diff options
Diffstat (limited to 'lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib')
34 files changed, 13754 insertions, 0 deletions
| diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPClientApp.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPClientApp.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..760718127e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPClientApp.c @@ -0,0 +1,208 @@ +/* +             LUFA Library +     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + +  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +           www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* +  Copyright 2017  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + +  Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this +  software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted +  without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in +  all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this +  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting +  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in +  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the +  software without specific, written prior permission. + +  The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this +  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability +  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any +  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages +  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether +  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, +  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of +  this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + *  DHCP Client Application. When connected to the uIP stack, this will retrieve IP configuration settings from the + *  DHCP server on the network. + */ + +#define  INCLUDE_FROM_DHCPCLIENTAPP_C +#include "DHCPClientApp.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_DHCP_CLIENT) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + +/** Initialization function for the DHCP client. */ +void DHCPClientApp_Init(void) +{ +	/* Create a new UDP connection to the DHCP server port for the DHCP solicitation */ +	struct uip_udp_conn* Connection = uip_udp_new(&uip_broadcast_addr, HTONS(DHCP_SERVER_PORT)); + +	/* If the connection was successfully created, bind it to the local DHCP client port */ +	if (Connection != NULL) +	{ +		uip_udp_appstate_t* const AppState = &Connection->appstate; +		uip_udp_bind(Connection, HTONS(DHCP_CLIENT_PORT)); + +		/* Set the initial client state */ +		AppState->DHCPClient.CurrentState = DHCP_STATE_SendDiscover; + +		/* Set timeout period to half a second for a DHCP server to respond */ +		timer_set(&AppState->DHCPClient.Timeout, CLOCK_SECOND / 2); +	} +} + +/** uIP stack application callback for the DHCP client. This function must be called each time the TCP/IP stack + *  needs a UDP packet to be processed. + */ +void DHCPClientApp_Callback(void) +{ +	uip_udp_appstate_t* const AppState    = &uip_udp_conn->appstate; +	DHCP_Header_t*      const AppData     = (DHCP_Header_t*)uip_appdata; +	uint16_t                  AppDataSize = 0; + +	switch (AppState->DHCPClient.CurrentState) +	{ +		case DHCP_STATE_SendDiscover: +			/* Clear all DHCP settings, reset client IP address */ +			memset(&AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data, 0x00, sizeof(AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data)); +			uip_sethostaddr((uip_ipaddr_t*)&AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.AllocatedIP); + +			/* Fill out the DHCP response header */ +			AppDataSize += DHCPClientApp_FillDHCPHeader(AppData, DHCP_DISCOVER, AppState); + +			/* Add the required DHCP options list to the packet */ +			uint8_t RequiredOptionList[] = {DHCP_OPTION_SUBNET_MASK, DHCP_OPTION_ROUTER, DHCP_OPTION_DNS_SERVER}; +			AppDataSize += DHCPCommon_SetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_REQ_LIST, sizeof(RequiredOptionList), +			                                    RequiredOptionList); + +			/* Send the DHCP DISCOVER packet */ +			uip_udp_send(AppDataSize); + +			/* Reset the timeout timer, progress to next state */ +			timer_reset(&AppState->DHCPClient.Timeout); +			AppState->DHCPClient.CurrentState = DHCP_STATE_WaitForOffer; + +			break; +		case DHCP_STATE_WaitForOffer: +			if (!(uip_newdata())) +			{ +				/* Check if the DHCP timeout period has expired while waiting for a response */ +				if (timer_expired(&AppState->DHCPClient.Timeout)) +				  AppState->DHCPClient.CurrentState = DHCP_STATE_SendDiscover; + +				break; +			} + +			uint8_t OfferResponse_MessageType; +			if ((AppData->TransactionID == DHCP_TRANSACTION_ID) && +			    DHCPCommon_GetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_MSG_TYPE, &OfferResponse_MessageType) && +			    (OfferResponse_MessageType == DHCP_OFFER)) +			{ +				/* Received a DHCP offer for an IP address, copy over values for later request */ +				memcpy(&AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.AllocatedIP, &AppData->YourIP, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); +				DHCPCommon_GetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_SUBNET_MASK, &AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.Netmask); +				DHCPCommon_GetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_ROUTER,      &AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.GatewayIP); +				DHCPCommon_GetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_SERVER_ID,   &AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.ServerIP); + +				timer_reset(&AppState->DHCPClient.Timeout); +				AppState->DHCPClient.CurrentState = DHCP_STATE_SendRequest; +			} + +			break; +		case DHCP_STATE_SendRequest: +			/* Fill out the DHCP response header */ +			AppDataSize += DHCPClientApp_FillDHCPHeader(AppData, DHCP_REQUEST, AppState); + +			/* Add the DHCP REQUESTED IP ADDRESS option to the packet */ +			AppDataSize += DHCPCommon_SetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_REQ_IPADDR, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t), +			                                    &AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.AllocatedIP); + +			/* Add the DHCP SERVER IP ADDRESS option to the packet */ +			AppDataSize += DHCPCommon_SetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_SERVER_ID, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t), +			                                    &AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.ServerIP); + +			/* Send the DHCP REQUEST packet */ +			uip_udp_send(AppDataSize); + +			/* Reset the timeout timer, progress to next state */ +			timer_reset(&AppState->DHCPClient.Timeout); +			AppState->DHCPClient.CurrentState = DHCP_STATE_WaitForACK; + +			break; +		case DHCP_STATE_WaitForACK: +			if (!(uip_newdata())) +			{ +				/* Check if the DHCP timeout period has expired while waiting for a response */ +				if (timer_expired(&AppState->DHCPClient.Timeout)) +				  AppState->DHCPClient.CurrentState = DHCP_STATE_SendDiscover; + +				break; +			} + +			uint8_t RequestResponse_MessageType; +			if ((AppData->TransactionID == DHCP_TRANSACTION_ID) && +			    DHCPCommon_GetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_MSG_TYPE, &RequestResponse_MessageType) && +			    (RequestResponse_MessageType == DHCP_ACK)) +			{ +				/* Set the new network parameters from the DHCP server */ +				uip_sethostaddr((uip_ipaddr_t*)&AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.AllocatedIP); +				uip_setnetmask((uip_ipaddr_t*)&AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.Netmask); +				uip_setdraddr((uip_ipaddr_t*)&AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.GatewayIP); + +				AppState->DHCPClient.CurrentState = DHCP_STATE_AddressLeased; +			} + +			break; +	} +} + +/** Fills the DHCP packet response with the appropriate BOOTP header for DHCP. This fills out all the required + *  fields, leaving only the additional DHCP options to be added to the packet before it is sent to the DHCP server. + * + *  \param[out] DHCPHeader       Location in the packet buffer where the BOOTP header should be written to + *  \param[in]  DHCPMessageType  DHCP Message type, such as DHCP_DISCOVER + *  \param[in]  AppState         Application state of the current UDP connection + * + *  \return Size in bytes of the created DHCP packet + */ +static uint16_t DHCPClientApp_FillDHCPHeader(DHCP_Header_t* const DHCPHeader, +                                             const uint8_t DHCPMessageType, +                                             uip_udp_appstate_t* const AppState) +{ +	/* Erase existing packet data so that we start will all 0x00 DHCP header data */ + 	memset(DHCPHeader, 0, sizeof(DHCP_Header_t)); + +	/* Fill out the DHCP packet header */ +	DHCPHeader->Operation             = DHCP_OP_BOOTREQUEST; +	DHCPHeader->HardwareType          = DHCP_HTYPE_ETHERNET; +	DHCPHeader->HardwareAddressLength = sizeof(MACAddress); +	DHCPHeader->Hops                  = 0; +	DHCPHeader->TransactionID         = DHCP_TRANSACTION_ID; +	DHCPHeader->ElapsedSeconds        = 0; +	DHCPHeader->Flags                 = HTONS(BOOTP_BROADCAST); +	memcpy(&DHCPHeader->ClientIP,     &uip_hostaddr,        sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); +	memcpy(&DHCPHeader->YourIP,       &AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.AllocatedIP, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); +	memcpy(&DHCPHeader->NextServerIP, &AppState->DHCPClient.DHCPOffer_Data.ServerIP,    sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); +	memcpy(&DHCPHeader->ClientHardwareAddress, &MACAddress, sizeof(struct uip_eth_addr)); +	DHCPHeader->Cookie                = DHCP_MAGIC_COOKIE; + +	/* Add a DHCP message type and terminator options to the start of the DHCP options field */ +	DHCPHeader->Options[0]            = DHCP_OPTION_MSG_TYPE; +	DHCPHeader->Options[1]            = 1; +	DHCPHeader->Options[2]            = DHCPMessageType; +	DHCPHeader->Options[3]            = DHCP_OPTION_END; + +	/* Calculate the total number of bytes added to the outgoing packet */ +	return (sizeof(DHCP_Header_t) + 4); +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPClientApp.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPClientApp.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0aec00331c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPClientApp.h @@ -0,0 +1,69 @@ +/* +             LUFA Library +     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + +  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +           www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* +  Copyright 2017  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + +  Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this +  software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted +  without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in +  all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this +  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting +  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in +  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the +  software without specific, written prior permission. + +  The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this +  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability +  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any +  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages +  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether +  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, +  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of +  this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + *  Header file for DHCPClientApp.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DHCPCLIENT_APP_H_ +#define _DHCPCLIENT_APP_H_ + +	/* Includes: */ +		#include <stdio.h> + +		#include <uip.h> + +		#include "Config/AppConfig.h" +		#include "../Webserver.h" +		#include "DHCPCommon.h" + +	/* Enums: */ +		/** States for each DHCP connection to a DHCP client. */ +		enum DHCP_Client_States_t +		{ +			DHCP_STATE_SendDiscover,  /**< Send DISCOVER packet to retrieve DHCP lease offers */ +			DHCP_STATE_WaitForOffer,  /**< Waiting for OFFER packet giving available DHCP leases */ +			DHCP_STATE_SendRequest,   /**< Send REQUEST packet to request a DHCP lease */ +			DHCP_STATE_WaitForACK,    /**< Wait for ACK packet to complete the DHCP lease */ +			DHCP_STATE_AddressLeased, /**< DHCP address has been leased from a DHCP server */ +		}; + +	/* Function Prototypes: */ +		void DHCPClientApp_Init(void); +		void DHCPClientApp_Callback(void); + +		#if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_DHCPCLIENTAPP_C) +			static uint16_t DHCPClientApp_FillDHCPHeader(DHCP_Header_t* const DHCPHeader, +			                                             const uint8_t DHCPMessageType, +			                                             uip_udp_appstate_t* const AppState); +		#endif +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPCommon.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPCommon.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..6d80f65cae --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPCommon.c @@ -0,0 +1,103 @@ +/* +             LUFA Library +     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + +  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +           www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* +  Copyright 2017  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + +  Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this +  software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted +  without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in +  all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this +  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting +  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in +  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the +  software without specific, written prior permission. + +  The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this +  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability +  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any +  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages +  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether +  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, +  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of +  this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + *  Common DHCP routines to manage DHCP packet data. + */ + +#include "DHCPCommon.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_DHCP_CLIENT) || defined(ENABLE_DHCP_SERVER) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + +/** Sets the given DHCP option in the DHCP packet's option list. This automatically moves the + *  end of options terminator past the new option in the options list. + * + *  \param[in,out] DHCPOptionList  Pointer to the start of the DHCP packet's options list + *  \param[in]     Option          DHCP option to add to the list + *  \param[in]     DataLen         Size in bytes of the option data to add + *  \param[in]     OptionData      Buffer where the option's data is to be sourced from + * + *  \return Number of bytes added to the DHCP packet + */ +uint8_t DHCPCommon_SetOption(uint8_t* DHCPOptionList, +                             const uint8_t Option, +                             const uint8_t DataLen, +                             void* const OptionData) +{ +	/* Skip through the DHCP options list until the terminator option is found */ +	while (*DHCPOptionList != DHCP_OPTION_END) +	  DHCPOptionList += (DHCPOptionList[1] + 2); + +	/* Overwrite the existing terminator with the new option, add a new terminator at the end of the list */ +	DHCPOptionList[0] = Option; +	DHCPOptionList[1] = DataLen; +	memcpy(&DHCPOptionList[2], OptionData, DataLen); +	DHCPOptionList[2 + DataLen] = DHCP_OPTION_END; + +	/* Calculate the total number of bytes added to the outgoing packet */ +	return (2 + DataLen); +} + +/** Retrieves the given option's data (if present) from the DHCP packet's options list. + * + *  \param[in,out] DHCPOptionList  Pointer to the start of the DHCP packet's options list + *  \param[in]     Option          DHCP option to retrieve to the list + *  \param[out]    Destination     Buffer where the option's data is to be written to if found + * + *  \return Boolean \c true if the option was found in the DHCP packet's options list, \c false otherwise + */ +bool DHCPCommon_GetOption(const uint8_t* DHCPOptionList, +                          const uint8_t Option, +                          void* const Destination) +{ +	/* Look through the incoming DHCP packet's options list for the requested option */ +	while (*DHCPOptionList != DHCP_OPTION_END) +	{ +		/* Check if the current DHCP option in the packet is the one requested */ +		if (DHCPOptionList[0] == Option) +		{ +			/* Copy request option's data to the destination buffer */ +			memcpy(Destination, &DHCPOptionList[2], DHCPOptionList[1]); + +			/* Indicate that the requested option data was successfully retrieved */ +			return true; +		} + +		/* Skip to next DHCP option in the options list */ +		DHCPOptionList += (DHCPOptionList[1] + 2); +	} + +	/* Requested option not found in the incoming packet's DHCP options list */ +	return false; +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPCommon.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPCommon.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8f54c16717 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPCommon.h @@ -0,0 +1,159 @@ +/* +             LUFA Library +     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + +  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +           www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* +  Copyright 2017  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + +  Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this +  software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted +  without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in +  all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this +  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting +  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in +  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the +  software without specific, written prior permission. + +  The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this +  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability +  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any +  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages +  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether +  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, +  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of +  this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + *  Header file for common DHCP defines. + */ + +#ifndef _DHCP_COMMON_H_ +#define _DHCP_COMMON_H_ + +	/* Includes: */ +		#include <stdint.h> +		#include <stdbool.h> +		#include <string.h> + +		#include "Config/AppConfig.h" + +		#include <uip.h> + +	/* Macros: */ +		/** UDP listen port for a BOOTP server. */ +		#define DHCP_SERVER_PORT          67 + +		/** UDP listen port for a BOOTP client. */ +		#define DHCP_CLIENT_PORT          68 + +		/** BOOTP message type for a BOOTP REQUEST message. */ +		#define DHCP_OP_BOOTREQUEST       0x01 + +		/** BOOTP message type for a BOOTP REPLY message. */ +		#define DHCP_OP_BOOTREPLY         0x02 + +		/** BOOTP flag for a BOOTP broadcast message. */ +		#define BOOTP_BROADCAST           0x8000 + +		/** Magic DHCP cookie for a BOOTP message to identify it as a DHCP message. */ +		#define DHCP_MAGIC_COOKIE         0x63538263 + +		/** Unique transaction ID used to identify DHCP responses to the client. */ +		#define DHCP_TRANSACTION_ID       0x13245466 + +		/** DHCP message type for a DISCOVER message. */ +		#define DHCP_DISCOVER             1 + +		/** DHCP message type for an OFFER message. */ +		#define DHCP_OFFER                2 + +		/** DHCP message type for a REQUEST message. */ +		#define DHCP_REQUEST              3 + +		/** DHCP message type for a DECLINE message. */ +		#define DHCP_DECLINE              4 + +		/** DHCP message type for an ACK message. */ +		#define DHCP_ACK                  5 + +		/** DHCP message type for a NAK message. */ +		#define DHCP_NAK                  6 + +		/** DHCP message type for a RELEASE message. */ +		#define DHCP_RELEASE              7 + +		/** DHCP medium type for standard Ethernet. */ +		#define DHCP_HTYPE_ETHERNET       1 + +		/** DHCP message option for the network subnet mask. */ +		#define DHCP_OPTION_SUBNET_MASK   1 + +		/** DHCP message option for the network gateway IP. */ +		#define DHCP_OPTION_ROUTER        3 + +		/** DHCP message option for the network DNS server. */ +		#define DHCP_OPTION_DNS_SERVER    6 + +		/** DHCP message option for the requested client IP address. */ +		#define DHCP_OPTION_REQ_IPADDR    50 + +		/** DHCP message option for the IP address lease time. */ +		#define DHCP_OPTION_LEASE_TIME    51 + +		/** DHCP message option for the DHCP message type. */ +		#define DHCP_OPTION_MSG_TYPE      53 + +		/** DHCP message option for the DHCP server IP. */ +		#define DHCP_OPTION_SERVER_ID     54 + +		/** DHCP message option for the list of required options from the server. */ +		#define DHCP_OPTION_REQ_LIST      55 + +		/** DHCP message option for the options list terminator. */ +		#define DHCP_OPTION_END           255 + +	/* Type Defines: */ +		/** Type define for a DHCP packet inside an Ethernet frame. */ +		typedef struct +		{ +			uint8_t      Operation; /**< DHCP operation, either DHCP_OP_BOOTREQUEST or DHCP_OP_BOOTREPLY */ +			uint8_t      HardwareType; /**< Hardware carrier type constant */ +			uint8_t      HardwareAddressLength;  /**< Length in bytes of a hardware (MAC) address on the network */ +			uint8_t      Hops; /**< Number of hops required to reach the server, unused */ + +			uint32_t     TransactionID; /**< Unique ID of the DHCP packet, for positive matching between sent and received packets */ + +			uint16_t     ElapsedSeconds; /**< Elapsed seconds since the request was made */ +			uint16_t     Flags; /**< BOOTP packet flags */ + +			uip_ipaddr_t ClientIP; /**< Client IP address, if already leased an IP */ +			uip_ipaddr_t YourIP; /**< Client IP address */ +			uip_ipaddr_t NextServerIP; /**< Legacy BOOTP protocol field, unused for DHCP */ +			uip_ipaddr_t RelayAgentIP; /**< Legacy BOOTP protocol field, unused for DHCP */ + +			uint8_t      ClientHardwareAddress[16]; /**< Hardware (MAC) address of the client making a request to the DHCP server */ +			uint8_t      ServerHostnameString[64]; /**< Legacy BOOTP protocol field, unused for DHCP */ +			uint8_t      BootFileName[128]; /**< Legacy BOOTP protocol field, unused for DHCP */ + +			uint32_t     Cookie; /**< Magic BOOTP protocol cookie to indicate a valid packet */ + +			uint8_t      Options[]; /**< DHCP message options */ +		} DHCP_Header_t; + +	/* Function Prototypes: */ +		uint8_t  DHCPCommon_SetOption(uint8_t* DHCPOptionList, +			                          const uint8_t Option, +			                          const uint8_t DataLen, +			                          void* const OptionData); +		bool     DHCPCommon_GetOption(const uint8_t* DHCPOptionList, +			                          const uint8_t Option, +			                          void* const Destination); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPServerApp.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPServerApp.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fea54ddb0e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPServerApp.c @@ -0,0 +1,265 @@ +/* +             LUFA Library +     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + +  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +           www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* +  Copyright 2017  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + +  Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this +  software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted +  without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in +  all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this +  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting +  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in +  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the +  software without specific, written prior permission. + +  The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this +  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability +  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any +  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages +  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether +  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, +  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of +  this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + *  DHCP Server Application. When connected to the uIP stack, this will send IP configuration settings to a + *  DHCP client on the network. + */ + +#define  INCLUDE_FROM_DHCPSERVERAPP_C +#include "DHCPServerApp.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_DHCP_SERVER) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + +struct uip_conn* BroadcastConnection; + +uint8_t LeasedIPs[255 / 8]; + +/** Initialization function for the DHCP server. */ +void DHCPServerApp_Init(void) +{ +	/* Listen on port 67 for DHCP server connections from hosts */ +	uip_listen(HTONS(DHCP_SERVER_PORT)); + +	/* Create a new UDP connection to the DHCP server port for the DHCP solicitation */ +	struct uip_udp_conn* BroadcastConnection = uip_udp_new(&uip_broadcast_addr, HTONS(DHCP_CLIENT_PORT)); + +	/* If the connection was successfully created, bind it to the local DHCP client port */ +	if (BroadcastConnection != NULL) +	  uip_udp_bind(BroadcastConnection, HTONS(DHCP_SERVER_PORT)); + +	/* Set all IP addresses as unleased */ +	memset(LeasedIPs, 0x00, sizeof(LeasedIPs)); +} + +/** uIP stack application callback for the DHCP server. This function must be called each time the TCP/IP stack + *  needs a UDP packet to be processed. + */ +void DHCPServerApp_Callback(void) +{ +	DHCP_Header_t* const AppData     = (DHCP_Header_t*)uip_appdata; +	uint16_t             AppDataSize = 0; + +	/* Only process when new data arrives - don't retransmit lost packets */ +	if (uip_newdata()) +	{ +		/* Get the DHCP message type (if present), otherwise early-abort */ +		uint8_t DHCPMessageType; +		if (!(DHCPCommon_GetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_MSG_TYPE, &DHCPMessageType))) +			return; + +		uip_ipaddr_t        Netmask, GatewayIPAddress, PreferredClientIP; +		struct uip_eth_addr RemoteMACAddress; +		uint32_t            TransactionID; + +		/* Get configured network mask, gateway IP and extract out DHCP transaction ID and remote IP */ +		uip_getnetmask(&Netmask); +		uip_getdraddr(&GatewayIPAddress); +		memcpy(&RemoteMACAddress, &AppData->ClientHardwareAddress, sizeof(struct uip_eth_addr)); +		TransactionID = AppData->TransactionID; + +		/* Try to extract out the client's preferred IP address if it is indicated in the packet */ +		if (!(DHCPCommon_GetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_REQ_IPADDR, &PreferredClientIP))) +		  memcpy(&PreferredClientIP, &uip_all_zeroes_addr, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); + +		switch (DHCPMessageType) +		{ +			case DHCP_DISCOVER: +				/* If no preference was made or the preferred IP is already taken, find a new address */ +				if (DHCPServerApp_CheckIfIPLeased(&PreferredClientIP)) +				  DHCPServerApp_GetUnleasedIP(&PreferredClientIP); + +				/* Create a new DHCP OFFER packet with the offered IP address */ +				AppDataSize += DHCPServerApp_FillDHCPHeader(AppData, DHCP_OFFER, &RemoteMACAddress, &PreferredClientIP, TransactionID); + +				/* Add network mask and router information to the list of DHCP OFFER packet options */ +				AppDataSize += DHCPCommon_SetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_SUBNET_MASK, +													sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t), &Netmask); +				AppDataSize += DHCPCommon_SetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_ROUTER, +					                                sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t), &GatewayIPAddress); + +				/* Send the DHCP OFFER packet */ +				uip_poll_conn(BroadcastConnection); +				memcpy(&uip_udp_conn->ripaddr, &uip_broadcast_addr, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); +				uip_udp_send(AppDataSize); + +				break; +			case DHCP_REQUEST: +				/* Check to see if the requested IP address has already been leased to a client */ +				if (!(DHCPServerApp_CheckIfIPLeased(&PreferredClientIP))) +				{ +					/* Create a new DHCP ACK packet to accept the IP address lease */ +					AppDataSize += DHCPServerApp_FillDHCPHeader(AppData, DHCP_ACK, &RemoteMACAddress, &PreferredClientIP, TransactionID); + +					/* Add network mask and router information to the list of DHCP ACK packet options */ +					AppDataSize += DHCPCommon_SetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_SUBNET_MASK, +														sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t), &Netmask); +					AppDataSize += DHCPCommon_SetOption(AppData->Options, DHCP_OPTION_ROUTER, +					                                    sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t), &GatewayIPAddress); + +					/* Mark the requested IP as leased to a client */ +					DHCPServerApp_LeaseIP(&PreferredClientIP); +				} +				else +				{ +					/* Create a new DHCP NAK packet to reject the requested allocation */ +					AppDataSize += DHCPServerApp_FillDHCPHeader(AppData, DHCP_NAK, &RemoteMACAddress, &uip_all_zeroes_addr, TransactionID); +				} + +				/* Send the DHCP ACK or NAK packet */ +				uip_poll_conn(BroadcastConnection); +				memcpy(&uip_udp_conn->ripaddr, &uip_broadcast_addr, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); +				uip_udp_send(AppDataSize); + +				break; +			case DHCP_RELEASE: +				/* Mark the IP address as released in the allocation table */ +				DHCPServerApp_UnleaseIP(&uip_udp_conn->ripaddr); +				break; +		} +	} +} + +/** Fills the DHCP packet response with the appropriate BOOTP header for DHCP. This fills out all the required + *  fields, leaving only the additional DHCP options to be added to the packet before it is sent to the DHCP client. + * + *  \param[out] DHCPHeader             Location in the packet buffer where the BOOTP header should be written to + *  \param[in]  DHCPMessageType        DHCP Message type, such as DHCP_DISCOVER + *  \param[in]  ClientHardwareAddress  Client MAC address the created transaction should be directed to + *  \param[in]  PreferredClientIP      Preferred IP that should be given to the client if it is unallocated + *  \param[in]  TransactionID          Transaction ID the created transaction should be associated with + * + *  \return Size in bytes of the created DHCP packet + */ +static uint16_t DHCPServerApp_FillDHCPHeader(DHCP_Header_t* const DHCPHeader, +                                             const uint8_t DHCPMessageType, +                                             const struct uip_eth_addr* const ClientHardwareAddress, +											 const uip_ipaddr_t* const PreferredClientIP, +                                             const uint32_t TransactionID) +{ +	/* Erase existing packet data so that we start will all 0x00 DHCP header data */ + 	memset(DHCPHeader, 0, sizeof(DHCP_Header_t)); + +	DHCPHeader->Operation             = DHCPMessageType; +	DHCPHeader->HardwareType          = DHCP_HTYPE_ETHERNET; +	DHCPHeader->HardwareAddressLength = sizeof(MACAddress); +	DHCPHeader->Hops                  = 0; +	DHCPHeader->TransactionID         = TransactionID; +	DHCPHeader->ElapsedSeconds        = 0; +	DHCPHeader->Flags                 = 0; +	memcpy(&DHCPHeader->NextServerIP, &uip_hostaddr, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); +	memcpy(&DHCPHeader->YourIP, PreferredClientIP, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); +	memcpy(&DHCPHeader->ClientHardwareAddress, ClientHardwareAddress, sizeof(struct uip_eth_addr)); +	DHCPHeader->Cookie                = DHCP_MAGIC_COOKIE; + +	/* Add a DHCP message type and terminator options to the start of the DHCP options field */ +	DHCPHeader->Options[0]            = DHCP_OPTION_MSG_TYPE; +	DHCPHeader->Options[1]            = 1; +	DHCPHeader->Options[2]            = DHCPMessageType; +	DHCPHeader->Options[3]            = DHCP_OPTION_END; + +	/* Calculate the total number of bytes added to the outgoing packet */ +	return (sizeof(DHCP_Header_t) + 4); +} + +/** Checks to see if the nominated IP address has already been allocated to a client. + * + *  \param[in] IPAddress  IP Address whose lease status should be checked + * + *  \pre The IP address must be within the same /24 subnet as the virtual webserver. + * + *  \return Boolean \c true if the IP has already been leased to a client, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool DHCPServerApp_CheckIfIPLeased(const uip_ipaddr_t* const IPAddress) +{ +	uint8_t Byte = (IPAddress->u8[3] / 8); +	uint8_t Mask = (1 << (IPAddress->u8[3] % 8)); + +	/* Make sure that the requested IP address isn't already leased to the virtual server or another client */ +	if (IPAddress->u8[3] && !(IPAddress->u8[3] == uip_hostaddr.u8[3]) && !(LeasedIPs[Byte] & Mask)) +	  return false; +	else +	  return true; +} + +/** Retrieves the next unleased IP in the IP address pool. + * + *  \param[out] NewIPAddress  Location where the generated IP Address should be stored + */ +static void DHCPServerApp_GetUnleasedIP(uip_ipaddr_t* const NewIPAddress) +{ +	uip_ipaddr_copy(NewIPAddress, &uip_hostaddr); + +	/** Look through the current subnet, skipping the broadcast and zero IP addresses */ +	for (uint8_t IP = 1; IP < 254; IP++) +	{ +		/* Update new IP address to lease with the current IP address to test */ +		NewIPAddress->u8[3] = IP; + +		/* If we've found an unleased IP, abort with the updated IP stored for the called */ +		if (!(DHCPServerApp_CheckIfIPLeased(NewIPAddress))) +		  return; +	} +} + +/** Marks the given IP Address as leased in the address pool, so that it will not be + *  allocated to another client unless it is first released. + * + *  \param[in] IPAddress  IP Address to mark as leased + * + *  \pre The IP address must be within the same /24 subnet as the virtual webserver. + */ +static void DHCPServerApp_LeaseIP(const uip_ipaddr_t* const IPAddress) +{ +	uint8_t Byte = (IPAddress->u8[3] / 8); +	uint8_t Mask = (1 << (IPAddress->u8[3] % 8)); + +	/* Mark the IP address as leased in the allocation table */ +	LeasedIPs[Byte] |= Mask; +} + +/** Marks the given IP Address as not leased in the address pool, so that it can be + *  allocated to another client upon request. + * + *  \param[in] IPAddress  IP Address to mark as not leased + * + *  \pre The IP address must be within the same /24 subnet as the virtual webserver. + */ +static void DHCPServerApp_UnleaseIP(const uip_ipaddr_t* const IPAddress) +{ +	uint8_t Byte = (IPAddress->u8[3] / 8); +	uint8_t Mask = (1 << (IPAddress->u8[3] % 8)); + +	/* Mark the IP address as unleased in the allocation table */ +	LeasedIPs[Byte] &= ~Mask; +} +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPServerApp.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPServerApp.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..a9dae7bf3a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DHCPServerApp.h @@ -0,0 +1,64 @@ +/* +             LUFA Library +     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + +  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +           www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* +  Copyright 2017  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + +  Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this +  software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted +  without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in +  all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this +  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting +  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in +  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the +  software without specific, written prior permission. + +  The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this +  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability +  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any +  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages +  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether +  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, +  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of +  this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + *  Header file for DHCPServerApp.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DHCPSERVER_APP_H_ +#define _DHCPSERVER_APP_H_ + +	/* Includes: */ +		#include <stdio.h> + +		#include <uip.h> + +		#include "Config/AppConfig.h" +		#include "../Webserver.h" +		#include "DHCPCommon.h" + +	/* Function Prototypes: */ +		void DHCPServerApp_Init(void); +		void DHCPServerApp_Callback(void); + +		#if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_DHCPSERVERAPP_C) +		static uint16_t DHCPServerApp_FillDHCPHeader(DHCP_Header_t* const DHCPHeader, +		                                             const uint8_t DHCPMessageType, +		                                             const struct uip_eth_addr* const ClientHardwareAddress, +		                                             const uip_ipaddr_t* const PreferredClientIP, +		                                             const uint32_t TransactionID); +		static bool DHCPServerApp_CheckIfIPLeased(const uip_ipaddr_t* const IPAddress); +		static void DHCPServerApp_GetUnleasedIP(uip_ipaddr_t* const NewIPAddress); +		static void DHCPServerApp_LeaseIP(const uip_ipaddr_t* const IPAddress); +		static void DHCPServerApp_UnleaseIP(const uip_ipaddr_t* const IPAddress); +		#endif +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DataflashManager.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DataflashManager.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b1111ce39b --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DataflashManager.c @@ -0,0 +1,534 @@ +/* +             LUFA Library +     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + +  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +           www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* +  Copyright 2017  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + +  Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this +  software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted +  without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in +  all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this +  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting +  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in +  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the +  software without specific, written prior permission. + +  The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this +  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability +  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any +  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages +  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether +  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, +  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of +  this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + *  Functions to manage the physical Dataflash media, including reading and writing of + *  blocks of data. These functions are called by the SCSI layer when data must be stored + *  or retrieved to/from the physical storage media. If a different media is used (such + *  as a SD card or EEPROM), functions similar to these will need to be generated. + */ + +#define  INCLUDE_FROM_DATAFLASHMANAGER_C +#include "DataflashManager.h" + +/** Writes blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) to the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), from + *  the pre-selected data OUT endpoint. This routine reads in OS sized blocks from the endpoint and writes + *  them to the Dataflash in Dataflash page sized blocks. + * + *  \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo  Pointer to a structure containing a Mass Storage Class configuration and state + *  \param[in] BlockAddress  Data block starting address for the write sequence + *  \param[in] TotalBlocks   Number of blocks of data to write + */ +void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, +                                  const uint32_t BlockAddress, +                                  uint16_t TotalBlocks) +{ +	uint16_t CurrDFPage          = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); +	uint16_t CurrDFPageByte      = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); +	uint8_t  CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); +	bool     UsingSecondBuffer   = false; + +	/* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ +	Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) +	/* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ +	Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); +	Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); +	Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +#endif + +	/* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ +	Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); +	Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, CurrDFPageByte); + +	/* Wait until endpoint is ready before continuing */ +	if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) +	  return; + +	while (TotalBlocks) +	{ +		uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + +		/* Write an endpoint packet sized data block to the Dataflash */ +		while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) +		{ +			/* Check if the endpoint is currently empty */ +			if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) +			{ +				/* Clear the current endpoint bank */ +				Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + +				/* Wait until the host has sent another packet */ +				if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) +				  return; +			} + +			/* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ +			if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) +			{ +				/* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ +				Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +				Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); +				Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + +				/* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ +				CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; +				CurrDFPage++; + +				/* Once all the Dataflash ICs have had their first buffers filled, switch buffers to maintain throughput */ +				if (Dataflash_GetSelectedChip() == DATAFLASH_CHIP_MASK(DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS)) +				  UsingSecondBuffer = !(UsingSecondBuffer); + +				/* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ +				Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) +				/* If less than one Dataflash page remaining, copy over the existing page to preserve trailing data */ +				if ((TotalBlocks * (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) < (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) +				{ +					/* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ +					Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +					Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2 : DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); +					Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); +					Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +				} +#endif + +				/* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ +				Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2WRITE : DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); +				Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, 0); +			} + +			/* Write one 16-byte chunk of data to the Dataflash */ +			Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); +			Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); +			Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); +			Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); +			Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); +			Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); +			Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); +			Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); +			Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); +			Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); +			Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); +			Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); +			Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); +			Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); +			Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); +			Dataflash_SendByte(Endpoint_Read_8()); + +			/* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ +			CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + +			/* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ +			BytesInBlockDiv16++; + +			/* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ +			if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset) +			  return; +		} + +		/* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ +		TotalBlocks--; +	} + +	/* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ +	Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +	Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); +	Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0x00); +	Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + +	/* If the endpoint is empty, clear it ready for the next packet from the host */ +	if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) +	  Endpoint_ClearOUT(); + +	/* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ +	Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Reads blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) from the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), into + *  the pre-selected data IN endpoint. This routine reads in Dataflash page sized blocks from the Dataflash + *  and writes them in OS sized blocks to the endpoint. + * + *  \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo  Pointer to a structure containing a Mass Storage Class configuration and state + *  \param[in] BlockAddress  Data block starting address for the read sequence + *  \param[in] TotalBlocks   Number of blocks of data to read + */ +void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, +                                 const uint32_t BlockAddress, +                                 uint16_t TotalBlocks) +{ +	uint16_t CurrDFPage          = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); +	uint16_t CurrDFPageByte      = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); +	uint8_t  CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + +	/* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ +	Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +	/* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ +	Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); +	Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, CurrDFPageByte); +	Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); +	Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); +	Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); +	Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + +	/* Wait until endpoint is ready before continuing */ +	if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) +	  return; + +	while (TotalBlocks) +	{ +		uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + +		/* Read an endpoint packet sized data block from the Dataflash */ +		while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) +		{ +			/* Check if the endpoint is currently full */ +			if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) +			{ +				/* Clear the endpoint bank to send its contents to the host */ +				Endpoint_ClearIN(); + +				/* Wait until the endpoint is ready for more data */ +				if (Endpoint_WaitUntilReady()) +				  return; +			} + +			/* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ +			if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) +			{ +				/* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ +				CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; +				CurrDFPage++; + +				/* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ +				Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +				/* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ +				Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); +				Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); +				Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); +				Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); +				Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); +				Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); +			} + +			/* Read one 16-byte chunk of data from the Dataflash */ +			Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); +			Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); +			Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); +			Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); +			Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); +			Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); +			Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); +			Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); +			Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); +			Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); +			Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); +			Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); +			Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); +			Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); +			Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); +			Endpoint_Write_8(Dataflash_ReceiveByte()); + +			/* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ +			CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + +			/* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ +			BytesInBlockDiv16++; + +			/* Check if the current command is being aborted by the host */ +			if (MSInterfaceInfo->State.IsMassStoreReset) +			  return; +		} + +		/* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ +		TotalBlocks--; +	} + +	/* If the endpoint is full, send its contents to the host */ +	if (!(Endpoint_IsReadWriteAllowed())) +	  Endpoint_ClearIN(); + +	/* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ +	Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Writes blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) to the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), from + *  the given RAM buffer. This routine reads in OS sized blocks from the buffer and writes them to the + *  Dataflash in Dataflash page sized blocks. This can be linked to FAT libraries to write files to the + *  Dataflash. + * + *  \param[in] BlockAddress  Data block starting address for the write sequence + *  \param[in] TotalBlocks   Number of blocks of data to write + *  \param[in] BufferPtr     Pointer to the data source RAM buffer + */ +void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, +                                      uint16_t TotalBlocks, +                                      const uint8_t* BufferPtr) +{ +	uint16_t CurrDFPage          = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); +	uint16_t CurrDFPageByte      = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); +	uint8_t  CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); +	bool     UsingSecondBuffer   = false; + +	/* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ +	Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) +	/* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ +	Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); +	Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); +	Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +#endif + +	/* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ +	Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); +	Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, CurrDFPageByte); + +	while (TotalBlocks) +	{ +		uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + +		/* Write an endpoint packet sized data block to the Dataflash */ +		while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) +		{ +			/* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ +			if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) +			{ +				/* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ +				Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +				Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); +				Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); + +				/* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ +				CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; +				CurrDFPage++; + +				/* Once all the Dataflash ICs have had their first buffers filled, switch buffers to maintain throughput */ +				if (Dataflash_GetSelectedChip() == DATAFLASH_CHIP_MASK(DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS)) +				  UsingSecondBuffer = !(UsingSecondBuffer); + +				/* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ +				Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE > VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) +				/* If less than one Dataflash page remaining, copy over the existing page to preserve trailing data */ +				if ((TotalBlocks * (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) < (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) +				{ +					/* Copy selected dataflash's current page contents to the Dataflash buffer */ +					Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +					Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF2 : DF_CMD_MAINMEMTOBUFF1); +					Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); +					Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +				} +#endif + +				/* Send the Dataflash buffer write command */ +				Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); +				Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2WRITE : DF_CMD_BUFF1WRITE); +				Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(0, 0); +			} + +			/* Write one 16-byte chunk of data to the Dataflash */ +			for (uint8_t ByteNum = 0; ByteNum < 16; ByteNum++) +			  Dataflash_SendByte(*(BufferPtr++)); + +			/* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ +			CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + +			/* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ +			BytesInBlockDiv16++; +		} + +		/* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ +		TotalBlocks--; +	} + +	/* Write the Dataflash buffer contents back to the Dataflash page */ +	Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); +	Dataflash_SendByte(UsingSecondBuffer ? DF_CMD_BUFF2TOMAINMEMWITHERASE : DF_CMD_BUFF1TOMAINMEMWITHERASE); +	Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0x00); +	Dataflash_WaitWhileBusy(); + +	/* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ +	Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Reads blocks (OS blocks, not Dataflash pages) from the storage medium, the board Dataflash IC(s), into + *  the preallocated RAM buffer. This routine reads in Dataflash page sized blocks from the Dataflash + *  and writes them in OS sized blocks to the given buffer. This can be linked to FAT libraries to read + *  the files stored on the Dataflash. + * + *  \param[in] BlockAddress  Data block starting address for the read sequence + *  \param[in] TotalBlocks   Number of blocks of data to read + *  \param[out] BufferPtr    Pointer to the data destination RAM buffer + */ +void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, +                                     uint16_t TotalBlocks, +                                     uint8_t* BufferPtr) +{ +	uint16_t CurrDFPage          = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) / DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); +	uint16_t CurrDFPageByte      = ((BlockAddress * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) % DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE); +	uint8_t  CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = (CurrDFPageByte >> 4); + +	/* Select the correct starting Dataflash IC for the block requested */ +	Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +	/* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ +	Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); +	Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, CurrDFPageByte); +	Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); +	Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); +	Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); +	Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); + +	while (TotalBlocks) +	{ +		uint8_t BytesInBlockDiv16 = 0; + +		/* Read an endpoint packet sized data block from the Dataflash */ +		while (BytesInBlockDiv16 < (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE >> 4)) +		{ +			/* Check if end of Dataflash page reached */ +			if (CurrDFPageByteDiv16 == (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE >> 4)) +			{ +				/* Reset the Dataflash buffer counter, increment the page counter */ +				CurrDFPageByteDiv16 = 0; +				CurrDFPage++; + +				/* Select the next Dataflash chip based on the new Dataflash page index */ +				Dataflash_SelectChipFromPage(CurrDFPage); + +				/* Send the Dataflash main memory page read command */ +				Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_MAINMEMPAGEREAD); +				Dataflash_SendAddressBytes(CurrDFPage, 0); +				Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); +				Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); +				Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); +				Dataflash_SendByte(0x00); +			} + +			/* Read one 16-byte chunk of data from the Dataflash */ +			for (uint8_t ByteNum = 0; ByteNum < 16; ByteNum++) +			  *(BufferPtr++) = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); + +			/* Increment the Dataflash page 16 byte block counter */ +			CurrDFPageByteDiv16++; + +			/* Increment the block 16 byte block counter */ +			BytesInBlockDiv16++; +		} + +		/* Decrement the blocks remaining counter */ +		TotalBlocks--; +	} + +	/* Deselect all Dataflash chips */ +	Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Disables the Dataflash memory write protection bits on the board Dataflash ICs, if enabled. */ +void DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(void) +{ +	/* Select first Dataflash chip, send the read status register command */ +	Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); +	Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + +	/* Check if sector protection is enabled */ +	if (Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_SECTORPROTECTION_ON) +	{ +		Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + +		/* Send the commands to disable sector protection */ +		Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[0]); +		Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[1]); +		Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[2]); +		Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[3]); +	} + +	/* Select second Dataflash chip (if present on selected board), send read status register command */ +	#if (DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS == 2) +	Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP2); +	Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_GETSTATUS); + +	/* Check if sector protection is enabled */ +	if (Dataflash_ReceiveByte() & DF_STATUS_SECTORPROTECTION_ON) +	{ +		Dataflash_ToggleSelectedChipCS(); + +		/* Send the commands to disable sector protection */ +		Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[0]); +		Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[1]); +		Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[2]); +		Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_SECTORPROTECTIONOFF[3]); +	} +	#endif + +	/* Deselect current Dataflash chip */ +	Dataflash_DeselectChip(); +} + +/** Performs a simple test on the attached Dataflash IC(s) to ensure that they are working. + * + *  \return Boolean \c true if all media chips are working, \c false otherwise + */ +bool DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation(void) +{ +	uint8_t ReturnByte; + +	/* Test first Dataflash IC is present and responding to commands */ +	Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP1); +	Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_READMANUFACTURERDEVICEINFO); +	ReturnByte = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); +	Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + +	/* If returned data is invalid, fail the command */ +	if (ReturnByte != DF_MANUFACTURER_ATMEL) +	  return false; + +	#if (DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS == 2) +	/* Test second Dataflash IC is present and responding to commands */ +	Dataflash_SelectChip(DATAFLASH_CHIP2); +	Dataflash_SendByte(DF_CMD_READMANUFACTURERDEVICEINFO); +	ReturnByte = Dataflash_ReceiveByte(); +	Dataflash_DeselectChip(); + +	/* If returned data is invalid, fail the command */ +	if (ReturnByte != DF_MANUFACTURER_ATMEL) +	  return false; +	#endif + +	return true; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DataflashManager.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DataflashManager.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..367fbac8c4 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/DataflashManager.h @@ -0,0 +1,87 @@ +/* +             LUFA Library +     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + +  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +           www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* +  Copyright 2017  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + +  Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this +  software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted +  without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in +  all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this +  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting +  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in +  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the +  software without specific, written prior permission. + +  The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this +  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability +  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any +  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages +  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether +  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, +  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of +  this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + *  Header file for DataflashManager.c. + */ + +#ifndef _DATAFLASH_MANAGER_H_ +#define _DATAFLASH_MANAGER_H_ + +	/* Includes: */ +		#include <avr/io.h> + +		#include "../Descriptors.h" + +		#include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> +		#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> +		#include <LUFA/Drivers/Board/Dataflash.h> + +	/* Preprocessor Checks: */ +		#if (DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE % 16) +			#error Dataflash page size must be a multiple of 16 bytes. +		#endif + +	/* Defines: */ +		/** Total number of bytes of the storage medium, comprised of one or more Dataflash ICs. */ +		#define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES                ((uint32_t)DATAFLASH_PAGES * DATAFLASH_PAGE_SIZE * DATAFLASH_TOTALCHIPS) + +		/** Block size of the device. This is kept at 512 to remain compatible with the OS despite the underlying +		 *  storage media (Dataflash) using a different native block size. Do not change this value. +		 */ +		#define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE           512 + +		/** Total number of blocks of the virtual memory for reporting to the host as the device's total capacity. Do not +		 *  change this value; change VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES instead to alter the media size. +		 */ +		#define VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCKS               (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BYTES / VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE) + +		/** Indicates if the disk is write protected or not. */ +		#define DISK_READ_ONLY                      false + +	/* Function Prototypes: */ +		void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, +		                                  const uint32_t BlockAddress, +		                                  uint16_t TotalBlocks); +		void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, +		                                 const uint32_t BlockAddress, +		                                 uint16_t TotalBlocks); +		void DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, +		                                      uint16_t TotalBlocks, +		                                      const uint8_t* BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); +		void DataflashManager_ReadBlocks_RAM(const uint32_t BlockAddress, +		                                     uint16_t TotalBlocks, +		                                     uint8_t* BufferPtr) ATTR_NON_NULL_PTR_ARG(3); +		void DataflashManager_ResetDataflashProtections(void); +		bool DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation(void); + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/00readme.txt b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/00readme.txt new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..80d8843d13 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/00readme.txt @@ -0,0 +1,135 @@ +FatFs Module Source Files R0.09a                       (C)ChaN, 2012 + + +FILES + +  ffconf.h   Configuration file for FatFs module. +  ff.h       Common include file for FatFs and application module. +  ff.c       FatFs module. +  diskio.h   Common include file for FatFs and disk I/O module. +  diskio.c   An example of glue function to attach existing disk I/O module to FatFs. +  integer.h  Integer type definitions for FatFs. +  option     Optional external functions. + +  Low level disk I/O module is not included in this archive because the FatFs +  module is only a generic file system layer and not depend on any specific +  storage device. You have to provide a low level disk I/O module that written +  to control your storage device. + + + +AGREEMENTS + + FatFs module is an open source software to implement FAT file system to + small embedded systems. This is a free software and is opened for education, + research and commercial developments under license policy of following trems. + +  Copyright (C) 2012, ChaN, all right reserved. + + * The FatFs module is a free software and there is NO WARRANTY. + * No restriction on use. You can use, modify and redistribute it for +   personal, non-profit or commercial product UNDER YOUR RESPONSIBILITY. + * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice. + + + +REVISION HISTORY + +  Feb 26, 2006  R0.00  Prototype + +  Apr 29, 2006  R0.01  First release. + +  Jun 01, 2006  R0.02  Added FAT12. +                       Removed unbuffered mode. +                       Fixed a problem on small (<32M) patition. + +  Jun 10, 2006  R0.02a Added a configuration option _FS_MINIMUM. + +  Sep 22, 2006  R0.03  Added f_rename. +                       Changed option _FS_MINIMUM to _FS_MINIMIZE. + +  Dec 11, 2006  R0.03a Improved cluster scan algolithm to write files fast. +                       Fixed f_mkdir creates incorrect directory on FAT32. + +  Feb 04, 2007  R0.04  Supported multiple drive system. (FatFs) +                       Changed some APIs for multiple drive system. +                       Added f_mkfs. (FatFs) +                       Added _USE_FAT32 option. (Tiny-FatFs) + +  Apr 01, 2007  R0.04a Supported multiple partitions on a plysical drive. (FatFs) +                       Fixed an endian sensitive code in f_mkfs. (FatFs) +                       Added a capability of extending the file size to f_lseek. +                       Added minimization level 3. +                       Fixed a problem that can collapse a sector when recreate an +                       existing file in any sub-directory at non FAT32 cfg. (Tiny-FatFs) + +  May 05, 2007  R0.04b Added _USE_NTFLAG option. +                       Added FSInfo support. +                       Fixed some problems corresponds to FAT32. (Tiny-FatFs) +                       Fixed DBCS name can result FR_INVALID_NAME. +                       Fixed short seek (0 < ofs <= csize) collapses the file object. + +  Aug 25, 2007  R0.05  Changed arguments of f_read, f_write. +                       Changed arguments of f_mkfs. (FatFs) +                       Fixed f_mkfs on FAT32 creates incorrect FSInfo. (FatFs) +                       Fixed f_mkdir on FAT32 creates incorrect directory. (FatFs) + +  Feb 03, 2008  R0.05a Added f_truncate(). +                       Added f_utime(). +                       Fixed off by one error at FAT sub-type determination. +                       Fixed btr in f_read() can be mistruncated. +                       Fixed cached sector is not flushed when create and close without write. + +  Apr 01, 2008  R0.06  Added f_forward(). (Tiny-FatFs) +                       Added string functions: fputc(), fputs(), fprintf() and fgets(). +                       Improved performance of f_lseek() on move to the same or following cluster. + +  Apr 01, 2009, R0.07  Merged Tiny-FatFs as a buffer configuration option. +                       Added long file name support. +                       Added multiple code page support. +                       Added re-entrancy for multitask operation. +                       Added auto cluster size selection to f_mkfs(). +                       Added rewind option to f_readdir(). +                       Changed result code of critical errors. +                       Renamed string functions to avoid name collision. + +  Apr 14, 2009, R0.07a Separated out OS dependent code on reentrant cfg. +                       Added multiple sector size support. + +  Jun 21, 2009, R0.07c Fixed f_unlink() may return FR_OK on error. +                       Fixed wrong cache control in f_lseek(). +                       Added relative path feature. +                       Added f_chdir(). +                       Added f_chdrive(). +                       Added proper case conversion for extended characters. + +  Nov 03, 2009 R0.07e  Separated out configuration options from ff.h to ffconf.h. +                       Added a configuration option, _LFN_UNICODE. +                       Fixed f_unlink() fails to remove a sub-dir on _FS_RPATH. +                       Fixed name matching error on the 13 char boundary. +                       Changed f_readdir() to return the SFN with always upper case on non-LFN cfg. + +  May 15, 2010, R0.08  Added a memory configuration option. (_USE_LFN) +                       Added file lock feature. (_FS_SHARE) +                       Added fast seek feature. (_USE_FASTSEEK) +                       Changed some types on the API, XCHAR->TCHAR. +                       Changed fname member in the FILINFO structure on Unicode cfg. +                       String functions support UTF-8 encoding files on Unicode cfg. + +  Aug 16,'10 R0.08a    Added f_getcwd(). (_FS_RPATH = 2) +                       Added sector erase feature. (_USE_ERASE) +                       Moved file lock semaphore table from fs object to the bss. +                       Fixed a wrong directory entry is created on non-LFN cfg when the given name contains ';'. +                       Fixed f_mkfs() creates wrong FAT32 volume. + +  Jan 15,'11 R0.08b    Fast seek feature is also applied to f_read() and f_write(). +                       f_lseek() reports required table size on creating CLMP. +                       Extended format syntax of f_printf function. +                       Ignores duplicated directory separators in given path names. + +  Sep 06,'11 R0.09     f_mkfs() supports multiple partition to finish the multiple partition feature. +                       Added f_fdisk(). (_MULTI_PARTITION = 2) + +  Aug 27,'12 R0.09a    Fixed assertion failure due to OS/2 EA on FAT12/16. +                       Changed API rejects null object pointer to avoid crash. +                       Changed option name _FS_SHARE to _FS_LOCK. diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/diskio.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/diskio.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..b119b1a402 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/diskio.c @@ -0,0 +1,65 @@ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Low level disk I/O module skeleton for FatFs     (C)ChaN, 2007        */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* This is a stub disk I/O module that acts as front end of the existing */ +/* disk I/O modules and attach it to FatFs module with common interface. */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#include "diskio.h" + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Initialize a Drive                                                    */ + +DSTATUS disk_initialize ( +	BYTE drv				/* Physical drive number (0..) */ +) +{ +	return FR_OK; +} + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Return Disk Status                                                    */ + +DSTATUS disk_status ( +	BYTE drv		/* Physical drive number (0..) */ +) +{ +	return FR_OK; +} + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Read Sector(s)                                                        */ + +DRESULT disk_read ( +	BYTE drv,		/* Physical drive number (0..) */ +	BYTE *buff,		/* Data buffer to store read data */ +	DWORD sector,	/* Sector address (LBA) */ +	BYTE count		/* Number of sectors to read (1..128) */ +) +{ +	DataflashManager_ReadBlocks_RAM(sector, count, buff); +	return RES_OK; +} + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Write Sector(s)                                                       */ + +#if _READONLY == 0 +DRESULT disk_write ( +	BYTE drv,			/* Physical drive number (0..) */ +	const BYTE *buff,	/* Data to be written */ +	DWORD sector,		/* Sector address (LBA) */ +	BYTE count			/* Number of sectors to write (1..128) */ +) +{ +	DataflashManager_WriteBlocks_RAM(sector, count, buff); +	return RES_OK; +} +#endif /* _READONLY */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/diskio.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/diskio.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..65e3048a0a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/diskio.h @@ -0,0 +1,52 @@ +/*----------------------------------------------------------------------- +/  Low level disk interface module include file +/-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#ifndef _DISKIO_DEFINED +#define _DISKIO_DEFINED + +#ifdef __cplusplus +extern "C" { +#endif + +#include "integer.h" +#include "ff.h" + +#include "../DataflashManager.h" + + +/* Status of Disk Functions */ +typedef BYTE	DSTATUS; + +/* Results of Disk Functions */ +typedef enum { +	RES_OK = 0,		/* 0: Successful */ +	RES_ERROR,		/* 1: R/W Error */ +	RES_WRPRT,		/* 2: Write Protected */ +	RES_NOTRDY,		/* 3: Not Ready */ +	RES_PARERR		/* 4: Invalid Parameter */ +} DRESULT; + + +/*---------------------------------------*/ +/* Prototypes for disk control functions */ + +DSTATUS disk_initialize (BYTE); +DSTATUS disk_status (BYTE); +DRESULT disk_read (BYTE, BYTE*, DWORD, BYTE); +DRESULT disk_write (BYTE, const BYTE*, DWORD, BYTE); +DRESULT disk_ioctl (BYTE, BYTE, void*); + + +/* Disk Status Bits (DSTATUS) */ + +#define STA_NOINIT		0x01	/* Drive not initialized */ +#define STA_NODISK		0x02	/* No medium in the drive */ +#define STA_PROTECT		0x04	/* Write protected */ + + +#ifdef __cplusplus +} +#endif + +#endif diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/ff.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/ff.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..2f58adf837 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/ff.c @@ -0,0 +1,4139 @@ +/*----------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/  FatFs - FAT file system module  R0.09a                 (C)ChaN, 2012 +/-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ FatFs module is a generic FAT file system module for small embedded systems. +/ This is a free software that opened for education, research and commercial +/ developments under license policy of following terms. +/ +/  Copyright (C) 2012, ChaN, all right reserved. +/ +/ * The FatFs module is a free software and there is NO WARRANTY. +/ * No restriction on use. You can use, modify and redistribute it for +/   personal, non-profit or commercial products UNDER YOUR RESPONSIBILITY. +/ * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice. +/ +/-----------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ Feb 26,'06 R0.00  Prototype. +/ +/ Apr 29,'06 R0.01  First stable version. +/ +/ Jun 01,'06 R0.02  Added FAT12 support. +/                   Removed unbuffered mode. +/                   Fixed a problem on small (<32M) partition. +/ Jun 10,'06 R0.02a Added a configuration option (_FS_MINIMUM). +/ +/ Sep 22,'06 R0.03  Added f_rename(). +/                   Changed option _FS_MINIMUM to _FS_MINIMIZE. +/ Dec 11,'06 R0.03a Improved cluster scan algorithm to write files fast. +/                   Fixed f_mkdir() creates incorrect directory on FAT32. +/ +/ Feb 04,'07 R0.04  Supported multiple drive system. +/                   Changed some interfaces for multiple drive system. +/                   Changed f_mountdrv() to f_mount(). +/                   Added f_mkfs(). +/ Apr 01,'07 R0.04a Supported multiple partitions on a physical drive. +/                   Added a capability of extending file size to f_lseek(). +/                   Added minimization level 3. +/                   Fixed an endian sensitive code in f_mkfs(). +/ May 05,'07 R0.04b Added a configuration option _USE_NTFLAG. +/                   Added FSInfo support. +/                   Fixed DBCS name can result FR_INVALID_NAME. +/                   Fixed short seek (<= csize) collapses the file object. +/ +/ Aug 25,'07 R0.05  Changed arguments of f_read(), f_write() and f_mkfs(). +/                   Fixed f_mkfs() on FAT32 creates incorrect FSInfo. +/                   Fixed f_mkdir() on FAT32 creates incorrect directory. +/ Feb 03,'08 R0.05a Added f_truncate() and f_utime(). +/                   Fixed off by one error at FAT sub-type determination. +/                   Fixed btr in f_read() can be mistruncated. +/                   Fixed cached sector is not flushed when create and close without write. +/ +/ Apr 01,'08 R0.06  Added fputc(), fputs(), fprintf() and fgets(). +/                   Improved performance of f_lseek() on moving to the same or following cluster. +/ +/ Apr 01,'09 R0.07  Merged Tiny-FatFs as a configuration option. (_FS_TINY) +/                   Added long file name feature. +/                   Added multiple code page feature. +/                   Added re-entrancy for multitask operation. +/                   Added auto cluster size selection to f_mkfs(). +/                   Added rewind option to f_readdir(). +/                   Changed result code of critical errors. +/                   Renamed string functions to avoid name collision. +/ Apr 14,'09 R0.07a Separated out OS dependent code on reentrant cfg. +/                   Added multiple sector size feature. +/ Jun 21,'09 R0.07c Fixed f_unlink() can return FR_OK on error. +/                   Fixed wrong cache control in f_lseek(). +/                   Added relative path feature. +/                   Added f_chdir() and f_chdrive(). +/                   Added proper case conversion to extended char. +/ Nov 03,'09 R0.07e Separated out configuration options from ff.h to ffconf.h. +/                   Fixed f_unlink() fails to remove a sub-dir on _FS_RPATH. +/                   Fixed name matching error on the 13 char boundary. +/                   Added a configuration option, _LFN_UNICODE. +/                   Changed f_readdir() to return the SFN with always upper case on non-LFN cfg. +/ +/ May 15,'10 R0.08  Added a memory configuration option. (_USE_LFN = 3) +/                   Added file lock feature. (_FS_SHARE) +/                   Added fast seek feature. (_USE_FASTSEEK) +/                   Changed some types on the API, XCHAR->TCHAR. +/                   Changed fname member in the FILINFO structure on Unicode cfg. +/                   String functions support UTF-8 encoding files on Unicode cfg. +/ Aug 16,'10 R0.08a Added f_getcwd(). (_FS_RPATH = 2) +/                   Added sector erase feature. (_USE_ERASE) +/                   Moved file lock semaphore table from fs object to the bss. +/                   Fixed a wrong directory entry is created on non-LFN cfg when the given name contains ';'. +/                   Fixed f_mkfs() creates wrong FAT32 volume. +/ Jan 15,'11 R0.08b Fast seek feature is also applied to f_read() and f_write(). +/                   f_lseek() reports required table size on creating CLMP. +/                   Extended format syntax of f_printf function. +/                   Ignores duplicated directory separators in given path name. +/ +/ Sep 06,'11 R0.09  f_mkfs() supports multiple partition to finish the multiple partition feature. +/                   Added f_fdisk(). (_MULTI_PARTITION = 2) +/ Aug 27,'12 R0.09a Fixed assertion failure due to OS/2 EA on FAT12/16 volume. +/                   Changed f_open() and f_opendir reject null object pointer to avoid crash. +/                   Changed option name _FS_SHARE to _FS_LOCK. +/---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#include "ff.h"			/* FatFs configurations and declarations */ +#include "diskio.h"		/* Declarations of low level disk I/O functions */ + + +/*-------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +   Module Private Definitions + +---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#if _FATFS != 4004	/* Revision ID */ +#error Wrong include file (ff.h). +#endif + + +/* Definitions on sector size */ +#if _MAX_SS != 512 && _MAX_SS != 1024 && _MAX_SS != 2048 && _MAX_SS != 4096 +#error Wrong sector size. +#endif +#if _MAX_SS != 512 +#define	SS(fs)	((fs)->ssize)	/* Variable sector size */ +#else +#define	SS(fs)	512U			/* Fixed sector size */ +#endif + + +/* Reentrancy related */ +#if _FS_REENTRANT +#if _USE_LFN == 1 +#error Static LFN work area must not be used in re-entrant configuration. +#endif +#define	ENTER_FF(fs)		{ if (!lock_fs(fs)) return FR_TIMEOUT; } +#define	LEAVE_FF(fs, res)	{ unlock_fs(fs, res); return res; } +#else +#define	ENTER_FF(fs) +#define LEAVE_FF(fs, res)	return res +#endif + +#define	ABORT(fs, res)		{ fp->flag |= FA__ERROR; LEAVE_FF(fs, res); } + + +/* File access control feature */ +#if _FS_LOCK +#if _FS_READONLY +#error _FS_LOCK must be 0 on read-only cfg. +#endif +typedef struct { +	FATFS *fs;				/* File ID 1, volume (NULL:blank entry) */ +	DWORD clu;				/* File ID 2, directory */ +	WORD idx;				/* File ID 3, directory index */ +	WORD ctr;				/* File open counter, 0:none, 0x01..0xFF:read open count, 0x100:write mode */ +} FILESEM; +#endif + + + +/* DBCS code ranges and SBCS extend char conversion table */ + +#if _CODE_PAGE == 932	/* Japanese Shift-JIS */ +#define _DF1S	0x81	/* DBC 1st byte range 1 start */ +#define _DF1E	0x9F	/* DBC 1st byte range 1 end */ +#define _DF2S	0xE0	/* DBC 1st byte range 2 start */ +#define _DF2E	0xFC	/* DBC 1st byte range 2 end */ +#define _DS1S	0x40	/* DBC 2nd byte range 1 start */ +#define _DS1E	0x7E	/* DBC 2nd byte range 1 end */ +#define _DS2S	0x80	/* DBC 2nd byte range 2 start */ +#define _DS2E	0xFC	/* DBC 2nd byte range 2 end */ + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 936	/* Simplified Chinese GBK */ +#define _DF1S	0x81 +#define _DF1E	0xFE +#define _DS1S	0x40 +#define _DS1E	0x7E +#define _DS2S	0x80 +#define _DS2E	0xFE + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 949	/* Korean */ +#define _DF1S	0x81 +#define _DF1E	0xFE +#define _DS1S	0x41 +#define _DS1E	0x5A +#define _DS2S	0x61 +#define _DS2E	0x7A +#define _DS3S	0x81 +#define _DS3E	0xFE + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 950	/* Traditional Chinese Big5 */ +#define _DF1S	0x81 +#define _DF1E	0xFE +#define _DS1S	0x40 +#define _DS1E	0x7E +#define _DS2S	0xA1 +#define _DS2E	0xFE + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 437	/* U.S. (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x9A,0x90,0x41,0x8E,0x41,0x8F,0x80,0x45,0x45,0x45,0x49,0x49,0x49,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0x4F,0x99,0x4F,0x55,0x55,0x59,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ +				0x41,0x49,0x4F,0x55,0xA5,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0x21,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE4,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE8,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 720	/* Arabic (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x45,0x41,0x84,0x41,0x86,0x43,0x45,0x45,0x45,0x49,0x49,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x49,0x49,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ +				0xA0,0xA1,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE4,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE8,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 737	/* Greek (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87, \ +				0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0xAA,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0x97,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xE4,0xED,0xEE,0xE7,0xE8,0xF1,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 775	/* Baltic (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x9A,0x91,0xA0,0x8E,0x95,0x8F,0x80,0xAD,0xED,0x8A,0x8A,0xA1,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0xE2,0x99,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x97,0x99,0x9A,0x9D,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ +				0xA0,0xA1,0xE0,0xA3,0xA3,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xBD,0xBE,0xC6,0xC7,0xA5,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE5,0xE5,0xE6,0xE3,0xE8,0xE8,0xEA,0xEA,0xEE,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 850	/* Multilingual Latin 1 (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x9A,0x90,0xB6,0x8E,0xB7,0x8F,0x80,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD8,0xD7,0xDE,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0xE2,0x99,0xE3,0xEA,0xEB,0x59,0x99,0x9A,0x9D,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ +				0xB5,0xD6,0xE0,0xE9,0xA5,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0x21,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC7,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE5,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE7,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xED,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 852	/* Latin 2 (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x9A,0x90,0xB6,0x8E,0xDE,0x8F,0x80,0x9D,0xD3,0x8A,0x8A,0xD7,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x91,0xE2,0x99,0x95,0x95,0x97,0x97,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9B,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ +				0xB5,0xD6,0xE0,0xE9,0xA4,0xA4,0xA6,0xA6,0xA8,0xA8,0xAA,0x8D,0xAC,0xB8,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBD,0xBF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC6,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD1,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD2,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xB7,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE3,0xD5,0xE6,0xE6,0xE8,0xE9,0xE8,0xEB,0xED,0xED,0xDD,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xEB,0xFC,0xFC,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 855	/* Cyrillic (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x81,0x81,0x83,0x83,0x85,0x85,0x87,0x87,0x89,0x89,0x8B,0x8B,0x8D,0x8D,0x8F,0x8F,0x91,0x91,0x93,0x93,0x95,0x95,0x97,0x97,0x99,0x99,0x9B,0x9B,0x9D,0x9D,0x9F,0x9F, \ +				0xA1,0xA1,0xA3,0xA3,0xA5,0xA5,0xA7,0xA7,0xA9,0xA9,0xAB,0xAB,0xAD,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB6,0xB6,0xB8,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBE,0xBE,0xBF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC7,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD1,0xD1,0xD3,0xD3,0xD5,0xD5,0xD7,0xD7,0xDD,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xE0,0xDF, \ +				0xE0,0xE2,0xE2,0xE4,0xE4,0xE6,0xE6,0xE8,0xE8,0xEA,0xEA,0xEC,0xEC,0xEE,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF2,0xF2,0xF4,0xF4,0xF6,0xF6,0xF8,0xF8,0xFA,0xFA,0xFC,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 857	/* Turkish (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x9A,0x90,0xB6,0x8E,0xB7,0x8F,0x80,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD8,0xD7,0x98,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0xE2,0x99,0xE3,0xEA,0xEB,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9D,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9E, \ +				0xB5,0xD6,0xE0,0xE9,0xA5,0xA5,0xA6,0xA6,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0x21,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC7,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE5,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE8,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xDE,0x59,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 858	/* Multilingual Latin 1 + Euro (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x9A,0x90,0xB6,0x8E,0xB7,0x8F,0x80,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD8,0xD7,0xDE,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x92,0x92,0xE2,0x99,0xE3,0xEA,0xEB,0x59,0x99,0x9A,0x9D,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ +				0xB5,0xD6,0xE0,0xE9,0xA5,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0x21,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC7,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD1,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE5,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE7,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xED,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 862	/* Hebrew (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ +				0x41,0x49,0x4F,0x55,0xA5,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0x21,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE4,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE8,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 866	/* Russian (OEM) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ +				0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x9d,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F,0xF0,0xF0,0xF2,0xF2,0xF4,0xF4,0xF6,0xF6,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 874	/* Thai (OEM, Windows) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ +				0xA0,0xA1,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE4,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE8,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1250 /* Central Europe (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x8A,0x9B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F, \ +				0xA0,0xA1,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xA3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xA5,0xAA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBC,0xAF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xF7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1251 /* Cyrillic (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x82,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x80,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x8A,0x9B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F, \ +				0xA0,0xA2,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB2,0xA5,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xA8,0xB9,0xAA,0xBB,0xA3,0xBD,0xBD,0xAF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1252 /* Latin 1 (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0xAd,0x9B,0x8C,0x9D,0xAE,0x9F, \ +				0xA0,0x21,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xF7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0x9F} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1253 /* Greek (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ +				0xA0,0xA1,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xA2,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA, \ +				0xE0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xF2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xFB,0xBC,0xFD,0xBF,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1254 /* Turkish (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x8A,0x9B,0x8C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ +				0xA0,0x21,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xF7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0x9F} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1255 /* Hebrew (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ +				0xA0,0x21,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0xE0,0xE1,0xE2,0xE3,0xE4,0xE5,0xE6,0xE7,0xE8,0xE9,0xEA,0xEB,0xEC,0xED,0xEE,0xEF,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0xF4,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0xF9,0xFA,0xFB,0xFC,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1256 /* Arabic (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x8C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ +				0xA0,0xA1,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0x41,0xE1,0x41,0xE3,0xE4,0xE5,0xE6,0x43,0x45,0x45,0x45,0x45,0xEC,0xED,0x49,0x49,0xF0,0xF1,0xF2,0xF3,0x4F,0xF5,0xF6,0xF7,0xF8,0x55,0xFA,0x55,0x55,0xFD,0xFE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1257 /* Baltic (Windows) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0x9C,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ +				0xA0,0xA1,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xA8,0xB9,0xAA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xAF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xF7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xFF} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1258 /* Vietnam (OEM, Windows) */ +#define _DF1S	0 +#define _EXCVT {0x80,0x81,0x82,0x83,0x84,0x85,0x86,0x87,0x88,0x89,0x8A,0x8B,0x8C,0x8D,0x8E,0x8F,0x90,0x91,0x92,0x93,0x94,0x95,0x96,0x97,0x98,0x99,0x9A,0x9B,0xAC,0x9D,0x9E,0x9F, \ +				0xA0,0x21,0xA2,0xA3,0xA4,0xA5,0xA6,0xA7,0xA8,0xA9,0xAA,0xAB,0xAC,0xAD,0xAE,0xAF,0xB0,0xB1,0xB2,0xB3,0xB4,0xB5,0xB6,0xB7,0xB8,0xB9,0xBA,0xBB,0xBC,0xBD,0xBE,0xBF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xCC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xD2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xD7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xDE,0xDF, \ +				0xC0,0xC1,0xC2,0xC3,0xC4,0xC5,0xC6,0xC7,0xC8,0xC9,0xCA,0xCB,0xEC,0xCD,0xCE,0xCF,0xD0,0xD1,0xF2,0xD3,0xD4,0xD5,0xD6,0xF7,0xD8,0xD9,0xDA,0xDB,0xDC,0xDD,0xFE,0x9F} + +#elif _CODE_PAGE == 1	/* ASCII (for only non-LFN cfg) */ +#if _USE_LFN +#error Cannot use LFN feature without valid code page. +#endif +#define _DF1S	0 + +#else +#error Unknown code page + +#endif + + +/* Character code support macros */ +#define IsUpper(c)	(((c)>='A')&&((c)<='Z')) +#define IsLower(c)	(((c)>='a')&&((c)<='z')) +#define IsDigit(c)	(((c)>='0')&&((c)<='9')) + +#if _DF1S		/* Code page is DBCS */ + +#ifdef _DF2S	/* Two 1st byte areas */ +#define IsDBCS1(c)	(((BYTE)(c) >= _DF1S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DF1E) || ((BYTE)(c) >= _DF2S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DF2E)) +#else			/* One 1st byte area */ +#define IsDBCS1(c)	((BYTE)(c) >= _DF1S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DF1E) +#endif + +#ifdef _DS3S	/* Three 2nd byte areas */ +#define IsDBCS2(c)	(((BYTE)(c) >= _DS1S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DS1E) || ((BYTE)(c) >= _DS2S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DS2E) || ((BYTE)(c) >= _DS3S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DS3E)) +#else			/* Two 2nd byte areas */ +#define IsDBCS2(c)	(((BYTE)(c) >= _DS1S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DS1E) || ((BYTE)(c) >= _DS2S && (BYTE)(c) <= _DS2E)) +#endif + +#else			/* Code page is SBCS */ + +#define IsDBCS1(c)	0 +#define IsDBCS2(c)	0 + +#endif /* _DF1S */ + + +/* Name status flags */ +#define NS			11		/* Index of name status byte in fn[] */ +#define NS_LOSS		0x01	/* Out of 8.3 format */ +#define NS_LFN		0x02	/* Force to create LFN entry */ +#define NS_LAST		0x04	/* Last segment */ +#define NS_BODY		0x08	/* Lower case flag (body) */ +#define NS_EXT		0x10	/* Lower case flag (ext) */ +#define NS_DOT		0x20	/* Dot entry */ + + +/* FAT sub-type boundaries */ +/* Note that the FAT spec by Microsoft says 4085 but Windows works with 4087! */ +#define MIN_FAT16	4086	/* Minimum number of clusters for FAT16 */ +#define	MIN_FAT32	65526	/* Minimum number of clusters for FAT32 */ + + +/* FatFs refers the members in the FAT structures as byte array instead of +/ structure member because the structure is not binary compatible between +/ different platforms */ + +#define BS_jmpBoot			0	/* Jump instruction (3) */ +#define BS_OEMName			3	/* OEM name (8) */ +#define BPB_BytsPerSec		11	/* Sector size [byte] (2) */ +#define BPB_SecPerClus		13	/* Cluster size [sector] (1) */ +#define BPB_RsvdSecCnt		14	/* Size of reserved area [sector] (2) */ +#define BPB_NumFATs			16	/* Number of FAT copies (1) */ +#define BPB_RootEntCnt		17	/* Number of root dir entries for FAT12/16 (2) */ +#define BPB_TotSec16		19	/* Volume size [sector] (2) */ +#define BPB_Media			21	/* Media descriptor (1) */ +#define BPB_FATSz16			22	/* FAT size [sector] (2) */ +#define BPB_SecPerTrk		24	/* Track size [sector] (2) */ +#define BPB_NumHeads		26	/* Number of heads (2) */ +#define BPB_HiddSec			28	/* Number of special hidden sectors (4) */ +#define BPB_TotSec32		32	/* Volume size [sector] (4) */ +#define BS_DrvNum			36	/* Physical drive number (2) */ +#define BS_BootSig			38	/* Extended boot signature (1) */ +#define BS_VolID			39	/* Volume serial number (4) */ +#define BS_VolLab			43	/* Volume label (8) */ +#define BS_FilSysType		54	/* File system type (1) */ +#define BPB_FATSz32			36	/* FAT size [sector] (4) */ +#define BPB_ExtFlags		40	/* Extended flags (2) */ +#define BPB_FSVer			42	/* File system version (2) */ +#define BPB_RootClus		44	/* Root dir first cluster (4) */ +#define BPB_FSInfo			48	/* Offset of FSInfo sector (2) */ +#define BPB_BkBootSec		50	/* Offset of backup boot sector (2) */ +#define BS_DrvNum32			64	/* Physical drive number (2) */ +#define BS_BootSig32		66	/* Extended boot signature (1) */ +#define BS_VolID32			67	/* Volume serial number (4) */ +#define BS_VolLab32			71	/* Volume label (8) */ +#define BS_FilSysType32		82	/* File system type (1) */ +#define	FSI_LeadSig			0	/* FSI: Leading signature (4) */ +#define	FSI_StrucSig		484	/* FSI: Structure signature (4) */ +#define	FSI_Free_Count		488	/* FSI: Number of free clusters (4) */ +#define	FSI_Nxt_Free		492	/* FSI: Last allocated cluster (4) */ +#define MBR_Table			446	/* MBR: Partition table offset (2) */ +#define	SZ_PTE				16	/* MBR: Size of a partition table entry */ +#define BS_55AA				510	/* Boot sector signature (2) */ + +#define	DIR_Name			0	/* Short file name (11) */ +#define	DIR_Attr			11	/* Attribute (1) */ +#define	DIR_NTres			12	/* NT flag (1) */ +#define DIR_CrtTimeTenth	13	/* Created time sub-second (1) */ +#define	DIR_CrtTime			14	/* Created time (2) */ +#define	DIR_CrtDate			16	/* Created date (2) */ +#define DIR_LstAccDate		18	/* Last accessed date (2) */ +#define	DIR_FstClusHI		20	/* Higher 16-bit of first cluster (2) */ +#define	DIR_WrtTime			22	/* Modified time (2) */ +#define	DIR_WrtDate			24	/* Modified date (2) */ +#define	DIR_FstClusLO		26	/* Lower 16-bit of first cluster (2) */ +#define	DIR_FileSize		28	/* File size (4) */ +#define	LDIR_Ord			0	/* LFN entry order and LLE flag (1) */ +#define	LDIR_Attr			11	/* LFN attribute (1) */ +#define	LDIR_Type			12	/* LFN type (1) */ +#define	LDIR_Chksum			13	/* Sum of corresponding SFN entry */ +#define	LDIR_FstClusLO		26	/* Filled by zero (0) */ +#define	SZ_DIR				32		/* Size of a directory entry */ +#define	LLE					0x40	/* Last long entry flag in LDIR_Ord */ +#define	DDE					0xE5	/* Deleted directory entry mark in DIR_Name[0] */ +#define	NDDE				0x05	/* Replacement of the character collides with DDE */ + + +/*------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Module private work area                                   */ +/*------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Note that uninitialized variables with static duration are +/  zeroed/nulled at start-up. If not, the compiler or start-up +/  routine is out of ANSI-C standard. +*/ + +#if _VOLUMES +static +FATFS *FatFs[_VOLUMES];	/* Pointer to the file system objects (logical drives) */ +#else +#error Number of volumes must not be 0. +#endif + +static +WORD Fsid;				/* File system mount ID */ + +#if _FS_RPATH +static +BYTE CurrVol;			/* Current drive */ +#endif + +#if _FS_LOCK +static +FILESEM	Files[_FS_LOCK];	/* File lock semaphores */ +#endif + +#if _USE_LFN == 0			/* No LFN feature */ +#define	DEF_NAMEBUF			BYTE sfn[12] +#define INIT_BUF(dobj)		(dobj).fn = sfn +#define	FREE_BUF() + +#elif _USE_LFN == 1			/* LFN feature with static working buffer */ +static WCHAR LfnBuf[_MAX_LFN+1]; +#define	DEF_NAMEBUF			BYTE sfn[12] +#define INIT_BUF(dobj)		{ (dobj).fn = sfn; (dobj).lfn = LfnBuf; } +#define	FREE_BUF() + +#elif _USE_LFN == 2 		/* LFN feature with dynamic working buffer on the stack */ +#define	DEF_NAMEBUF			BYTE sfn[12]; WCHAR lbuf[_MAX_LFN+1] +#define INIT_BUF(dobj)		{ (dobj).fn = sfn; (dobj).lfn = lbuf; } +#define	FREE_BUF() + +#elif _USE_LFN == 3 		/* LFN feature with dynamic working buffer on the heap */ +#define	DEF_NAMEBUF			BYTE sfn[12]; WCHAR *lfn +#define INIT_BUF(dobj)		{ lfn = ff_memalloc((_MAX_LFN + 1) * 2); \ +							  if (!lfn) LEAVE_FF((dobj).fs, FR_NOT_ENOUGH_CORE); \ +							  (dobj).lfn = lfn;	(dobj).fn = sfn; } +#define	FREE_BUF()			ff_memfree(lfn) + +#else +#error Wrong LFN configuration. +#endif + + + + +/*-------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +   Module Private Functions + +---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* String functions                                                      */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +/* Copy memory to memory */ +static +void mem_cpy (void* dst, const void* src, UINT cnt) { +	BYTE *d = (BYTE*)dst; +	const BYTE *s = (const BYTE*)src; + +#if _WORD_ACCESS == 1 +	while (cnt >= sizeof (int)) { +		*(int*)d = *(int*)s; +		d += sizeof (int); s += sizeof (int); +		cnt -= sizeof (int); +	} +#endif +	while (cnt--) +		*d++ = *s++; +} + +/* Fill memory */ +static +void mem_set (void* dst, int val, UINT cnt) { +	BYTE *d = (BYTE*)dst; + +	while (cnt--) +		*d++ = (BYTE)val; +} + +/* Compare memory to memory */ +static +int mem_cmp (const void* dst, const void* src, UINT cnt) { +	const BYTE *d = (const BYTE *)dst, *s = (const BYTE *)src; +	int r = 0; + +	while (cnt-- && (r = *d++ - *s++) == 0) ; +	return r; +} + +/* Check if chr is contained in the string */ +static +int chk_chr (const char* str, int chr) { +	while (*str && *str != chr) str++; +	return *str; +} + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Request/Release grant to access the volume                            */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _FS_REENTRANT + +static +int lock_fs ( +	FATFS *fs		/* File system object */ +) +{ +	return ff_req_grant(fs->sobj); +} + + +static +void unlock_fs ( +	FATFS *fs,		/* File system object */ +	FRESULT res		/* Result code to be returned */ +) +{ +	if (fs && +		res != FR_NOT_ENABLED && +		res != FR_INVALID_DRIVE && +		res != FR_INVALID_OBJECT && +		res != FR_TIMEOUT) { +		ff_rel_grant(fs->sobj); +	} +} +#endif + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* File lock control functions                                           */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _FS_LOCK + +static +FRESULT chk_lock (	/* Check if the file can be accessed */ +	DIR* dj,		/* Directory object pointing the file to be checked */ +	int acc			/* Desired access (0:Read, 1:Write, 2:Delete/Rename) */ +) +{ +	UINT i, be; + +	/* Search file semaphore table */ +	for (i = be = 0; i < _FS_LOCK; i++) { +		if (Files[i].fs) {	/* Existing entry */ +			if (Files[i].fs == dj->fs &&	 	/* Check if the file matched with an open file */ +				Files[i].clu == dj->sclust && +				Files[i].idx == dj->index) break; +		} else {			/* Blank entry */ +			be++; +		} +	} +	if (i == _FS_LOCK)	/* The file is not opened */ +		return (be || acc == 2) ? FR_OK : FR_TOO_MANY_OPEN_FILES;	/* Is there a blank entry for new file? */ + +	/* The file has been opened. Reject any open against writing file and all write mode open */ +	return (acc || Files[i].ctr == 0x100) ? FR_LOCKED : FR_OK; +} + + +static +int enq_lock (void)	/* Check if an entry is available for a new file */ +{ +	UINT i; + +	for (i = 0; i < _FS_LOCK && Files[i].fs; i++) ; +	return (i == _FS_LOCK) ? 0 : 1; +} + + +static +UINT inc_lock (	/* Increment file open counter and returns its index (0:int error) */ +	DIR* dj,	/* Directory object pointing the file to register or increment */ +	int acc		/* Desired access mode (0:Read, !0:Write) */ +) +{ +	UINT i; + + +	for (i = 0; i < _FS_LOCK; i++) {	/* Find the file */ +		if (Files[i].fs == dj->fs && +			Files[i].clu == dj->sclust && +			Files[i].idx == dj->index) break; +	} + +	if (i == _FS_LOCK) {				/* Not opened. Register it as new. */ +		for (i = 0; i < _FS_LOCK && Files[i].fs; i++) ; +		if (i == _FS_LOCK) return 0;	/* No space to register (int err) */ +		Files[i].fs = dj->fs; +		Files[i].clu = dj->sclust; +		Files[i].idx = dj->index; +		Files[i].ctr = 0; +	} + +	if (acc && Files[i].ctr) return 0;	/* Access violation (int err) */ + +	Files[i].ctr = acc ? 0x100 : Files[i].ctr + 1;	/* Set semaphore value */ + +	return i + 1; +} + + +static +FRESULT dec_lock (	/* Decrement file open counter */ +	UINT i			/* Semaphore index */ +) +{ +	WORD n; +	FRESULT res; + + +	if (--i < _FS_LOCK) { +		n = Files[i].ctr; +		if (n == 0x100) n = 0; +		if (n) n--; +		Files[i].ctr = n; +		if (!n) Files[i].fs = 0; +		res = FR_OK; +	} else { +		res = FR_INT_ERR; +	} +	return res; +} + + +static +void clear_lock (	/* Clear lock entries of the volume */ +	FATFS *fs +) +{ +	UINT i; + +	for (i = 0; i < _FS_LOCK; i++) { +		if (Files[i].fs == fs) Files[i].fs = 0; +	} +} +#endif + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Change window offset                                                  */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT move_window ( +	FATFS *fs,		/* File system object */ +	DWORD sector	/* Sector number to make appearance in the fs->win[] */ +)					/* Move to zero only writes back dirty window */ +{ +	DWORD wsect; + + +	wsect = fs->winsect; +	if (wsect != sector) {	/* Changed current window */ +#if !_FS_READONLY +		if (fs->wflag) {	/* Write back dirty window if needed */ +			if (disk_write(fs->drv, fs->win, wsect, 1) != RES_OK) +				return FR_DISK_ERR; +			fs->wflag = 0; +			if (wsect < (fs->fatbase + fs->fsize)) {	/* In FAT area */ +				BYTE nf; +				for (nf = fs->n_fats; nf > 1; nf--) {	/* Reflect the change to all FAT copies */ +					wsect += fs->fsize; +					disk_write(fs->drv, fs->win, wsect, 1); +				} +			} +		} +#endif +		if (sector) { +			if (disk_read(fs->drv, fs->win, sector, 1) != RES_OK) +				return FR_DISK_ERR; +			fs->winsect = sector; +		} +	} + +	return FR_OK; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Clean-up cached data                                                  */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if !_FS_READONLY +static +FRESULT sync (	/* FR_OK: successful, FR_DISK_ERR: failed */ +	FATFS *fs	/* File system object */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; + + +	res = move_window(fs, 0); +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		/* Update FSInfo sector if needed */ +		if (fs->fs_type == FS_FAT32 && fs->fsi_flag) { +			fs->winsect = 0; +			/* Create FSInfo structure */ +			mem_set(fs->win, 0, 512); +			ST_WORD(fs->win+BS_55AA, 0xAA55); +			ST_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_LeadSig, 0x41615252); +			ST_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_StrucSig, 0x61417272); +			ST_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_Free_Count, fs->free_clust); +			ST_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_Nxt_Free, fs->last_clust); +			/* Write it into the FSInfo sector */ +			disk_write(fs->drv, fs->win, fs->fsi_sector, 1); +			fs->fsi_flag = 0; +		} +		/* Make sure that no pending write process in the physical drive */ +		if (disk_ioctl(fs->drv, CTRL_SYNC, 0) != RES_OK) +			res = FR_DISK_ERR; +	} + +	return res; +} +#endif + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Get sector# from cluster#                                             */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + + +DWORD clust2sect (	/* !=0: Sector number, 0: Failed - invalid cluster# */ +	FATFS *fs,		/* File system object */ +	DWORD clst		/* Cluster# to be converted */ +) +{ +	clst -= 2; +	if (clst >= (fs->n_fatent - 2)) return 0;		/* Invalid cluster# */ +	return clst * fs->csize + fs->database; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* FAT access - Read value of a FAT entry                                */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + + +DWORD get_fat (	/* 0xFFFFFFFF:Disk error, 1:Internal error, Else:Cluster status */ +	FATFS *fs,	/* File system object */ +	DWORD clst	/* Cluster# to get the link information */ +) +{ +	UINT wc, bc; +	BYTE *p; + + +	if (clst < 2 || clst >= fs->n_fatent)	/* Check range */ +		return 1; + +	switch (fs->fs_type) { +	case FS_FAT12 : +		bc = (UINT)clst; bc += bc / 2; +		if (move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (bc / SS(fs)))) break; +		wc = fs->win[bc % SS(fs)]; bc++; +		if (move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (bc / SS(fs)))) break; +		wc |= fs->win[bc % SS(fs)] << 8; +		return (clst & 1) ? (wc >> 4) : (wc & 0xFFF); + +	case FS_FAT16 : +		if (move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (clst / (SS(fs) / 2)))) break; +		p = &fs->win[clst * 2 % SS(fs)]; +		return LD_WORD(p); + +	case FS_FAT32 : +		if (move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (clst / (SS(fs) / 4)))) break; +		p = &fs->win[clst * 4 % SS(fs)]; +		return LD_DWORD(p) & 0x0FFFFFFF; +	} + +	return 0xFFFFFFFF;	/* An error occurred at the disk I/O layer */ +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* FAT access - Change value of a FAT entry                              */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if !_FS_READONLY + +FRESULT put_fat ( +	FATFS *fs,	/* File system object */ +	DWORD clst,	/* Cluster# to be changed in range of 2 to fs->n_fatent - 1 */ +	DWORD val	/* New value to mark the cluster */ +) +{ +	UINT bc; +	BYTE *p; +	FRESULT res; + + +	if (clst < 2 || clst >= fs->n_fatent) {	/* Check range */ +		res = FR_INT_ERR; + +	} else { +		switch (fs->fs_type) { +		case FS_FAT12 : +			bc = (UINT)clst; bc += bc / 2; +			res = move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (bc / SS(fs))); +			if (res != FR_OK) break; +			p = &fs->win[bc % SS(fs)]; +			*p = (clst & 1) ? ((*p & 0x0F) | ((BYTE)val << 4)) : (BYTE)val; +			bc++; +			fs->wflag = 1; +			res = move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (bc / SS(fs))); +			if (res != FR_OK) break; +			p = &fs->win[bc % SS(fs)]; +			*p = (clst & 1) ? (BYTE)(val >> 4) : ((*p & 0xF0) | ((BYTE)(val >> 8) & 0x0F)); +			break; + +		case FS_FAT16 : +			res = move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (clst / (SS(fs) / 2))); +			if (res != FR_OK) break; +			p = &fs->win[clst * 2 % SS(fs)]; +			ST_WORD(p, (WORD)val); +			break; + +		case FS_FAT32 : +			res = move_window(fs, fs->fatbase + (clst / (SS(fs) / 4))); +			if (res != FR_OK) break; +			p = &fs->win[clst * 4 % SS(fs)]; +			val |= LD_DWORD(p) & 0xF0000000; +			ST_DWORD(p, val); +			break; + +		default : +			res = FR_INT_ERR; +		} +		fs->wflag = 1; +	} + +	return res; +} +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* FAT handling - Remove a cluster chain                                 */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if !_FS_READONLY +static +FRESULT remove_chain ( +	FATFS *fs,			/* File system object */ +	DWORD clst			/* Cluster# to remove a chain from */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	DWORD nxt; +#if _USE_ERASE +	DWORD scl = clst, ecl = clst, rt[2]; +#endif + +	if (clst < 2 || clst >= fs->n_fatent) {	/* Check range */ +		res = FR_INT_ERR; + +	} else { +		res = FR_OK; +		while (clst < fs->n_fatent) {			/* Not a last link? */ +			nxt = get_fat(fs, clst);			/* Get cluster status */ +			if (nxt == 0) break;				/* Empty cluster? */ +			if (nxt == 1) { res = FR_INT_ERR; break; }	/* Internal error? */ +			if (nxt == 0xFFFFFFFF) { res = FR_DISK_ERR; break; }	/* Disk error? */ +			res = put_fat(fs, clst, 0);			/* Mark the cluster "empty" */ +			if (res != FR_OK) break; +			if (fs->free_clust != 0xFFFFFFFF) {	/* Update FSInfo */ +				fs->free_clust++; +				fs->fsi_flag = 1; +			} +#if _USE_ERASE +			if (ecl + 1 == nxt) {	/* Is next cluster contiguous? */ +				ecl = nxt; +			} else {				/* End of contiguous clusters */  +				rt[0] = clust2sect(fs, scl);					/* Start sector */ +				rt[1] = clust2sect(fs, ecl) + fs->csize - 1;	/* End sector */ +				disk_ioctl(fs->drv, CTRL_ERASE_SECTOR, rt);		/* Erase the block */ +				scl = ecl = nxt; +			} +#endif +			clst = nxt;	/* Next cluster */ +		} +	} + +	return res; +} +#endif + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* FAT handling - Stretch or Create a cluster chain                      */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if !_FS_READONLY +static +DWORD create_chain (	/* 0:No free cluster, 1:Internal error, 0xFFFFFFFF:Disk error, >=2:New cluster# */ +	FATFS *fs,			/* File system object */ +	DWORD clst			/* Cluster# to stretch. 0 means create a new chain. */ +) +{ +	DWORD cs, ncl, scl; +	FRESULT res; + + +	if (clst == 0) {		/* Create a new chain */ +		scl = fs->last_clust;			/* Get suggested start point */ +		if (!scl || scl >= fs->n_fatent) scl = 1; +	} +	else {					/* Stretch the current chain */ +		cs = get_fat(fs, clst);			/* Check the cluster status */ +		if (cs < 2) return 1;			/* It is an invalid cluster */ +		if (cs < fs->n_fatent) return cs;	/* It is already followed by next cluster */ +		scl = clst; +	} + +	ncl = scl;				/* Start cluster */ +	for (;;) { +		ncl++;							/* Next cluster */ +		if (ncl >= fs->n_fatent) {		/* Wrap around */ +			ncl = 2; +			if (ncl > scl) return 0;	/* No free cluster */ +		} +		cs = get_fat(fs, ncl);			/* Get the cluster status */ +		if (cs == 0) break;				/* Found a free cluster */ +		if (cs == 0xFFFFFFFF || cs == 1)/* An error occurred */ +			return cs; +		if (ncl == scl) return 0;		/* No free cluster */ +	} + +	res = put_fat(fs, ncl, 0x0FFFFFFF);	/* Mark the new cluster "last link" */ +	if (res == FR_OK && clst != 0) { +		res = put_fat(fs, clst, ncl);	/* Link it to the previous one if needed */ +	} +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		fs->last_clust = ncl;			/* Update FSINFO */ +		if (fs->free_clust != 0xFFFFFFFF) { +			fs->free_clust--; +			fs->fsi_flag = 1; +		} +	} else { +		ncl = (res == FR_DISK_ERR) ? 0xFFFFFFFF : 1; +	} + +	return ncl;		/* Return new cluster number or error code */ +} +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* FAT handling - Convert offset into cluster with link map table        */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#if _USE_FASTSEEK +static +DWORD clmt_clust (	/* <2:Error, >=2:Cluster number */ +	FIL* fp,		/* Pointer to the file object */ +	DWORD ofs		/* File offset to be converted to cluster# */ +) +{ +	DWORD cl, ncl, *tbl; + + +	tbl = fp->cltbl + 1;	/* Top of CLMT */ +	cl = ofs / SS(fp->fs) / fp->fs->csize;	/* Cluster order from top of the file */ +	for (;;) { +		ncl = *tbl++;			/* Number of cluters in the fragment */ +		if (!ncl) return 0;		/* End of table? (error) */ +		if (cl < ncl) break;	/* In this fragment? */ +		cl -= ncl; tbl++;		/* Next fragment */ +	} +	return cl + *tbl;	/* Return the cluster number */ +} +#endif	/* _USE_FASTSEEK */ + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Directory handling - Set directory index                              */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT dir_sdi ( +	DIR *dj,		/* Pointer to directory object */ +	WORD idx		/* Index of directory table */ +) +{ +	DWORD clst; +	WORD ic; + + +	dj->index = idx; +	clst = dj->sclust; +	if (clst == 1 || clst >= dj->fs->n_fatent)	/* Check start cluster range */ +		return FR_INT_ERR; +	if (!clst && dj->fs->fs_type == FS_FAT32)	/* Replace cluster# 0 with root cluster# if in FAT32 */ +		clst = dj->fs->dirbase; + +	if (clst == 0) {	/* Static table (root-dir in FAT12/16) */ +		dj->clust = clst; +		if (idx >= dj->fs->n_rootdir)		/* Index is out of range */ +			return FR_INT_ERR; +		dj->sect = dj->fs->dirbase + idx / (SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR);	/* Sector# */ +	} +	else {				/* Dynamic table (sub-dirs or root-dir in FAT32) */ +		ic = SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR * dj->fs->csize;	/* Entries per cluster */ +		while (idx >= ic) {	/* Follow cluster chain */ +			clst = get_fat(dj->fs, clst);				/* Get next cluster */ +			if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) return FR_DISK_ERR;	/* Disk error */ +			if (clst < 2 || clst >= dj->fs->n_fatent)	/* Reached to end of table or int error */ +				return FR_INT_ERR; +			idx -= ic; +		} +		dj->clust = clst; +		dj->sect = clust2sect(dj->fs, clst) + idx / (SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR);	/* Sector# */ +	} + +	dj->dir = dj->fs->win + (idx % (SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR)) * SZ_DIR;	/* Ptr to the entry in the sector */ + +	return FR_OK;	/* Seek succeeded */ +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Directory handling - Move directory table index next                  */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT dir_next (	/* FR_OK:Succeeded, FR_NO_FILE:End of table, FR_DENIED:EOT and could not stretch */ +	DIR *dj,		/* Pointer to directory object */ +	int stretch		/* 0: Do not stretch table, 1: Stretch table if needed */ +) +{ +	DWORD clst; +	WORD i; + + +	stretch = stretch;		/* To suppress warning on read-only cfg. */ +	i = dj->index + 1; +	if (!i || !dj->sect)	/* Report EOT when index has reached 65535 */ +		return FR_NO_FILE; + +	if (!(i % (SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR))) {	/* Sector changed? */ +		dj->sect++;					/* Next sector */ + +		if (dj->clust == 0) {	/* Static table */ +			if (i >= dj->fs->n_rootdir)	/* Report EOT when end of table */ +				return FR_NO_FILE; +		} +		else {					/* Dynamic table */ +			if (((i / (SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR)) & (dj->fs->csize - 1)) == 0) {	/* Cluster changed? */ +				clst = get_fat(dj->fs, dj->clust);				/* Get next cluster */ +				if (clst <= 1) return FR_INT_ERR; +				if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) return FR_DISK_ERR; +				if (clst >= dj->fs->n_fatent) {					/* When it reached end of dynamic table */ +#if !_FS_READONLY +					BYTE c; +					if (!stretch) return FR_NO_FILE;			/* When do not stretch, report EOT */ +					clst = create_chain(dj->fs, dj->clust);		/* Stretch cluster chain */ +					if (clst == 0) return FR_DENIED;			/* No free cluster */ +					if (clst == 1) return FR_INT_ERR; +					if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) return FR_DISK_ERR; +					/* Clean-up stretched table */ +					if (move_window(dj->fs, 0)) return FR_DISK_ERR;	/* Flush active window */ +					mem_set(dj->fs->win, 0, SS(dj->fs));			/* Clear window buffer */ +					dj->fs->winsect = clust2sect(dj->fs, clst);	/* Cluster start sector */ +					for (c = 0; c < dj->fs->csize; c++) {		/* Fill the new cluster with 0 */ +						dj->fs->wflag = 1; +						if (move_window(dj->fs, 0)) return FR_DISK_ERR; +						dj->fs->winsect++; +					} +					dj->fs->winsect -= c;						/* Rewind window address */ +#else +					return FR_NO_FILE;			/* Report EOT */ +#endif +				} +				dj->clust = clst;				/* Initialize data for new cluster */ +				dj->sect = clust2sect(dj->fs, clst); +			} +		} +	} + +	dj->index = i; +	dj->dir = dj->fs->win + (i % (SS(dj->fs) / SZ_DIR)) * SZ_DIR; + +	return FR_OK; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Directory handling - Load/Store start cluster number                  */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +DWORD ld_clust ( +	FATFS *fs,	/* Pointer to the fs object */ +	BYTE *dir	/* Pointer to the directory entry */ +) +{ +	DWORD cl; + +	cl = LD_WORD(dir+DIR_FstClusLO); +	if (fs->fs_type == FS_FAT32) +		cl |= (DWORD)LD_WORD(dir+DIR_FstClusHI) << 16; + +	return cl; +} + + +#if !_FS_READONLY +static +void st_clust ( +	BYTE *dir,	/* Pointer to the directory entry */ +	DWORD cl	/* Value to be set */ +) +{ +	ST_WORD(dir+DIR_FstClusLO, cl); +	ST_WORD(dir+DIR_FstClusHI, cl >> 16); +} +#endif + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* LFN handling - Test/Pick/Fit an LFN segment from/to directory entry   */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _USE_LFN +static +const BYTE LfnOfs[] = {1,3,5,7,9,14,16,18,20,22,24,28,30};	/* Offset of LFN chars in the directory entry */ + + +static +int cmp_lfn (			/* 1:Matched, 0:Not matched */ +	WCHAR *lfnbuf,		/* Pointer to the LFN to be compared */ +	BYTE *dir			/* Pointer to the directory entry containing a part of LFN */ +) +{ +	UINT i, s; +	WCHAR wc, uc; + + +	i = ((dir[LDIR_Ord] & ~LLE) - 1) * 13;	/* Get offset in the LFN buffer */ +	s = 0; wc = 1; +	do { +		uc = LD_WORD(dir+LfnOfs[s]);	/* Pick an LFN character from the entry */ +		if (wc) {	/* Last char has not been processed */ +			wc = ff_wtoupper(uc);		/* Convert it to upper case */ +			if (i >= _MAX_LFN || wc != ff_wtoupper(lfnbuf[i++]))	/* Compare it */ +				return 0;				/* Not matched */ +		} else { +			if (uc != 0xFFFF) return 0;	/* Check filler */ +		} +	} while (++s < 13);				/* Repeat until all chars in the entry are checked */ + +	if ((dir[LDIR_Ord] & LLE) && wc && lfnbuf[i])	/* Last segment matched but different length */ +		return 0; + +	return 1;						/* The part of LFN matched */ +} + + + +static +int pick_lfn (			/* 1:Succeeded, 0:Buffer overflow */ +	WCHAR *lfnbuf,		/* Pointer to the Unicode-LFN buffer */ +	BYTE *dir			/* Pointer to the directory entry */ +) +{ +	UINT i, s; +	WCHAR wc, uc; + + +	i = ((dir[LDIR_Ord] & 0x3F) - 1) * 13;	/* Offset in the LFN buffer */ + +	s = 0; wc = 1; +	do { +		uc = LD_WORD(dir+LfnOfs[s]);		/* Pick an LFN character from the entry */ +		if (wc) {	/* Last char has not been processed */ +			if (i >= _MAX_LFN) return 0;	/* Buffer overflow? */ +			lfnbuf[i++] = wc = uc;			/* Store it */ +		} else { +			if (uc != 0xFFFF) return 0;		/* Check filler */ +		} +	} while (++s < 13);						/* Read all character in the entry */ + +	if (dir[LDIR_Ord] & LLE) {				/* Put terminator if it is the last LFN part */ +		if (i >= _MAX_LFN) return 0;		/* Buffer overflow? */ +		lfnbuf[i] = 0; +	} + +	return 1; +} + + +#if !_FS_READONLY +static +void fit_lfn ( +	const WCHAR *lfnbuf,	/* Pointer to the LFN buffer */ +	BYTE *dir,				/* Pointer to the directory entry */ +	BYTE ord,				/* LFN order (1-20) */ +	BYTE sum				/* SFN sum */ +) +{ +	UINT i, s; +	WCHAR wc; + + +	dir[LDIR_Chksum] = sum;			/* Set check sum */ +	dir[LDIR_Attr] = AM_LFN;		/* Set attribute. LFN entry */ +	dir[LDIR_Type] = 0; +	ST_WORD(dir+LDIR_FstClusLO, 0); + +	i = (ord - 1) * 13;				/* Get offset in the LFN buffer */ +	s = wc = 0; +	do { +		if (wc != 0xFFFF) wc = lfnbuf[i++];	/* Get an effective char */ +		ST_WORD(dir+LfnOfs[s], wc);	/* Put it */ +		if (!wc) wc = 0xFFFF;		/* Padding chars following last char */ +	} while (++s < 13); +	if (wc == 0xFFFF || !lfnbuf[i]) ord |= LLE;	/* Bottom LFN part is the start of LFN sequence */ +	dir[LDIR_Ord] = ord;			/* Set the LFN order */ +} + +#endif +#endif + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Create numbered name                                                  */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _USE_LFN +void gen_numname ( +	BYTE *dst,			/* Pointer to generated SFN */ +	const BYTE *src,	/* Pointer to source SFN to be modified */ +	const WCHAR *lfn,	/* Pointer to LFN */ +	WORD seq			/* Sequence number */ +) +{ +	BYTE ns[8], c; +	UINT i, j; + + +	mem_cpy(dst, src, 11); + +	if (seq > 5) {	/* On many collisions, generate a hash number instead of sequential number */ +		do seq = (seq >> 1) + (seq << 15) + (WORD)*lfn++; while (*lfn); +	} + +	/* itoa (hexdecimal) */ +	i = 7; +	do { +		c = (seq % 16) + '0'; +		if (c > '9') c += 7; +		ns[i--] = c; +		seq /= 16; +	} while (seq); +	ns[i] = '~'; + +	/* Append the number */ +	for (j = 0; j < i && dst[j] != ' '; j++) { +		if (IsDBCS1(dst[j])) { +			if (j == i - 1) break; +			j++; +		} +	} +	do { +		dst[j++] = (i < 8) ? ns[i++] : ' '; +	} while (j < 8); +} +#endif + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Calculate sum of an SFN                                               */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _USE_LFN +static +BYTE sum_sfn ( +	const BYTE *dir		/* Ptr to directory entry */ +) +{ +	BYTE sum = 0; +	UINT n = 11; + +	do sum = (sum >> 1) + (sum << 7) + *dir++; while (--n); +	return sum; +} +#endif + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Directory handling - Find an object in the directory                  */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT dir_find ( +	DIR *dj			/* Pointer to the directory object linked to the file name */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	BYTE c, *dir; +#if _USE_LFN +	BYTE a, ord, sum; +#endif + +	res = dir_sdi(dj, 0);			/* Rewind directory object */ +	if (res != FR_OK) return res; + +#if _USE_LFN +	ord = sum = 0xFF; +#endif +	do { +		res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); +		if (res != FR_OK) break; +		dir = dj->dir;					/* Ptr to the directory entry of current index */ +		c = dir[DIR_Name]; +		if (c == 0) { res = FR_NO_FILE; break; }	/* Reached to end of table */ +#if _USE_LFN	/* LFN configuration */ +		a = dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_MASK; +		if (c == DDE || ((a & AM_VOL) && a != AM_LFN)) {	/* An entry without valid data */ +			ord = 0xFF; +		} else { +			if (a == AM_LFN) {			/* An LFN entry is found */ +				if (dj->lfn) { +					if (c & LLE) {		/* Is it start of LFN sequence? */ +						sum = dir[LDIR_Chksum]; +						c &= ~LLE; ord = c;	/* LFN start order */ +						dj->lfn_idx = dj->index; +					} +					/* Check validity of the LFN entry and compare it with given name */ +					ord = (c == ord && sum == dir[LDIR_Chksum] && cmp_lfn(dj->lfn, dir)) ? ord - 1 : 0xFF; +				} +			} else {					/* An SFN entry is found */ +				if (!ord && sum == sum_sfn(dir)) break;	/* LFN matched? */ +				ord = 0xFF; dj->lfn_idx = 0xFFFF;	/* Reset LFN sequence */ +				if (!(dj->fn[NS] & NS_LOSS) && !mem_cmp(dir, dj->fn, 11)) break;	/* SFN matched? */ +			} +		} +#else		/* Non LFN configuration */ +		if (!(dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_VOL) && !mem_cmp(dir, dj->fn, 11)) /* Is it a valid entry? */ +			break; +#endif +		res = dir_next(dj, 0);		/* Next entry */ +	} while (res == FR_OK); + +	return res; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Read an object from the directory                                     */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _FS_MINIMIZE <= 1 +static +FRESULT dir_read ( +	DIR *dj			/* Pointer to the directory object that pointing the entry to be read */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	BYTE c, *dir; +#if _USE_LFN +	BYTE a, ord = 0xFF, sum = 0xFF; +#endif + +	res = FR_NO_FILE; +	while (dj->sect) { +		res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); +		if (res != FR_OK) break; +		dir = dj->dir;					/* Ptr to the directory entry of current index */ +		c = dir[DIR_Name]; +		if (c == 0) { res = FR_NO_FILE; break; }	/* Reached to end of table */ +#if _USE_LFN	/* LFN configuration */ +		a = dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_MASK; +		if (c == DDE || (!_FS_RPATH && c == '.') || ((a & AM_VOL) && a != AM_LFN)) {	/* An entry without valid data */ +			ord = 0xFF; +		} else { +			if (a == AM_LFN) {			/* An LFN entry is found */ +				if (c & LLE) {			/* Is it start of LFN sequence? */ +					sum = dir[LDIR_Chksum]; +					c &= ~LLE; ord = c; +					dj->lfn_idx = dj->index; +				} +				/* Check LFN validity and capture it */ +				ord = (c == ord && sum == dir[LDIR_Chksum] && pick_lfn(dj->lfn, dir)) ? ord - 1 : 0xFF; +			} else {					/* An SFN entry is found */ +				if (ord || sum != sum_sfn(dir))	/* Is there a valid LFN? */ +					dj->lfn_idx = 0xFFFF;		/* It has no LFN. */ +				break; +			} +		} +#else		/* Non LFN configuration */ +		if (c != DDE && (_FS_RPATH || c != '.') && !(dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_VOL))	/* Is it a valid entry? */ +			break; +#endif +		res = dir_next(dj, 0);				/* Next entry */ +		if (res != FR_OK) break; +	} + +	if (res != FR_OK) dj->sect = 0; + +	return res; +} +#endif + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Register an object to the directory                                   */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if !_FS_READONLY +static +FRESULT dir_register (	/* FR_OK:Successful, FR_DENIED:No free entry or too many SFN collision, FR_DISK_ERR:Disk error */ +	DIR *dj				/* Target directory with object name to be created */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	BYTE c, *dir; +#if _USE_LFN	/* LFN configuration */ +	WORD n, ne, is; +	BYTE sn[12], *fn, sum; +	WCHAR *lfn; + + +	fn = dj->fn; lfn = dj->lfn; +	mem_cpy(sn, fn, 12); + +	if (_FS_RPATH && (sn[NS] & NS_DOT))		/* Cannot create dot entry */ +		return FR_INVALID_NAME; + +	if (sn[NS] & NS_LOSS) {			/* When LFN is out of 8.3 format, generate a numbered name */ +		fn[NS] = 0; dj->lfn = 0;			/* Find only SFN */ +		for (n = 1; n < 100; n++) { +			gen_numname(fn, sn, lfn, n);	/* Generate a numbered name */ +			res = dir_find(dj);				/* Check if the name collides with existing SFN */ +			if (res != FR_OK) break; +		} +		if (n == 100) return FR_DENIED;		/* Abort if too many collisions */ +		if (res != FR_NO_FILE) return res;	/* Abort if the result is other than 'not collided' */ +		fn[NS] = sn[NS]; dj->lfn = lfn; +	} + +	if (sn[NS] & NS_LFN) {			/* When LFN is to be created, reserve an SFN + LFN entries. */ +		for (ne = 0; lfn[ne]; ne++) ; +		ne = (ne + 25) / 13; +	} else {						/* Otherwise reserve only an SFN entry. */ +		ne = 1; +	} + +	/* Reserve contiguous entries */ +	res = dir_sdi(dj, 0); +	if (res != FR_OK) return res; +	n = is = 0; +	do { +		res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); +		if (res != FR_OK) break; +		c = *dj->dir;				/* Check the entry status */ +		if (c == DDE || c == 0) {	/* Is it a blank entry? */ +			if (n == 0) is = dj->index;	/* First index of the contiguous entry */ +			if (++n == ne) break;	/* A contiguous entry that required count is found */ +		} else { +			n = 0;					/* Not a blank entry. Restart to search */ +		} +		res = dir_next(dj, 1);		/* Next entry with table stretch */ +	} while (res == FR_OK); + +	if (res == FR_OK && ne > 1) {	/* Initialize LFN entry if needed */ +		res = dir_sdi(dj, is); +		if (res == FR_OK) { +			sum = sum_sfn(dj->fn);	/* Sum of the SFN tied to the LFN */ +			ne--; +			do {					/* Store LFN entries in bottom first */ +				res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); +				if (res != FR_OK) break; +				fit_lfn(dj->lfn, dj->dir, (BYTE)ne, sum); +				dj->fs->wflag = 1; +				res = dir_next(dj, 0);	/* Next entry */ +			} while (res == FR_OK && --ne); +		} +	} + +#else	/* Non LFN configuration */ +	res = dir_sdi(dj, 0); +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		do {	/* Find a blank entry for the SFN */ +			res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); +			if (res != FR_OK) break; +			c = *dj->dir; +			if (c == DDE || c == 0) break;	/* Is it a blank entry? */ +			res = dir_next(dj, 1);			/* Next entry with table stretch */ +		} while (res == FR_OK); +	} +#endif + +	if (res == FR_OK) {		/* Initialize the SFN entry */ +		res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); +		if (res == FR_OK) { +			dir = dj->dir; +			mem_set(dir, 0, SZ_DIR);	/* Clean the entry */ +			mem_cpy(dir, dj->fn, 11);	/* Put SFN */ +#if _USE_LFN +			dir[DIR_NTres] = *(dj->fn+NS) & (NS_BODY | NS_EXT);	/* Put NT flag */ +#endif +			dj->fs->wflag = 1; +		} +	} + +	return res; +} +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Remove an object from the directory                                   */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if !_FS_READONLY && !_FS_MINIMIZE +static +FRESULT dir_remove (	/* FR_OK: Successful, FR_DISK_ERR: A disk error */ +	DIR *dj				/* Directory object pointing the entry to be removed */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +#if _USE_LFN	/* LFN configuration */ +	WORD i; + +	i = dj->index;	/* SFN index */ +	res = dir_sdi(dj, (WORD)((dj->lfn_idx == 0xFFFF) ? i : dj->lfn_idx));	/* Goto the SFN or top of the LFN entries */ +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		do { +			res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); +			if (res != FR_OK) break; +			*dj->dir = DDE;			/* Mark the entry "deleted" */ +			dj->fs->wflag = 1; +			if (dj->index >= i) break;	/* When reached SFN, all entries of the object has been deleted. */ +			res = dir_next(dj, 0);		/* Next entry */ +		} while (res == FR_OK); +		if (res == FR_NO_FILE) res = FR_INT_ERR; +	} + +#else			/* Non LFN configuration */ +	res = dir_sdi(dj, dj->index); +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		res = move_window(dj->fs, dj->sect); +		if (res == FR_OK) { +			*dj->dir = DDE;			/* Mark the entry "deleted" */ +			dj->fs->wflag = 1; +		} +	} +#endif + +	return res; +} +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Pick a segment and create the object name in directory form           */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT create_name ( +	DIR *dj,			/* Pointer to the directory object */ +	const TCHAR **path	/* Pointer to pointer to the segment in the path string */ +) +{ +#ifdef _EXCVT +	static const BYTE excvt[] = _EXCVT;	/* Upper conversion table for extended chars */ +#endif + +#if _USE_LFN	/* LFN configuration */ +	BYTE b, cf; +	WCHAR w, *lfn; +	UINT i, ni, si, di; +	const TCHAR *p; + +	/* Create LFN in Unicode */ +	for (p = *path; *p == '/' || *p == '\\'; p++) ;	/* Strip duplicated separator */ +	lfn = dj->lfn; +	si = di = 0; +	for (;;) { +		w = p[si++];					/* Get a character */ +		if (w < ' ' || w == '/' || w == '\\') break;	/* Break on end of segment */ +		if (di >= _MAX_LFN)				/* Reject too long name */ +			return FR_INVALID_NAME; +#if !_LFN_UNICODE +		w &= 0xFF; +		if (IsDBCS1(w)) {				/* Check if it is a DBC 1st byte (always false on SBCS cfg) */ +			b = (BYTE)p[si++];			/* Get 2nd byte */ +			if (!IsDBCS2(b)) +				return FR_INVALID_NAME;	/* Reject invalid sequence */ +			w = (w << 8) + b;			/* Create a DBC */ +		} +		w = ff_convert(w, 1);			/* Convert ANSI/OEM to Unicode */ +		if (!w) return FR_INVALID_NAME;	/* Reject invalid code */ +#endif +		if (w < 0x80 && chk_chr("\"*:<>\?|\x7F", w)) /* Reject illegal chars for LFN */ +			return FR_INVALID_NAME; +		lfn[di++] = w;					/* Store the Unicode char */ +	} +	*path = &p[si];						/* Return pointer to the next segment */ +	cf = (w < ' ') ? NS_LAST : 0;		/* Set last segment flag if end of path */ +#if _FS_RPATH +	if ((di == 1 && lfn[di-1] == '.') || /* Is this a dot entry? */ +		(di == 2 && lfn[di-1] == '.' && lfn[di-2] == '.')) { +		lfn[di] = 0; +		for (i = 0; i < 11; i++) +			dj->fn[i] = (i < di) ? '.' : ' '; +		dj->fn[i] = cf | NS_DOT;		/* This is a dot entry */ +		return FR_OK; +	} +#endif +	while (di) {						/* Strip trailing spaces and dots */ +		w = lfn[di-1]; +		if (w != ' ' && w != '.') break; +		di--; +	} +	if (!di) return FR_INVALID_NAME;	/* Reject nul string */ + +	lfn[di] = 0;						/* LFN is created */ + +	/* Create SFN in directory form */ +	mem_set(dj->fn, ' ', 11); +	for (si = 0; lfn[si] == ' ' || lfn[si] == '.'; si++) ;	/* Strip leading spaces and dots */ +	if (si) cf |= NS_LOSS | NS_LFN; +	while (di && lfn[di - 1] != '.') di--;	/* Find extension (di<=si: no extension) */ + +	b = i = 0; ni = 8; +	for (;;) { +		w = lfn[si++];					/* Get an LFN char */ +		if (!w) break;					/* Break on end of the LFN */ +		if (w == ' ' || (w == '.' && si != di)) {	/* Remove spaces and dots */ +			cf |= NS_LOSS | NS_LFN; continue; +		} + +		if (i >= ni || si == di) {		/* Extension or end of SFN */ +			if (ni == 11) {				/* Long extension */ +				cf |= NS_LOSS | NS_LFN; break; +			} +			if (si != di) cf |= NS_LOSS | NS_LFN;	/* Out of 8.3 format */ +			if (si > di) break;			/* No extension */ +			si = di; i = 8; ni = 11;	/* Enter extension section */ +			b <<= 2; continue; +		} + +		if (w >= 0x80) {				/* Non ASCII char */ +#ifdef _EXCVT +			w = ff_convert(w, 0);		/* Unicode -> OEM code */ +			if (w) w = excvt[w - 0x80];	/* Convert extended char to upper (SBCS) */ +#else +			w = ff_convert(ff_wtoupper(w), 0);	/* Upper converted Unicode -> OEM code */ +#endif +			cf |= NS_LFN;				/* Force create LFN entry */ +		} + +		if (_DF1S && w >= 0x100) {		/* Double byte char (always false on SBCS cfg) */ +			if (i >= ni - 1) { +				cf |= NS_LOSS | NS_LFN; i = ni; continue; +			} +			dj->fn[i++] = (BYTE)(w >> 8); +		} else {						/* Single byte char */ +			if (!w || chk_chr("+,;=[]", w)) {	/* Replace illegal chars for SFN */ +				w = '_'; cf |= NS_LOSS | NS_LFN;/* Lossy conversion */ +			} else { +				if (IsUpper(w)) {		/* ASCII large capital */ +					b |= 2; +				} else { +					if (IsLower(w)) {	/* ASCII small capital */ +						b |= 1; w -= 0x20; +					} +				} +			} +		} +		dj->fn[i++] = (BYTE)w; +	} + +	if (dj->fn[0] == DDE) dj->fn[0] = NDDE;	/* If the first char collides with deleted mark, replace it with 0x05 */ + +	if (ni == 8) b <<= 2; +	if ((b & 0x0C) == 0x0C || (b & 0x03) == 0x03)	/* Create LFN entry when there are composite capitals */ +		cf |= NS_LFN; +	if (!(cf & NS_LFN)) {						/* When LFN is in 8.3 format without extended char, NT flags are created */ +		if ((b & 0x03) == 0x01) cf |= NS_EXT;	/* NT flag (Extension has only small capital) */ +		if ((b & 0x0C) == 0x04) cf |= NS_BODY;	/* NT flag (Filename has only small capital) */ +	} + +	dj->fn[NS] = cf;	/* SFN is created */ + +	return FR_OK; + + +#else	/* Non-LFN configuration */ +	BYTE b, c, d, *sfn; +	UINT ni, si, i; +	const char *p; + +	/* Create file name in directory form */ +	for (p = *path; *p == '/' || *p == '\\'; p++) ;	/* Strip duplicated separator */ +	sfn = dj->fn; +	mem_set(sfn, ' ', 11); +	si = i = b = 0; ni = 8; +#if _FS_RPATH +	if (p[si] == '.') { /* Is this a dot entry? */ +		for (;;) { +			c = (BYTE)p[si++]; +			if (c != '.' || si >= 3) break; +			sfn[i++] = c; +		} +		if (c != '/' && c != '\\' && c > ' ') return FR_INVALID_NAME; +		*path = &p[si];									/* Return pointer to the next segment */ +		sfn[NS] = (c <= ' ') ? NS_LAST | NS_DOT : NS_DOT;	/* Set last segment flag if end of path */ +		return FR_OK; +	} +#endif +	for (;;) { +		c = (BYTE)p[si++]; +		if (c <= ' ' || c == '/' || c == '\\') break;	/* Break on end of segment */ +		if (c == '.' || i >= ni) { +			if (ni != 8 || c != '.') return FR_INVALID_NAME; +			i = 8; ni = 11; +			b <<= 2; continue; +		} +		if (c >= 0x80) {				/* Extended char? */ +			b |= 3;						/* Eliminate NT flag */ +#ifdef _EXCVT +			c = excvt[c - 0x80];		/* Upper conversion (SBCS) */ +#else +#if !_DF1S	/* ASCII only cfg */ +			return FR_INVALID_NAME; +#endif +#endif +		} +		if (IsDBCS1(c)) {				/* Check if it is a DBC 1st byte (always false on SBCS cfg) */ +			d = (BYTE)p[si++];			/* Get 2nd byte */ +			if (!IsDBCS2(d) || i >= ni - 1)	/* Reject invalid DBC */ +				return FR_INVALID_NAME; +			sfn[i++] = c; +			sfn[i++] = d; +		} else {						/* Single byte code */ +			if (chk_chr("\"*+,:;<=>\?[]|\x7F", c))	/* Reject illegal chrs for SFN */ +				return FR_INVALID_NAME; +			if (IsUpper(c)) {			/* ASCII large capital? */ +				b |= 2; +			} else { +				if (IsLower(c)) {		/* ASCII small capital? */ +					b |= 1; c -= 0x20; +				} +			} +			sfn[i++] = c; +		} +	} +	*path = &p[si];						/* Return pointer to the next segment */ +	c = (c <= ' ') ? NS_LAST : 0;		/* Set last segment flag if end of path */ + +	if (!i) return FR_INVALID_NAME;		/* Reject nul string */ +	if (sfn[0] == DDE) sfn[0] = NDDE;	/* When first char collides with DDE, replace it with 0x05 */ + +	if (ni == 8) b <<= 2; +	if ((b & 0x03) == 0x01) c |= NS_EXT;	/* NT flag (Name extension has only small capital) */ +	if ((b & 0x0C) == 0x04) c |= NS_BODY;	/* NT flag (Name body has only small capital) */ + +	sfn[NS] = c;		/* Store NT flag, File name is created */ + +	return FR_OK; +#endif +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Get file information from directory entry                             */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _FS_MINIMIZE <= 1 +static +void get_fileinfo (		/* No return code */ +	DIR *dj,			/* Pointer to the directory object */ +	FILINFO *fno	 	/* Pointer to the file information to be filled */ +) +{ +	UINT i; +	BYTE nt, *dir; +	TCHAR *p, c; + + +	p = fno->fname; +	if (dj->sect) { +		dir = dj->dir; +		nt = dir[DIR_NTres];		/* NT flag */ +		for (i = 0; i < 8; i++) {	/* Copy name body */ +			c = dir[i]; +			if (c == ' ') break; +			if (c == NDDE) c = (TCHAR)DDE; +			if (_USE_LFN && (nt & NS_BODY) && IsUpper(c)) c += 0x20; +#if _LFN_UNICODE +			if (IsDBCS1(c) && i < 7 && IsDBCS2(dir[i+1])) +				c = (c << 8) | dir[++i]; +			c = ff_convert(c, 1); +			if (!c) c = '?'; +#endif +			*p++ = c; +		} +		if (dir[8] != ' ') {		/* Copy name extension */ +			*p++ = '.'; +			for (i = 8; i < 11; i++) { +				c = dir[i]; +				if (c == ' ') break; +				if (_USE_LFN && (nt & NS_EXT) && IsUpper(c)) c += 0x20; +#if _LFN_UNICODE +				if (IsDBCS1(c) && i < 10 && IsDBCS2(dir[i+1])) +					c = (c << 8) | dir[++i]; +				c = ff_convert(c, 1); +				if (!c) c = '?'; +#endif +				*p++ = c; +			} +		} +		fno->fattrib = dir[DIR_Attr];				/* Attribute */ +		fno->fsize = LD_DWORD(dir+DIR_FileSize);	/* Size */ +		fno->fdate = LD_WORD(dir+DIR_WrtDate);		/* Date */ +		fno->ftime = LD_WORD(dir+DIR_WrtTime);		/* Time */ +	} +	*p = 0;		/* Terminate SFN str by a \0 */ + +#if _USE_LFN +	if (fno->lfname && fno->lfsize) { +		TCHAR *tp = fno->lfname; +		WCHAR w, *lfn; + +		i = 0; +		if (dj->sect && dj->lfn_idx != 0xFFFF) {/* Get LFN if available */ +			lfn = dj->lfn; +			while ((w = *lfn++) != 0) {			/* Get an LFN char */ +#if !_LFN_UNICODE +				w = ff_convert(w, 0);			/* Unicode -> OEM conversion */ +				if (!w) { i = 0; break; }		/* Could not convert, no LFN */ +				if (_DF1S && w >= 0x100)		/* Put 1st byte if it is a DBC (always false on SBCS cfg) */ +					tp[i++] = (TCHAR)(w >> 8); +#endif +				if (i >= fno->lfsize - 1) { i = 0; break; }	/* Buffer overflow, no LFN */ +				tp[i++] = (TCHAR)w; +			} +		} +		tp[i] = 0;	/* Terminate the LFN str by a \0 */ +	} +#endif +} +#endif /* _FS_MINIMIZE <= 1 */ + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Follow a file path                                                    */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT follow_path (	/* FR_OK(0): successful, !=0: error code */ +	DIR *dj,			/* Directory object to return last directory and found object */ +	const TCHAR *path	/* Full-path string to find a file or directory */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	BYTE *dir, ns; + + +#if _FS_RPATH +	if (*path == '/' || *path == '\\') { /* There is a heading separator */ +		path++;	dj->sclust = 0;		/* Strip it and start from the root dir */ +	} else {							/* No heading separator */ +		dj->sclust = dj->fs->cdir;	/* Start from the current dir */ +	} +#else +	if (*path == '/' || *path == '\\')	/* Strip heading separator if exist */ +		path++; +	dj->sclust = 0;						/* Start from the root dir */ +#endif + +	if ((UINT)*path < ' ') {			/* Nul path means the start directory itself */ +		res = dir_sdi(dj, 0); +		dj->dir = 0; +	} else {							/* Follow path */ +		for (;;) { +			res = create_name(dj, &path);	/* Get a segment */ +			if (res != FR_OK) break; +			res = dir_find(dj);				/* Find it */ +			ns = *(dj->fn+NS); +			if (res != FR_OK) {				/* Failed to find the object */ +				if (res != FR_NO_FILE) break;	/* Abort if any hard error occurred */ +				/* Object not found */ +				if (_FS_RPATH && (ns & NS_DOT)) {	/* If dot entry is not exit */ +					dj->sclust = 0; dj->dir = 0;	/* It is the root dir */ +					res = FR_OK; +					if (!(ns & NS_LAST)) continue; +				} else {							/* Could not find the object */ +					if (!(ns & NS_LAST)) res = FR_NO_PATH; +				} +				break; +			} +			if (ns & NS_LAST) break;			/* Last segment match. Function completed. */ +			dir = dj->dir;						/* There is next segment. Follow the sub directory */ +			if (!(dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR)) {	/* Cannot follow because it is a file */ +				res = FR_NO_PATH; break; +			} +			dj->sclust = ld_clust(dj->fs, dir); +		} +	} + +	return res; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Load a sector and check if it is an FAT Volume Boot Record            */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +BYTE check_fs (	/* 0:FAT-VBR, 1:Any BR but not FAT, 2:Not a BR, 3:Disk error */ +	FATFS *fs,	/* File system object */ +	DWORD sect	/* Sector# (lba) to check if it is an FAT boot record or not */ +) +{ +	if (disk_read(fs->drv, fs->win, sect, 1) != RES_OK)	/* Load boot record */ +		return 3; +	if (LD_WORD(&fs->win[BS_55AA]) != 0xAA55)		/* Check record signature (always placed at offset 510 even if the sector size is >512) */ +		return 2; + +	if ((LD_DWORD(&fs->win[BS_FilSysType]) & 0xFFFFFF) == 0x544146)	/* Check "FAT" string */ +		return 0; +	if ((LD_DWORD(&fs->win[BS_FilSysType32]) & 0xFFFFFF) == 0x544146) +		return 0; + +	return 1; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Check if the file system object is valid or not                       */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT chk_mounted (	/* FR_OK(0): successful, !=0: any error occurred */ +	const TCHAR **path,	/* Pointer to pointer to the path name (drive number) */ +	FATFS **rfs,		/* Pointer to pointer to the found file system object */ +	BYTE wmode			/* !=0: Check write protection for write access */ +) +{ +	BYTE fmt, b, pi, *tbl; +	UINT vol; +	DSTATUS stat; +	DWORD bsect, fasize, tsect, sysect, nclst, szbfat; +	WORD nrsv; +	const TCHAR *p = *path; +	FATFS *fs; + + +	/* Get logical drive number from the path name */ +	vol = p[0] - '0';					/* Is there a drive number? */ +	if (vol <= 9 && p[1] == ':') {		/* Found a drive number, get and strip it */ +		p += 2; *path = p;				/* Return pointer to the path name */ +	} else {							/* No drive number is given */ +#if _FS_RPATH +		vol = CurrVol;					/* Use current drive */ +#else +		vol = 0;						/* Use drive 0 */ +#endif +	} + +	/* Check if the file system object is valid or not */ +	*rfs = 0; +	if (vol >= _VOLUMES) 				/* Is the drive number valid? */ +		return FR_INVALID_DRIVE; +	fs = FatFs[vol];					/* Get corresponding file system object */ +	if (!fs) return FR_NOT_ENABLED;		/* Is the file system object available? */ + +	ENTER_FF(fs);						/* Lock file system */ + +	*rfs = fs;							/* Return pointer to the corresponding file system object */ +	if (fs->fs_type) {					/* If the volume has been mounted */ +		stat = disk_status(fs->drv); +		if (!(stat & STA_NOINIT)) {		/* and the physical drive is kept initialized (has not been changed), */ +			if (!_FS_READONLY && wmode && (stat & STA_PROTECT))	/* Check write protection if needed */ +				return FR_WRITE_PROTECTED; +			return FR_OK;				/* The file system object is valid */ +		} +	} + +	/* The file system object is not valid. */ +	/* Following code attempts to mount the volume. (analyze BPB and initialize the fs object) */ + +	fs->fs_type = 0;					/* Clear the file system object */ +	fs->drv = LD2PD(vol);				/* Bind the logical drive and a physical drive */ +	stat = disk_initialize(fs->drv);	/* Initialize the physical drive */ +	if (stat & STA_NOINIT)				/* Check if the initialization succeeded */ +		return FR_NOT_READY;			/* Failed to initialize due to no medium or hard error */ +	if (!_FS_READONLY && wmode && (stat & STA_PROTECT))	/* Check disk write protection if needed */ +		return FR_WRITE_PROTECTED; +#if _MAX_SS != 512						/* Get disk sector size (variable sector size cfg only) */ +	if (disk_ioctl(fs->drv, GET_SECTOR_SIZE, &fs->ssize) != RES_OK) +		return FR_DISK_ERR; +#endif +	/* Search FAT partition on the drive. Supports only generic partitions, FDISK and SFD. */ +	fmt = check_fs(fs, bsect = 0);		/* Load sector 0 and check if it is an FAT-VBR (in SFD) */ +	if (LD2PT(vol) && !fmt) fmt = 1;	/* Force non-SFD if the volume is forced partition */ +	if (fmt == 1) {						/* Not an FAT-VBR, the physical drive can be partitioned */ +		/* Check the partition listed in the partition table */ +		pi = LD2PT(vol); +		if (pi) pi--; +		tbl = &fs->win[MBR_Table + pi * SZ_PTE];/* Partition table */ +		if (tbl[4]) {						/* Is the partition existing? */ +			bsect = LD_DWORD(&tbl[8]);		/* Partition offset in LBA */ +			fmt = check_fs(fs, bsect);		/* Check the partition */ +		} +	} +	if (fmt == 3) return FR_DISK_ERR; +	if (fmt) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM;		/* No FAT volume is found */ + +	/* An FAT volume is found. Following code initializes the file system object */ + +	if (LD_WORD(fs->win+BPB_BytsPerSec) != SS(fs))		/* (BPB_BytsPerSec must be equal to the physical sector size) */ +		return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; + +	fasize = LD_WORD(fs->win+BPB_FATSz16);				/* Number of sectors per FAT */ +	if (!fasize) fasize = LD_DWORD(fs->win+BPB_FATSz32); +	fs->fsize = fasize; + +	fs->n_fats = b = fs->win[BPB_NumFATs];				/* Number of FAT copies */ +	if (b != 1 && b != 2) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM;		/* (Must be 1 or 2) */ +	fasize *= b;										/* Number of sectors for FAT area */ + +	fs->csize = b = fs->win[BPB_SecPerClus];			/* Number of sectors per cluster */ +	if (!b || (b & (b - 1))) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM;	/* (Must be power of 2) */ + +	fs->n_rootdir = LD_WORD(fs->win+BPB_RootEntCnt);	/* Number of root directory entries */ +	if (fs->n_rootdir % (SS(fs) / SZ_DIR)) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM;	/* (BPB_RootEntCnt must be sector aligned) */ + +	tsect = LD_WORD(fs->win+BPB_TotSec16);				/* Number of sectors on the volume */ +	if (!tsect) tsect = LD_DWORD(fs->win+BPB_TotSec32); + +	nrsv = LD_WORD(fs->win+BPB_RsvdSecCnt);				/* Number of reserved sectors */ +	if (!nrsv) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM;					/* (BPB_RsvdSecCnt must not be 0) */ + +	/* Determine the FAT sub type */ +	sysect = nrsv + fasize + fs->n_rootdir / (SS(fs) / SZ_DIR);	/* RSV+FAT+DIR */ +	if (tsect < sysect) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM;		/* (Invalid volume size) */ +	nclst = (tsect - sysect) / fs->csize;				/* Number of clusters */ +	if (!nclst) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM;				/* (Invalid volume size) */ +	fmt = FS_FAT12; +	if (nclst >= MIN_FAT16) fmt = FS_FAT16; +	if (nclst >= MIN_FAT32) fmt = FS_FAT32; + +	/* Boundaries and Limits */ +	fs->n_fatent = nclst + 2;							/* Number of FAT entries */ +	fs->database = bsect + sysect;						/* Data start sector */ +	fs->fatbase = bsect + nrsv; 						/* FAT start sector */ +	if (fmt == FS_FAT32) { +		if (fs->n_rootdir) return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM;		/* (BPB_RootEntCnt must be 0) */ +		fs->dirbase = LD_DWORD(fs->win+BPB_RootClus);	/* Root directory start cluster */ +		szbfat = fs->n_fatent * 4;						/* (Required FAT size) */ +	} else { +		if (!fs->n_rootdir)	return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM;	/* (BPB_RootEntCnt must not be 0) */ +		fs->dirbase = fs->fatbase + fasize;				/* Root directory start sector */ +		szbfat = (fmt == FS_FAT16) ?					/* (Required FAT size) */ +			fs->n_fatent * 2 : fs->n_fatent * 3 / 2 + (fs->n_fatent & 1); +	} +	if (fs->fsize < (szbfat + (SS(fs) - 1)) / SS(fs))	/* (BPB_FATSz must not be less than required) */ +		return FR_NO_FILESYSTEM; + +#if !_FS_READONLY +	/* Initialize cluster allocation information */ +	fs->free_clust = 0xFFFFFFFF; +	fs->last_clust = 0; + +	/* Get fsinfo if available */ +	if (fmt == FS_FAT32) { +	 	fs->fsi_flag = 0; +		fs->fsi_sector = bsect + LD_WORD(fs->win+BPB_FSInfo); +		if (disk_read(fs->drv, fs->win, fs->fsi_sector, 1) == RES_OK && +			LD_WORD(fs->win+BS_55AA) == 0xAA55 && +			LD_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_LeadSig) == 0x41615252 && +			LD_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_StrucSig) == 0x61417272) { +				fs->last_clust = LD_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_Nxt_Free); +				fs->free_clust = LD_DWORD(fs->win+FSI_Free_Count); +		} +	} +#endif +	fs->fs_type = fmt;		/* FAT sub-type */ +	fs->id = ++Fsid;		/* File system mount ID */ +	fs->winsect = 0;		/* Invalidate sector cache */ +	fs->wflag = 0; +#if _FS_RPATH +	fs->cdir = 0;			/* Current directory (root dir) */ +#endif +#if _FS_LOCK				/* Clear file lock semaphores */ +	clear_lock(fs); +#endif + +	return FR_OK; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Check if the file/dir object is valid or not                          */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +static +FRESULT validate (	/* FR_OK(0): The object is valid, !=0: Invalid */ +	void* obj		/* Pointer to the object FIL/DIR to check validity */ +) +{ +	FIL *fil; + + +	fil = (FIL*)obj;	/* Assuming offset of fs and id in the FIL/DIR is identical */ +	if (!fil->fs || !fil->fs->fs_type || fil->fs->id != fil->id) +		return FR_INVALID_OBJECT; + +	ENTER_FF(fil->fs);		/* Lock file system */ + +	if (disk_status(fil->fs->drv) & STA_NOINIT) +		return FR_NOT_READY; + +	return FR_OK; +} + + + + +/*-------------------------------------------------------------------------- + +   Public Functions + +--------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Mount/Unmount a Logical Drive                                         */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_mount ( +	BYTE vol,		/* Logical drive number to be mounted/unmounted */ +	FATFS *fs		/* Pointer to new file system object (NULL for unmount)*/ +) +{ +	FATFS *rfs; + + +	if (vol >= _VOLUMES)		/* Check if the drive number is valid */ +		return FR_INVALID_DRIVE; +	rfs = FatFs[vol];			/* Get current fs object */ + +	if (rfs) { +#if _FS_LOCK +		clear_lock(rfs); +#endif +#if _FS_REENTRANT				/* Discard sync object of the current volume */ +		if (!ff_del_syncobj(rfs->sobj)) return FR_INT_ERR; +#endif +		rfs->fs_type = 0;		/* Clear old fs object */ +	} + +	if (fs) { +		fs->fs_type = 0;		/* Clear new fs object */ +#if _FS_REENTRANT				/* Create sync object for the new volume */ +		if (!ff_cre_syncobj(vol, &fs->sobj)) return FR_INT_ERR; +#endif +	} +	FatFs[vol] = fs;			/* Register new fs object */ + +	return FR_OK; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Open or Create a File                                                 */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_open ( +	FIL *fp,			/* Pointer to the blank file object */ +	const TCHAR *path,	/* Pointer to the file name */ +	BYTE mode			/* Access mode and file open mode flags */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	DIR dj; +	BYTE *dir; +	DEF_NAMEBUF; + + +	if (!fp) return FR_INVALID_OBJECT; +	fp->fs = 0;			/* Clear file object */ + +#if !_FS_READONLY +	mode &= FA_READ | FA_WRITE | FA_CREATE_ALWAYS | FA_OPEN_ALWAYS | FA_CREATE_NEW; +	res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, (BYTE)(mode & ~FA_READ)); +#else +	mode &= FA_READ; +	res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 0); +#endif +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		INIT_BUF(dj); +		res = follow_path(&dj, path);	/* Follow the file path */ +		dir = dj.dir; +#if !_FS_READONLY	/* R/W configuration */ +		if (res == FR_OK) { +			if (!dir)	/* Current dir itself */ +				res = FR_INVALID_NAME; +#if _FS_LOCK +			else +				res = chk_lock(&dj, (mode & ~FA_READ) ? 1 : 0); +#endif +		} +		/* Create or Open a file */ +		if (mode & (FA_CREATE_ALWAYS | FA_OPEN_ALWAYS | FA_CREATE_NEW)) { +			DWORD dw, cl; + +			if (res != FR_OK) {					/* No file, create new */ +				if (res == FR_NO_FILE)			/* There is no file to open, create a new entry */ +#if _FS_LOCK +					res = enq_lock() ? dir_register(&dj) : FR_TOO_MANY_OPEN_FILES; +#else +					res = dir_register(&dj); +#endif +				mode |= FA_CREATE_ALWAYS;		/* File is created */ +				dir = dj.dir;					/* New entry */ +			} +			else {								/* Any object is already existing */ +				if (dir[DIR_Attr] & (AM_RDO | AM_DIR)) {	/* Cannot overwrite it (R/O or DIR) */ +					res = FR_DENIED; +				} else { +					if (mode & FA_CREATE_NEW)	/* Cannot create as new file */ +						res = FR_EXIST; +				} +			} +			if (res == FR_OK && (mode & FA_CREATE_ALWAYS)) {	/* Truncate it if overwrite mode */ +				dw = get_fattime();					/* Created time */ +				ST_DWORD(dir+DIR_CrtTime, dw); +				dir[DIR_Attr] = 0;					/* Reset attribute */ +				ST_DWORD(dir+DIR_FileSize, 0);		/* size = 0 */ +				cl = ld_clust(dj.fs, dir);			/* Get start cluster */ +				st_clust(dir, 0);					/* cluster = 0 */ +				dj.fs->wflag = 1; +				if (cl) {							/* Remove the cluster chain if exist */ +					dw = dj.fs->winsect; +					res = remove_chain(dj.fs, cl); +					if (res == FR_OK) { +						dj.fs->last_clust = cl - 1;	/* Reuse the cluster hole */ +						res = move_window(dj.fs, dw); +					} +				} +			} +		} +		else {	/* Open an existing file */ +			if (res == FR_OK) {						/* Follow succeeded */ +				if (dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR) {		/* It is a directory */ +					res = FR_NO_FILE; +				} else { +					if ((mode & FA_WRITE) && (dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_RDO)) /* R/O violation */ +						res = FR_DENIED; +				} +			} +		} +		if (res == FR_OK) { +			if (mode & FA_CREATE_ALWAYS)			/* Set file change flag if created or overwritten */ +				mode |= FA__WRITTEN; +			fp->dir_sect = dj.fs->winsect;			/* Pointer to the directory entry */ +			fp->dir_ptr = dir; +#if _FS_LOCK +			fp->lockid = inc_lock(&dj, (mode & ~FA_READ) ? 1 : 0); +			if (!fp->lockid) res = FR_INT_ERR; +#endif +		} + +#else				/* R/O configuration */ +		if (res == FR_OK) {					/* Follow succeeded */ +			dir = dj.dir; +			if (!dir) {						/* Current dir itself */ +				res = FR_INVALID_NAME; +			} else { +				if (dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR)	/* It is a directory */ +					res = FR_NO_FILE; +			} +		} +#endif +		FREE_BUF(); + +		if (res == FR_OK) { +			fp->flag = mode;					/* File access mode */ +			fp->sclust = ld_clust(dj.fs, dir);	/* File start cluster */ +			fp->fsize = LD_DWORD(dir+DIR_FileSize);	/* File size */ +			fp->fptr = 0;						/* File pointer */ +			fp->dsect = 0; +#if _USE_FASTSEEK +			fp->cltbl = 0;						/* Normal seek mode */ +#endif +			fp->fs = dj.fs; fp->id = dj.fs->id;	/* Validate file object */ +		} +	} + +	LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Read File                                                             */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_read ( +	FIL *fp, 		/* Pointer to the file object */ +	void *buff,		/* Pointer to data buffer */ +	UINT btr,		/* Number of bytes to read */ +	UINT *br		/* Pointer to number of bytes read */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	DWORD clst, sect, remain; +	UINT rcnt, cc; +	BYTE csect, *rbuff = buff; + + +	*br = 0;	/* Clear read byte counter */ + +	res = validate(fp);							/* Check validity */ +	if (res != FR_OK) LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); +	if (fp->flag & FA__ERROR)					/* Aborted file? */ +		LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); +	if (!(fp->flag & FA_READ)) 					/* Check access mode */ +		LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_DENIED); +	remain = fp->fsize - fp->fptr; +	if (btr > remain) btr = (UINT)remain;		/* Truncate btr by remaining bytes */ + +	for ( ;  btr;								/* Repeat until all data read */ +		rbuff += rcnt, fp->fptr += rcnt, *br += rcnt, btr -= rcnt) { +		if ((fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)) == 0) {		/* On the sector boundary? */ +			csect = (BYTE)(fp->fptr / SS(fp->fs) & (fp->fs->csize - 1));	/* Sector offset in the cluster */ +			if (!csect) {						/* On the cluster boundary? */ +				if (fp->fptr == 0) {			/* On the top of the file? */ +					clst = fp->sclust;			/* Follow from the origin */ +				} else {						/* Middle or end of the file */ +#if _USE_FASTSEEK +					if (fp->cltbl) +						clst = clmt_clust(fp, fp->fptr);	/* Get cluster# from the CLMT */ +					else +#endif +						clst = get_fat(fp->fs, fp->clust);	/* Follow cluster chain on the FAT */ +				} +				if (clst < 2) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); +				if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +				fp->clust = clst;				/* Update current cluster */ +			} +			sect = clust2sect(fp->fs, fp->clust);	/* Get current sector */ +			if (!sect) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); +			sect += csect; +			cc = btr / SS(fp->fs);				/* When remaining bytes >= sector size, */ +			if (cc) {							/* Read maximum contiguous sectors directly */ +				if (csect + cc > fp->fs->csize)	/* Clip at cluster boundary */ +					cc = fp->fs->csize - csect; +				if (disk_read(fp->fs->drv, rbuff, sect, (BYTE)cc) != RES_OK) +					ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +#if !_FS_READONLY && _FS_MINIMIZE <= 2			/* Replace one of the read sectors with cached data if it contains a dirty sector */ +#if _FS_TINY +				if (fp->fs->wflag && fp->fs->winsect - sect < cc) +					mem_cpy(rbuff + ((fp->fs->winsect - sect) * SS(fp->fs)), fp->fs->win, SS(fp->fs)); +#else +				if ((fp->flag & FA__DIRTY) && fp->dsect - sect < cc) +					mem_cpy(rbuff + ((fp->dsect - sect) * SS(fp->fs)), fp->buf, SS(fp->fs)); +#endif +#endif +				rcnt = SS(fp->fs) * cc;			/* Number of bytes transferred */ +				continue; +			} +#if !_FS_TINY +			if (fp->dsect != sect) {			/* Load data sector if not in cache */ +#if !_FS_READONLY +				if (fp->flag & FA__DIRTY) {		/* Write-back dirty sector cache */ +					if (disk_write(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, fp->dsect, 1) != RES_OK) +						ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +					fp->flag &= ~FA__DIRTY; +				} +#endif +				if (disk_read(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, sect, 1) != RES_OK)	/* Fill sector cache */ +					ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +			} +#endif +			fp->dsect = sect; +		} +		rcnt = SS(fp->fs) - ((UINT)fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs));	/* Get partial sector data from sector buffer */ +		if (rcnt > btr) rcnt = btr; +#if _FS_TINY +		if (move_window(fp->fs, fp->dsect))		/* Move sector window */ +			ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +		mem_cpy(rbuff, &fp->fs->win[fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)], rcnt);	/* Pick partial sector */ +#else +		mem_cpy(rbuff, &fp->buf[fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)], rcnt);	/* Pick partial sector */ +#endif +	} + +	LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_OK); +} + + + + +#if !_FS_READONLY +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Write File                                                            */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_write ( +	FIL *fp,			/* Pointer to the file object */ +	const void *buff,	/* Pointer to the data to be written */ +	UINT btw,			/* Number of bytes to write */ +	UINT *bw			/* Pointer to number of bytes written */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	DWORD clst, sect; +	UINT wcnt, cc; +	const BYTE *wbuff = buff; +	BYTE csect; + + +	*bw = 0;	/* Clear write byte counter */ + +	res = validate(fp);						/* Check validity */ +	if (res != FR_OK) LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); +	if (fp->flag & FA__ERROR)				/* Aborted file? */ +		LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); +	if (!(fp->flag & FA_WRITE))				/* Check access mode */ +		LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_DENIED); +	if ((DWORD)(fp->fsize + btw) < fp->fsize) btw = 0;	/* File size cannot reach 4GB */ + +	for ( ;  btw;							/* Repeat until all data written */ +		wbuff += wcnt, fp->fptr += wcnt, *bw += wcnt, btw -= wcnt) { +		if ((fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)) == 0) {	/* On the sector boundary? */ +			csect = (BYTE)(fp->fptr / SS(fp->fs) & (fp->fs->csize - 1));	/* Sector offset in the cluster */ +			if (!csect) {					/* On the cluster boundary? */ +				if (fp->fptr == 0) {		/* On the top of the file? */ +					clst = fp->sclust;		/* Follow from the origin */ +					if (clst == 0)			/* When no cluster is allocated, */ +						fp->sclust = clst = create_chain(fp->fs, 0);	/* Create a new cluster chain */ +				} else {					/* Middle or end of the file */ +#if _USE_FASTSEEK +					if (fp->cltbl) +						clst = clmt_clust(fp, fp->fptr);	/* Get cluster# from the CLMT */ +					else +#endif +						clst = create_chain(fp->fs, fp->clust);	/* Follow or stretch cluster chain on the FAT */ +				} +				if (clst == 0) break;		/* Could not allocate a new cluster (disk full) */ +				if (clst == 1) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); +				if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +				fp->clust = clst;			/* Update current cluster */ +			} +#if _FS_TINY +			if (fp->fs->winsect == fp->dsect && move_window(fp->fs, 0))	/* Write-back sector cache */ +				ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +#else +			if (fp->flag & FA__DIRTY) {		/* Write-back sector cache */ +				if (disk_write(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, fp->dsect, 1) != RES_OK) +					ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +				fp->flag &= ~FA__DIRTY; +			} +#endif +			sect = clust2sect(fp->fs, fp->clust);	/* Get current sector */ +			if (!sect) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); +			sect += csect; +			cc = btw / SS(fp->fs);			/* When remaining bytes >= sector size, */ +			if (cc) {						/* Write maximum contiguous sectors directly */ +				if (csect + cc > fp->fs->csize)	/* Clip at cluster boundary */ +					cc = fp->fs->csize - csect; +				if (disk_write(fp->fs->drv, wbuff, sect, (BYTE)cc) != RES_OK) +					ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +#if _FS_TINY +				if (fp->fs->winsect - sect < cc) {	/* Refill sector cache if it gets invalidated by the direct write */ +					mem_cpy(fp->fs->win, wbuff + ((fp->fs->winsect - sect) * SS(fp->fs)), SS(fp->fs)); +					fp->fs->wflag = 0; +				} +#else +				if (fp->dsect - sect < cc) { /* Refill sector cache if it gets invalidated by the direct write */ +					mem_cpy(fp->buf, wbuff + ((fp->dsect - sect) * SS(fp->fs)), SS(fp->fs)); +					fp->flag &= ~FA__DIRTY; +				} +#endif +				wcnt = SS(fp->fs) * cc;		/* Number of bytes transferred */ +				continue; +			} +#if _FS_TINY +			if (fp->fptr >= fp->fsize) {	/* Avoid silly cache filling at growing edge */ +				if (move_window(fp->fs, 0)) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +				fp->fs->winsect = sect; +			} +#else +			if (fp->dsect != sect) {		/* Fill sector cache with file data */ +				if (fp->fptr < fp->fsize && +					disk_read(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, sect, 1) != RES_OK) +						ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +			} +#endif +			fp->dsect = sect; +		} +		wcnt = SS(fp->fs) - ((UINT)fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs));/* Put partial sector into file I/O buffer */ +		if (wcnt > btw) wcnt = btw; +#if _FS_TINY +		if (move_window(fp->fs, fp->dsect))	/* Move sector window */ +			ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +		mem_cpy(&fp->fs->win[fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)], wbuff, wcnt);	/* Fit partial sector */ +		fp->fs->wflag = 1; +#else +		mem_cpy(&fp->buf[fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)], wbuff, wcnt);	/* Fit partial sector */ +		fp->flag |= FA__DIRTY; +#endif +	} + +	if (fp->fptr > fp->fsize) fp->fsize = fp->fptr;	/* Update file size if needed */ +	fp->flag |= FA__WRITTEN;						/* Set file change flag */ + +	LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_OK); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Synchronize the File Object                                           */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_sync ( +	FIL *fp		/* Pointer to the file object */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	DWORD tim; +	BYTE *dir; + + +	res = validate(fp);					/* Check validity of the object */ +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		if (fp->flag & FA__WRITTEN) {	/* Has the file been written? */ +#if !_FS_TINY	/* Write-back dirty buffer */ +			if (fp->flag & FA__DIRTY) { +				if (disk_write(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, fp->dsect, 1) != RES_OK) +					LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +				fp->flag &= ~FA__DIRTY; +			} +#endif +			/* Update the directory entry */ +			res = move_window(fp->fs, fp->dir_sect); +			if (res == FR_OK) { +				dir = fp->dir_ptr; +				dir[DIR_Attr] |= AM_ARC;					/* Set archive bit */ +				ST_DWORD(dir+DIR_FileSize, fp->fsize);		/* Update file size */ +				st_clust(dir, fp->sclust);					/* Update start cluster */ +				tim = get_fattime();						/* Update updated time */ +				ST_DWORD(dir+DIR_WrtTime, tim); +				ST_WORD(dir+DIR_LstAccDate, 0); +				fp->flag &= ~FA__WRITTEN; +				fp->fs->wflag = 1; +				res = sync(fp->fs); +			} +		} +	} + +	LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); +} + +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Close File                                                            */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_close ( +	FIL *fp		/* Pointer to the file object to be closed */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; + + +#if _FS_READONLY +	res = validate(fp); +	{ +#if _FS_REENTRANT +		FATFS *fs = fp->fs; +#endif +		if (res == FR_OK) fp->fs = 0;	/* Discard file object */ +		LEAVE_FF(fs, res); +	} +#else +	res = f_sync(fp);		/* Flush cached data */ +#if _FS_LOCK +	if (res == FR_OK) {		/* Decrement open counter */ +#if _FS_REENTRANT +		FATFS *fs = fp->fs;; +		res = validate(fp); +		if (res == FR_OK) { +			res = dec_lock(fp->lockid);	 +			unlock_fs(fs, FR_OK); +		} +#else +		res = dec_lock(fp->lockid); +#endif +	} +#endif +	if (res == FR_OK) fp->fs = 0;	/* Discard file object */ +	return res; +#endif +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Current Drive/Directory Handlings                                     */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#if _FS_RPATH >= 1 + +FRESULT f_chdrive ( +	BYTE drv		/* Drive number */ +) +{ +	if (drv >= _VOLUMES) return FR_INVALID_DRIVE; + +	CurrVol = drv; + +	return FR_OK; +} + + + +FRESULT f_chdir ( +	const TCHAR *path	/* Pointer to the directory path */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	DIR dj; +	DEF_NAMEBUF; + + +	res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 0); +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		INIT_BUF(dj); +		res = follow_path(&dj, path);		/* Follow the path */ +		FREE_BUF(); +		if (res == FR_OK) {					/* Follow completed */ +			if (!dj.dir) { +				dj.fs->cdir = dj.sclust;	/* Start directory itself */ +			} else { +				if (dj.dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR)	/* Reached to the directory */ +					dj.fs->cdir = ld_clust(dj.fs, dj.dir); +				else +					res = FR_NO_PATH;		/* Reached but a file */ +			} +		} +		if (res == FR_NO_FILE) res = FR_NO_PATH; +	} + +	LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + +#if _FS_RPATH >= 2 +FRESULT f_getcwd ( +	TCHAR *path,	/* Pointer to the directory path */ +	UINT sz_path	/* Size of path */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	DIR dj; +	UINT i, n; +	DWORD ccl; +	TCHAR *tp; +	FILINFO fno; +	DEF_NAMEBUF; + + +	*path = 0; +	res = chk_mounted((const TCHAR**)&path, &dj.fs, 0);	/* Get current volume */ +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		INIT_BUF(dj); +		i = sz_path;		/* Bottom of buffer (dir stack base) */ +		dj.sclust = dj.fs->cdir;			/* Start to follow upper dir from current dir */ +		while ((ccl = dj.sclust) != 0) {	/* Repeat while current dir is a sub-dir */ +			res = dir_sdi(&dj, 1);			/* Get parent dir */ +			if (res != FR_OK) break; +			res = dir_read(&dj); +			if (res != FR_OK) break; +			dj.sclust = ld_clust(dj.fs, dj.dir);	/* Goto parent dir */ +			res = dir_sdi(&dj, 0); +			if (res != FR_OK) break; +			do {							/* Find the entry links to the child dir */ +				res = dir_read(&dj); +				if (res != FR_OK) break; +				if (ccl == ld_clust(dj.fs, dj.dir)) break;	/* Found the entry */ +				res = dir_next(&dj, 0);	 +			} while (res == FR_OK); +			if (res == FR_NO_FILE) res = FR_INT_ERR;/* It cannot be 'not found'. */ +			if (res != FR_OK) break; +#if _USE_LFN +			fno.lfname = path; +			fno.lfsize = i; +#endif +			get_fileinfo(&dj, &fno);		/* Get the dir name and push it to the buffer */ +			tp = fno.fname; +			if (_USE_LFN && *path) tp = path; +			for (n = 0; tp[n]; n++) ; +			if (i < n + 3) { +				res = FR_NOT_ENOUGH_CORE; break; +			} +			while (n) path[--i] = tp[--n]; +			path[--i] = '/'; +		} +		tp = path; +		if (res == FR_OK) { +			*tp++ = '0' + CurrVol;			/* Put drive number */ +			*tp++ = ':'; +			if (i == sz_path) {				/* Root-dir */ +				*tp++ = '/'; +			} else {						/* Sub-dir */ +				do		/* Add stacked path str */ +					*tp++ = path[i++]; +				while (i < sz_path); +			} +		} +		*tp = 0; +		FREE_BUF(); +	} + +	LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} +#endif /* _FS_RPATH >= 2 */ +#endif /* _FS_RPATH >= 1 */ + + + +#if _FS_MINIMIZE <= 2 +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Seek File R/W Pointer                                                 */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_lseek ( +	FIL *fp,		/* Pointer to the file object */ +	DWORD ofs		/* File pointer from top of file */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; + + +	res = validate(fp);					/* Check validity of the object */ +	if (res != FR_OK) LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); +	if (fp->flag & FA__ERROR)			/* Check abort flag */ +		LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); + +#if _USE_FASTSEEK +	if (fp->cltbl) {	/* Fast seek */ +		DWORD cl, pcl, ncl, tcl, dsc, tlen, ulen, *tbl; + +		if (ofs == CREATE_LINKMAP) {	/* Create CLMT */ +			tbl = fp->cltbl; +			tlen = *tbl++; ulen = 2;	/* Given table size and required table size */ +			cl = fp->sclust;			/* Top of the chain */ +			if (cl) { +				do { +					/* Get a fragment */ +					tcl = cl; ncl = 0; ulen += 2;	/* Top, length and used items */ +					do { +						pcl = cl; ncl++; +						cl = get_fat(fp->fs, cl); +						if (cl <= 1) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); +						if (cl == 0xFFFFFFFF) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +					} while (cl == pcl + 1); +					if (ulen <= tlen) {		/* Store the length and top of the fragment */ +						*tbl++ = ncl; *tbl++ = tcl; +					} +				} while (cl < fp->fs->n_fatent);	/* Repeat until end of chain */ +			} +			*fp->cltbl = ulen;	/* Number of items used */ +			if (ulen <= tlen) +				*tbl = 0;		/* Terminate table */ +			else +				res = FR_NOT_ENOUGH_CORE;	/* Given table size is smaller than required */ + +		} else {						/* Fast seek */ +			if (ofs > fp->fsize)		/* Clip offset at the file size */ +				ofs = fp->fsize; +			fp->fptr = ofs;				/* Set file pointer */ +			if (ofs) { +				fp->clust = clmt_clust(fp, ofs - 1); +				dsc = clust2sect(fp->fs, fp->clust); +				if (!dsc) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); +				dsc += (ofs - 1) / SS(fp->fs) & (fp->fs->csize - 1); +				if (fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs) && dsc != fp->dsect) {	/* Refill sector cache if needed */ +#if !_FS_TINY +#if !_FS_READONLY +					if (fp->flag & FA__DIRTY) {		/* Write-back dirty sector cache */ +						if (disk_write(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, fp->dsect, 1) != RES_OK) +							ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +						fp->flag &= ~FA__DIRTY; +					} +#endif +					if (disk_read(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, dsc, 1) != RES_OK)	/* Load current sector */ +						ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +#endif +					fp->dsect = dsc; +				} +			} +		} +	} else +#endif + +	/* Normal Seek */ +	{ +		DWORD clst, bcs, nsect, ifptr; + +		if (ofs > fp->fsize					/* In read-only mode, clip offset with the file size */ +#if !_FS_READONLY +			 && !(fp->flag & FA_WRITE) +#endif +			) ofs = fp->fsize; + +		ifptr = fp->fptr; +		fp->fptr = nsect = 0; +		if (ofs) { +			bcs = (DWORD)fp->fs->csize * SS(fp->fs);	/* Cluster size (byte) */ +			if (ifptr > 0 && +				(ofs - 1) / bcs >= (ifptr - 1) / bcs) {	/* When seek to same or following cluster, */ +				fp->fptr = (ifptr - 1) & ~(bcs - 1);	/* start from the current cluster */ +				ofs -= fp->fptr; +				clst = fp->clust; +			} else {									/* When seek to back cluster, */ +				clst = fp->sclust;						/* start from the first cluster */ +#if !_FS_READONLY +				if (clst == 0) {						/* If no cluster chain, create a new chain */ +					clst = create_chain(fp->fs, 0); +					if (clst == 1) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); +					if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +					fp->sclust = clst; +				} +#endif +				fp->clust = clst; +			} +			if (clst != 0) { +				while (ofs > bcs) {						/* Cluster following loop */ +#if !_FS_READONLY +					if (fp->flag & FA_WRITE) {			/* Check if in write mode or not */ +						clst = create_chain(fp->fs, clst);	/* Force stretch if in write mode */ +						if (clst == 0) {				/* When disk gets full, clip file size */ +							ofs = bcs; break; +						} +					} else +#endif +						clst = get_fat(fp->fs, clst);	/* Follow cluster chain if not in write mode */ +					if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +					if (clst <= 1 || clst >= fp->fs->n_fatent) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); +					fp->clust = clst; +					fp->fptr += bcs; +					ofs -= bcs; +				} +				fp->fptr += ofs; +				if (ofs % SS(fp->fs)) { +					nsect = clust2sect(fp->fs, clst);	/* Current sector */ +					if (!nsect) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); +					nsect += ofs / SS(fp->fs); +				} +			} +		} +		if (fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs) && nsect != fp->dsect) {	/* Fill sector cache if needed */ +#if !_FS_TINY +#if !_FS_READONLY +			if (fp->flag & FA__DIRTY) {			/* Write-back dirty sector cache */ +				if (disk_write(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, fp->dsect, 1) != RES_OK) +					ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +				fp->flag &= ~FA__DIRTY; +			} +#endif +			if (disk_read(fp->fs->drv, fp->buf, nsect, 1) != RES_OK)	/* Fill sector cache */ +				ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +#endif +			fp->dsect = nsect; +		} +#if !_FS_READONLY +		if (fp->fptr > fp->fsize) {			/* Set file change flag if the file size is extended */ +			fp->fsize = fp->fptr; +			fp->flag |= FA__WRITTEN; +		} +#endif +	} + +	LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); +} + + + +#if _FS_MINIMIZE <= 1 +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Create a Directory Object                                             */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_opendir ( +	DIR *dj,			/* Pointer to directory object to create */ +	const TCHAR *path	/* Pointer to the directory path */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	FATFS *fs; +	DEF_NAMEBUF; + + +	if (!dj) return FR_INVALID_OBJECT; + +	res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj->fs, 0); +	fs = dj->fs; +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		INIT_BUF(*dj); +		res = follow_path(dj, path);			/* Follow the path to the directory */ +		FREE_BUF(); +		if (res == FR_OK) {						/* Follow completed */ +			if (dj->dir) {						/* It is not the root dir */ +				if (dj->dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR) {	/* The object is a directory */ +					dj->sclust = ld_clust(fs, dj->dir); +				} else {						/* The object is not a directory */ +					res = FR_NO_PATH; +				} +			} +			if (res == FR_OK) { +				dj->id = fs->id; +				res = dir_sdi(dj, 0);			/* Rewind dir */ +			} +		} +		if (res == FR_NO_FILE) res = FR_NO_PATH; +		if (res != FR_OK) dj->fs = 0;			/* Invalidate the dir object if function failed */ +	} else { +		dj->fs = 0; +	} + +	LEAVE_FF(fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Read Directory Entry in Sequence                                      */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_readdir ( +	DIR *dj,			/* Pointer to the open directory object */ +	FILINFO *fno		/* Pointer to file information to return */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	DEF_NAMEBUF; + + +	res = validate(dj);						/* Check validity of the object */ +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		if (!fno) { +			res = dir_sdi(dj, 0);			/* Rewind the directory object */ +		} else { +			INIT_BUF(*dj); +			res = dir_read(dj);				/* Read an directory item */ +			if (res == FR_NO_FILE) {		/* Reached end of dir */ +				dj->sect = 0; +				res = FR_OK; +			} +			if (res == FR_OK) {				/* A valid entry is found */ +				get_fileinfo(dj, fno);		/* Get the object information */ +				res = dir_next(dj, 0);		/* Increment index for next */ +				if (res == FR_NO_FILE) { +					dj->sect = 0; +					res = FR_OK; +				} +			} +			FREE_BUF(); +		} +	} + +	LEAVE_FF(dj->fs, res); +} + + + +#if _FS_MINIMIZE == 0 +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Get File Status                                                       */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_stat ( +	const TCHAR *path,	/* Pointer to the file path */ +	FILINFO *fno		/* Pointer to file information to return */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	DIR dj; +	DEF_NAMEBUF; + + +	res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 0); +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		INIT_BUF(dj); +		res = follow_path(&dj, path);	/* Follow the file path */ +		if (res == FR_OK) {				/* Follow completed */ +			if (dj.dir)		/* Found an object */ +				get_fileinfo(&dj, fno); +			else			/* It is root dir */ +				res = FR_INVALID_NAME; +		} +		FREE_BUF(); +	} + +	LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + + +#if !_FS_READONLY +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Get Number of Free Clusters                                           */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_getfree ( +	const TCHAR *path,	/* Pointer to the logical drive number (root dir) */ +	DWORD *nclst,		/* Pointer to the variable to return number of free clusters */ +	FATFS **fatfs		/* Pointer to pointer to corresponding file system object to return */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	FATFS *fs; +	DWORD n, clst, sect, stat; +	UINT i; +	BYTE fat, *p; + + +	/* Get drive number */ +	res = chk_mounted(&path, fatfs, 0); +	fs = *fatfs; +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		/* If free_clust is valid, return it without full cluster scan */ +		if (fs->free_clust <= fs->n_fatent - 2) { +			*nclst = fs->free_clust; +		} else { +			/* Get number of free clusters */ +			fat = fs->fs_type; +			n = 0; +			if (fat == FS_FAT12) { +				clst = 2; +				do { +					stat = get_fat(fs, clst); +					if (stat == 0xFFFFFFFF) { res = FR_DISK_ERR; break; } +					if (stat == 1) { res = FR_INT_ERR; break; } +					if (stat == 0) n++; +				} while (++clst < fs->n_fatent); +			} else { +				clst = fs->n_fatent; +				sect = fs->fatbase; +				i = 0; p = 0; +				do { +					if (!i) { +						res = move_window(fs, sect++); +						if (res != FR_OK) break; +						p = fs->win; +						i = SS(fs); +					} +					if (fat == FS_FAT16) { +						if (LD_WORD(p) == 0) n++; +						p += 2; i -= 2; +					} else { +						if ((LD_DWORD(p) & 0x0FFFFFFF) == 0) n++; +						p += 4; i -= 4; +					} +				} while (--clst); +			} +			fs->free_clust = n; +			if (fat == FS_FAT32) fs->fsi_flag = 1; +			*nclst = n; +		} +	} +	LEAVE_FF(fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Truncate File                                                         */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_truncate ( +	FIL *fp		/* Pointer to the file object */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	DWORD ncl; + + +	if (!fp) return FR_INVALID_OBJECT; + +	res = validate(fp);						/* Check validity of the object */ +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		if (fp->flag & FA__ERROR) {			/* Check abort flag */ +			res = FR_INT_ERR; +		} else { +			if (!(fp->flag & FA_WRITE))		/* Check access mode */ +				res = FR_DENIED; +		} +	} +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		if (fp->fsize > fp->fptr) { +			fp->fsize = fp->fptr;	/* Set file size to current R/W point */ +			fp->flag |= FA__WRITTEN; +			if (fp->fptr == 0) {	/* When set file size to zero, remove entire cluster chain */ +				res = remove_chain(fp->fs, fp->sclust); +				fp->sclust = 0; +			} else {				/* When truncate a part of the file, remove remaining clusters */ +				ncl = get_fat(fp->fs, fp->clust); +				res = FR_OK; +				if (ncl == 0xFFFFFFFF) res = FR_DISK_ERR; +				if (ncl == 1) res = FR_INT_ERR; +				if (res == FR_OK && ncl < fp->fs->n_fatent) { +					res = put_fat(fp->fs, fp->clust, 0x0FFFFFFF); +					if (res == FR_OK) res = remove_chain(fp->fs, ncl); +				} +			} +		} +		if (res != FR_OK) fp->flag |= FA__ERROR; +	} + +	LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Delete a File or Directory                                            */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_unlink ( +	const TCHAR *path		/* Pointer to the file or directory path */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	DIR dj, sdj; +	BYTE *dir; +	DWORD dclst; +	DEF_NAMEBUF; + + +	res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 1); +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		INIT_BUF(dj); +		res = follow_path(&dj, path);		/* Follow the file path */ +		if (_FS_RPATH && res == FR_OK && (dj.fn[NS] & NS_DOT)) +			res = FR_INVALID_NAME;			/* Cannot remove dot entry */ +#if _FS_LOCK +		if (res == FR_OK) res = chk_lock(&dj, 2);	/* Cannot remove open file */ +#endif +		if (res == FR_OK) {					/* The object is accessible */ +			dir = dj.dir; +			if (!dir) { +				res = FR_INVALID_NAME;		/* Cannot remove the start directory */ +			} else { +				if (dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_RDO) +					res = FR_DENIED;		/* Cannot remove R/O object */ +			} +			dclst = ld_clust(dj.fs, dir); +			if (res == FR_OK && (dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR)) {	/* Is it a sub-dir? */ +				if (dclst < 2) { +					res = FR_INT_ERR; +				} else { +					mem_cpy(&sdj, &dj, sizeof (DIR));	/* Check if the sub-dir is empty or not */ +					sdj.sclust = dclst; +					res = dir_sdi(&sdj, 2);		/* Exclude dot entries */ +					if (res == FR_OK) { +						res = dir_read(&sdj); +						if (res == FR_OK		/* Not empty dir */ +#if _FS_RPATH +						|| dclst == dj.fs->cdir	/* Current dir */ +#endif +						) res = FR_DENIED; +						if (res == FR_NO_FILE) res = FR_OK;	/* Empty */ +					} +				} +			} +			if (res == FR_OK) { +				res = dir_remove(&dj);		/* Remove the directory entry */ +				if (res == FR_OK) { +					if (dclst)				/* Remove the cluster chain if exist */ +						res = remove_chain(dj.fs, dclst); +					if (res == FR_OK) res = sync(dj.fs); +				} +			} +		} +		FREE_BUF(); +	} +	LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Create a Directory                                                    */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_mkdir ( +	const TCHAR *path		/* Pointer to the directory path */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	DIR dj; +	BYTE *dir, n; +	DWORD dsc, dcl, pcl, tim = get_fattime(); +	DEF_NAMEBUF; + + +	res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 1); +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		INIT_BUF(dj); +		res = follow_path(&dj, path);			/* Follow the file path */ +		if (res == FR_OK) res = FR_EXIST;		/* Any object with same name is already existing */ +		if (_FS_RPATH && res == FR_NO_FILE && (dj.fn[NS] & NS_DOT)) +			res = FR_INVALID_NAME; +		if (res == FR_NO_FILE) {				/* Can create a new directory */ +			dcl = create_chain(dj.fs, 0);		/* Allocate a cluster for the new directory table */ +			res = FR_OK; +			if (dcl == 0) res = FR_DENIED;		/* No space to allocate a new cluster */ +			if (dcl == 1) res = FR_INT_ERR; +			if (dcl == 0xFFFFFFFF) res = FR_DISK_ERR; +			if (res == FR_OK)					/* Flush FAT */ +				res = move_window(dj.fs, 0); +			if (res == FR_OK) {					/* Initialize the new directory table */ +				dsc = clust2sect(dj.fs, dcl); +				dir = dj.fs->win; +				mem_set(dir, 0, SS(dj.fs)); +				mem_set(dir+DIR_Name, ' ', 8+3);	/* Create "." entry */ +				dir[DIR_Name] = '.'; +				dir[DIR_Attr] = AM_DIR; +				ST_DWORD(dir+DIR_WrtTime, tim); +				st_clust(dir, dcl); +				mem_cpy(dir+SZ_DIR, dir, SZ_DIR); 	/* Create ".." entry */ +				dir[33] = '.'; pcl = dj.sclust; +				if (dj.fs->fs_type == FS_FAT32 && pcl == dj.fs->dirbase) +					pcl = 0; +				st_clust(dir+SZ_DIR, pcl); +				for (n = dj.fs->csize; n; n--) {	/* Write dot entries and clear following sectors */ +					dj.fs->winsect = dsc++; +					dj.fs->wflag = 1; +					res = move_window(dj.fs, 0); +					if (res != FR_OK) break; +					mem_set(dir, 0, SS(dj.fs)); +				} +			} +			if (res == FR_OK) res = dir_register(&dj);	/* Register the object to the directory */ +			if (res != FR_OK) { +				remove_chain(dj.fs, dcl);			/* Could not register, remove cluster chain */ +			} else { +				dir = dj.dir; +				dir[DIR_Attr] = AM_DIR;				/* Attribute */ +				ST_DWORD(dir+DIR_WrtTime, tim);		/* Created time */ +				st_clust(dir, dcl);					/* Table start cluster */ +				dj.fs->wflag = 1; +				res = sync(dj.fs); +			} +		} +		FREE_BUF(); +	} + +	LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Change Attribute                                                      */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_chmod ( +	const TCHAR *path,	/* Pointer to the file path */ +	BYTE value,			/* Attribute bits */ +	BYTE mask			/* Attribute mask to change */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	DIR dj; +	BYTE *dir; +	DEF_NAMEBUF; + + +	res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 1); +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		INIT_BUF(dj); +		res = follow_path(&dj, path);		/* Follow the file path */ +		FREE_BUF(); +		if (_FS_RPATH && res == FR_OK && (dj.fn[NS] & NS_DOT)) +			res = FR_INVALID_NAME; +		if (res == FR_OK) { +			dir = dj.dir; +			if (!dir) {						/* Is it a root directory? */ +				res = FR_INVALID_NAME; +			} else {						/* File or sub directory */ +				mask &= AM_RDO|AM_HID|AM_SYS|AM_ARC;	/* Valid attribute mask */ +				dir[DIR_Attr] = (value & mask) | (dir[DIR_Attr] & (BYTE)~mask);	/* Apply attribute change */ +				dj.fs->wflag = 1; +				res = sync(dj.fs); +			} +		} +	} + +	LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Change Timestamp                                                      */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_utime ( +	const TCHAR *path,	/* Pointer to the file/directory name */ +	const FILINFO *fno	/* Pointer to the time stamp to be set */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	DIR dj; +	BYTE *dir; +	DEF_NAMEBUF; + + +	res = chk_mounted(&path, &dj.fs, 1); +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		INIT_BUF(dj); +		res = follow_path(&dj, path);	/* Follow the file path */ +		FREE_BUF(); +		if (_FS_RPATH && res == FR_OK && (dj.fn[NS] & NS_DOT)) +			res = FR_INVALID_NAME; +		if (res == FR_OK) { +			dir = dj.dir; +			if (!dir) {					/* Root directory */ +				res = FR_INVALID_NAME; +			} else {					/* File or sub-directory */ +				ST_WORD(dir+DIR_WrtTime, fno->ftime); +				ST_WORD(dir+DIR_WrtDate, fno->fdate); +				dj.fs->wflag = 1; +				res = sync(dj.fs); +			} +		} +	} + +	LEAVE_FF(dj.fs, res); +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Rename File/Directory                                                 */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_rename ( +	const TCHAR *path_old,	/* Pointer to the old name */ +	const TCHAR *path_new	/* Pointer to the new name */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	DIR djo, djn; +	BYTE buf[21], *dir; +	DWORD dw; +	DEF_NAMEBUF; + + +	res = chk_mounted(&path_old, &djo.fs, 1); +	if (res == FR_OK) { +		djn.fs = djo.fs; +		INIT_BUF(djo); +		res = follow_path(&djo, path_old);		/* Check old object */ +		if (_FS_RPATH && res == FR_OK && (djo.fn[NS] & NS_DOT)) +			res = FR_INVALID_NAME; +#if _FS_LOCK +		if (res == FR_OK) res = chk_lock(&djo, 2); +#endif +		if (res == FR_OK) {						/* Old object is found */ +			if (!djo.dir) {						/* Is root dir? */ +				res = FR_NO_FILE; +			} else { +				mem_cpy(buf, djo.dir+DIR_Attr, 21);		/* Save the object information except for name */ +				mem_cpy(&djn, &djo, sizeof (DIR));		/* Check new object */ +				res = follow_path(&djn, path_new); +				if (res == FR_OK) res = FR_EXIST;		/* The new object name is already existing */ +				if (res == FR_NO_FILE) { 				/* Is it a valid path and no name collision? */ +/* Start critical section that an interruption or error can cause cross-link */ +					res = dir_register(&djn);			/* Register the new entry */ +					if (res == FR_OK) { +						dir = djn.dir;					/* Copy object information except for name */ +						mem_cpy(dir+13, buf+2, 19); +						dir[DIR_Attr] = buf[0] | AM_ARC; +						djo.fs->wflag = 1; +						if (djo.sclust != djn.sclust && (dir[DIR_Attr] & AM_DIR)) {		/* Update .. entry in the directory if needed */ +							dw = clust2sect(djo.fs, ld_clust(djo.fs, dir)); +							if (!dw) { +								res = FR_INT_ERR; +							} else { +								res = move_window(djo.fs, dw); +								dir = djo.fs->win+SZ_DIR;	/* .. entry */ +								if (res == FR_OK && dir[1] == '.') { +									dw = (djo.fs->fs_type == FS_FAT32 && djn.sclust == djo.fs->dirbase) ? 0 : djn.sclust; +									st_clust(dir, dw); +									djo.fs->wflag = 1; +								} +							} +						} +						if (res == FR_OK) { +							res = dir_remove(&djo);		/* Remove old entry */ +							if (res == FR_OK) +								res = sync(djo.fs); +						} +					} +/* End critical section */ +				} +			} +		} +		FREE_BUF(); +	} +	LEAVE_FF(djo.fs, res); +} + +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ +#endif /* _FS_MINIMIZE == 0 */ +#endif /* _FS_MINIMIZE <= 1 */ +#endif /* _FS_MINIMIZE <= 2 */ + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Forward data to the stream directly (available on only tiny cfg)      */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if _USE_FORWARD && _FS_TINY + +FRESULT f_forward ( +	FIL *fp, 						/* Pointer to the file object */ +	UINT (*func)(const BYTE*,UINT),	/* Pointer to the streaming function */ +	UINT btr,						/* Number of bytes to forward */ +	UINT *bf						/* Pointer to number of bytes forwarded */ +) +{ +	FRESULT res; +	DWORD remain, clst, sect; +	UINT rcnt; +	BYTE csect; + + +	*bf = 0;	/* Clear transfer byte counter */ + +	if (!fp) return FR_INVALID_OBJECT; + +	res = validate(fp);								/* Check validity of the object */ +	if (res != FR_OK) LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, res); +	if (fp->flag & FA__ERROR)						/* Check error flag */ +		LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); +	if (!(fp->flag & FA_READ))						/* Check access mode */ +		LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_DENIED); + +	remain = fp->fsize - fp->fptr; +	if (btr > remain) btr = (UINT)remain;			/* Truncate btr by remaining bytes */ + +	for ( ;  btr && (*func)(0, 0);					/* Repeat until all data transferred or stream becomes busy */ +		fp->fptr += rcnt, *bf += rcnt, btr -= rcnt) { +		csect = (BYTE)(fp->fptr / SS(fp->fs) & (fp->fs->csize - 1));	/* Sector offset in the cluster */ +		if ((fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)) == 0) {			/* On the sector boundary? */ +			if (!csect) {							/* On the cluster boundary? */ +				clst = (fp->fptr == 0) ?			/* On the top of the file? */ +					fp->sclust : get_fat(fp->fs, fp->clust); +				if (clst <= 1) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); +				if (clst == 0xFFFFFFFF) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +				fp->clust = clst;					/* Update current cluster */ +			} +		} +		sect = clust2sect(fp->fs, fp->clust);		/* Get current data sector */ +		if (!sect) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); +		sect += csect; +		if (move_window(fp->fs, sect))				/* Move sector window */ +			ABORT(fp->fs, FR_DISK_ERR); +		fp->dsect = sect; +		rcnt = SS(fp->fs) - (WORD)(fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs));	/* Forward data from sector window */ +		if (rcnt > btr) rcnt = btr; +		rcnt = (*func)(&fp->fs->win[(WORD)fp->fptr % SS(fp->fs)], rcnt); +		if (!rcnt) ABORT(fp->fs, FR_INT_ERR); +	} + +	LEAVE_FF(fp->fs, FR_OK); +} +#endif /* _USE_FORWARD */ + + + +#if _USE_MKFS && !_FS_READONLY +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Create File System on the Drive                                       */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#define N_ROOTDIR	512		/* Number of root dir entries for FAT12/16 */ +#define N_FATS		1		/* Number of FAT copies (1 or 2) */ + + +FRESULT f_mkfs ( +	BYTE drv,		/* Logical drive number */ +	BYTE sfd,		/* Partitioning rule 0:FDISK, 1:SFD */ +	UINT au			/* Allocation unit size [bytes] */ +) +{ +	static const WORD vst[] = { 1024,   512,  256,  128,   64,    32,   16,    8,    4,    2,   0}; +	static const WORD cst[] = {32768, 16384, 8192, 4096, 2048, 16384, 8192, 4096, 2048, 1024, 512}; +	BYTE fmt, md, sys, *tbl, pdrv, part; +	DWORD n_clst, vs, n, wsect; +	UINT i; +	DWORD b_vol, b_fat, b_dir, b_data;	/* LBA */ +	DWORD n_vol, n_rsv, n_fat, n_dir;	/* Size */ +	FATFS *fs; +	DSTATUS stat; + + +	/* Check mounted drive and clear work area */ +	if (drv >= _VOLUMES) return FR_INVALID_DRIVE; +	if (sfd > 1) return FR_INVALID_PARAMETER; +	if (au & (au - 1)) return FR_INVALID_PARAMETER; +	fs = FatFs[drv]; +	if (!fs) return FR_NOT_ENABLED; +	fs->fs_type = 0; +	pdrv = LD2PD(drv);	/* Physical drive */ +	part = LD2PT(drv);	/* Partition (0:auto detect, 1-4:get from partition table)*/ + +	/* Get disk statics */ +	stat = disk_initialize(pdrv); +	if (stat & STA_NOINIT) return FR_NOT_READY; +	if (stat & STA_PROTECT) return FR_WRITE_PROTECTED; +#if _MAX_SS != 512					/* Get disk sector size */ +	if (disk_ioctl(pdrv, GET_SECTOR_SIZE, &SS(fs)) != RES_OK || SS(fs) > _MAX_SS) +		return FR_DISK_ERR; +#endif +	if (_MULTI_PARTITION && part) { +		/* Get partition information from partition table in the MBR */ +		if (disk_read(pdrv, fs->win, 0, 1) != RES_OK) return FR_DISK_ERR; +		if (LD_WORD(fs->win+BS_55AA) != 0xAA55) return FR_MKFS_ABORTED; +		tbl = &fs->win[MBR_Table + (part - 1) * SZ_PTE]; +		if (!tbl[4]) return FR_MKFS_ABORTED;	/* No partition? */ +		b_vol = LD_DWORD(tbl+8);	/* Volume start sector */ +		n_vol = LD_DWORD(tbl+12);	/* Volume size */ +	} else { +		/* Create a partition in this function */ +		if (disk_ioctl(pdrv, GET_SECTOR_COUNT, &n_vol) != RES_OK || n_vol < 128) +			return FR_DISK_ERR; +		b_vol = (sfd) ? 0 : 63;		/* Volume start sector */ +		n_vol -= b_vol;				/* Volume size */ +	} + +	if (!au) {				/* AU auto selection */ +		vs = n_vol / (2000 / (SS(fs) / 512)); +		for (i = 0; vs < vst[i]; i++) ; +		au = cst[i]; +	} +	au /= SS(fs);		/* Number of sectors per cluster */ +	if (au == 0) au = 1; +	if (au > 128) au = 128; + +	/* Pre-compute number of clusters and FAT sub-type */ +	n_clst = n_vol / au; +	fmt = FS_FAT12; +	if (n_clst >= MIN_FAT16) fmt = FS_FAT16; +	if (n_clst >= MIN_FAT32) fmt = FS_FAT32; + +	/* Determine offset and size of FAT structure */ +	if (fmt == FS_FAT32) { +		n_fat = ((n_clst * 4) + 8 + SS(fs) - 1) / SS(fs); +		n_rsv = 32; +		n_dir = 0; +	} else { +		n_fat = (fmt == FS_FAT12) ? (n_clst * 3 + 1) / 2 + 3 : (n_clst * 2) + 4; +		n_fat = (n_fat + SS(fs) - 1) / SS(fs); +		n_rsv = 1; +		n_dir = (DWORD)N_ROOTDIR * SZ_DIR / SS(fs); +	} +	b_fat = b_vol + n_rsv;				/* FAT area start sector */ +	b_dir = b_fat + n_fat * N_FATS;		/* Directory area start sector */ +	b_data = b_dir + n_dir;				/* Data area start sector */ +	if (n_vol < b_data + au - b_vol) return FR_MKFS_ABORTED;	/* Too small volume */ + +	/* Align data start sector to erase block boundary (for flash memory media) */ +	if (disk_ioctl(pdrv, GET_BLOCK_SIZE, &n) != RES_OK || !n || n > 32768) n = 1; +	n = (b_data + n - 1) & ~(n - 1);	/* Next nearest erase block from current data start */ +	n = (n - b_data) / N_FATS; +	if (fmt == FS_FAT32) {		/* FAT32: Move FAT offset */ +		n_rsv += n; +		b_fat += n; +	} else {					/* FAT12/16: Expand FAT size */ +		n_fat += n; +	} + +	/* Determine number of clusters and final check of validity of the FAT sub-type */ +	n_clst = (n_vol - n_rsv - n_fat * N_FATS - n_dir) / au; +	if (   (fmt == FS_FAT16 && n_clst < MIN_FAT16) +		|| (fmt == FS_FAT32 && n_clst < MIN_FAT32)) +		return FR_MKFS_ABORTED; + +	switch (fmt) {	/* Determine system ID for partition table */ +	case FS_FAT12:	sys = 0x01; break; +	case FS_FAT16:	sys = (n_vol < 0x10000) ? 0x04 : 0x06; break; +	default: 		sys = 0x0C; +	} + +	if (_MULTI_PARTITION && part) { +		/* Update system ID in the partition table */ +		tbl = &fs->win[MBR_Table + (part - 1) * SZ_PTE]; +		tbl[4] = sys; +		if (disk_write(pdrv, fs->win, 0, 1) != RES_OK) return FR_DISK_ERR; +		md = 0xF8; +	} else { +		if (sfd) {	/* No partition table (SFD) */ +			md = 0xF0; +		} else {	/* Create partition table (FDISK) */ +			mem_set(fs->win, 0, SS(fs)); +			tbl = fs->win+MBR_Table;	/* Create partition table for single partition in the drive */ +			tbl[1] = 1;						/* Partition start head */ +			tbl[2] = 1;						/* Partition start sector */ +			tbl[3] = 0;						/* Partition start cylinder */ +			tbl[4] = sys;					/* System type */ +			tbl[5] = 254;					/* Partition end head */ +			n = (b_vol + n_vol) / 63 / 255; +			tbl[6] = (BYTE)((n >> 2) | 63);	/* Partition end sector */ +			tbl[7] = (BYTE)n;				/* End cylinder */ +			ST_DWORD(tbl+8, 63);			/* Partition start in LBA */ +			ST_DWORD(tbl+12, n_vol);		/* Partition size in LBA */ +			ST_WORD(fs->win+BS_55AA, 0xAA55);	/* MBR signature */ +			if (disk_write(pdrv, fs->win, 0, 1) != RES_OK)	/* Write it to the MBR sector */ +				return FR_DISK_ERR; +			md = 0xF8; +		} +	} + +	/* Create BPB in the VBR */ +	tbl = fs->win;							/* Clear sector */ +	mem_set(tbl, 0, SS(fs)); +	mem_cpy(tbl, "\xEB\xFE\x90" "MSDOS5.0", 11);/* Boot jump code, OEM name */ +	i = SS(fs);								/* Sector size */ +	ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_BytsPerSec, i); +	tbl[BPB_SecPerClus] = (BYTE)au;			/* Sectors per cluster */ +	ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_RsvdSecCnt, n_rsv);		/* Reserved sectors */ +	tbl[BPB_NumFATs] = N_FATS;				/* Number of FATs */ +	i = (fmt == FS_FAT32) ? 0 : N_ROOTDIR;	/* Number of rootdir entries */ +	ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_RootEntCnt, i); +	if (n_vol < 0x10000) {					/* Number of total sectors */ +		ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_TotSec16, n_vol); +	} else { +		ST_DWORD(tbl+BPB_TotSec32, n_vol); +	} +	tbl[BPB_Media] = md;					/* Media descriptor */ +	ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_SecPerTrk, 63);			/* Number of sectors per track */ +	ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_NumHeads, 255);			/* Number of heads */ +	ST_DWORD(tbl+BPB_HiddSec, b_vol);		/* Hidden sectors */ +	n = get_fattime();						/* Use current time as VSN */ +	if (fmt == FS_FAT32) { +		ST_DWORD(tbl+BS_VolID32, n);		/* VSN */ +		ST_DWORD(tbl+BPB_FATSz32, n_fat);	/* Number of sectors per FAT */ +		ST_DWORD(tbl+BPB_RootClus, 2);		/* Root directory start cluster (2) */ +		ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_FSInfo, 1);			/* FSInfo record offset (VBR+1) */ +		ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_BkBootSec, 6);		/* Backup boot record offset (VBR+6) */ +		tbl[BS_DrvNum32] = 0x80;			/* Drive number */ +		tbl[BS_BootSig32] = 0x29;			/* Extended boot signature */ +		mem_cpy(tbl+BS_VolLab32, "NO NAME    " "FAT32   ", 19);	/* Volume label, FAT signature */ +	} else { +		ST_DWORD(tbl+BS_VolID, n);			/* VSN */ +		ST_WORD(tbl+BPB_FATSz16, n_fat);	/* Number of sectors per FAT */ +		tbl[BS_DrvNum] = 0x80;				/* Drive number */ +		tbl[BS_BootSig] = 0x29;				/* Extended boot signature */ +		mem_cpy(tbl+BS_VolLab, "NO NAME    " "FAT     ", 19);	/* Volume label, FAT signature */ +	} +	ST_WORD(tbl+BS_55AA, 0xAA55);			/* Signature (Offset is fixed here regardless of sector size) */ +	if (disk_write(pdrv, tbl, b_vol, 1) != RES_OK)	/* Write it to the VBR sector */ +		return FR_DISK_ERR; +	if (fmt == FS_FAT32)							/* Write backup VBR if needed (VBR+6) */ +		disk_write(pdrv, tbl, b_vol + 6, 1); + +	/* Initialize FAT area */ +	wsect = b_fat; +	for (i = 0; i < N_FATS; i++) {		/* Initialize each FAT copy */ +		mem_set(tbl, 0, SS(fs));			/* 1st sector of the FAT  */ +		n = md;								/* Media descriptor byte */ +		if (fmt != FS_FAT32) { +			n |= (fmt == FS_FAT12) ? 0x00FFFF00 : 0xFFFFFF00; +			ST_DWORD(tbl+0, n);				/* Reserve cluster #0-1 (FAT12/16) */ +		} else { +			n |= 0xFFFFFF00; +			ST_DWORD(tbl+0, n);				/* Reserve cluster #0-1 (FAT32) */ +			ST_DWORD(tbl+4, 0xFFFFFFFF); +			ST_DWORD(tbl+8, 0x0FFFFFFF);	/* Reserve cluster #2 for root dir */ +		} +		if (disk_write(pdrv, tbl, wsect++, 1) != RES_OK) +			return FR_DISK_ERR; +		mem_set(tbl, 0, SS(fs));			/* Fill following FAT entries with zero */ +		for (n = 1; n < n_fat; n++) {		/* This loop may take a time on FAT32 volume due to many single sector writes */ +			if (disk_write(pdrv, tbl, wsect++, 1) != RES_OK) +				return FR_DISK_ERR; +		} +	} + +	/* Initialize root directory */ +	i = (fmt == FS_FAT32) ? au : n_dir; +	do { +		if (disk_write(pdrv, tbl, wsect++, 1) != RES_OK) +			return FR_DISK_ERR; +	} while (--i); + +#if _USE_ERASE	/* Erase data area if needed */ +	{ +		DWORD eb[2]; + +		eb[0] = wsect; eb[1] = wsect + (n_clst - ((fmt == FS_FAT32) ? 1 : 0)) * au - 1; +		disk_ioctl(pdrv, CTRL_ERASE_SECTOR, eb); +	} +#endif + +	/* Create FSInfo if needed */ +	if (fmt == FS_FAT32) { +		ST_DWORD(tbl+FSI_LeadSig, 0x41615252); +		ST_DWORD(tbl+FSI_StrucSig, 0x61417272); +		ST_DWORD(tbl+FSI_Free_Count, n_clst - 1);	/* Number of free clusters */ +		ST_DWORD(tbl+FSI_Nxt_Free, 2);				/* Last allocated cluster# */ +		ST_WORD(tbl+BS_55AA, 0xAA55); +		disk_write(pdrv, tbl, b_vol + 1, 1);	/* Write original (VBR+1) */ +		disk_write(pdrv, tbl, b_vol + 7, 1);	/* Write backup (VBR+7) */ +	} + +	return (disk_ioctl(pdrv, CTRL_SYNC, 0) == RES_OK) ? FR_OK : FR_DISK_ERR; +} + + +#if _MULTI_PARTITION == 2 +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Divide Physical Drive                                                 */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +FRESULT f_fdisk ( +	BYTE pdrv,			/* Physical drive number */ +	const DWORD szt[],	/* Pointer to the size table for each partitions */ +	void* work			/* Pointer to the working buffer */ +) +{ +	UINT i, n, sz_cyl, tot_cyl, b_cyl, e_cyl, p_cyl; +	BYTE s_hd, e_hd, *p, *buf = (BYTE*)work; +	DSTATUS stat; +	DWORD sz_disk, sz_part, s_part; + + +	stat = disk_initialize(pdrv); +	if (stat & STA_NOINIT) return FR_NOT_READY; +	if (stat & STA_PROTECT) return FR_WRITE_PROTECTED; +	if (disk_ioctl(pdrv, GET_SECTOR_COUNT, &sz_disk)) return FR_DISK_ERR; + +	/* Determine CHS in the table regardless of the drive geometry */ +	for (n = 16; n < 256 && sz_disk / n / 63 > 1024; n *= 2) ; +	if (n == 256) n--; +	e_hd = n - 1; +	sz_cyl = 63 * n; +	tot_cyl = sz_disk / sz_cyl; + +	/* Create partition table */ +	mem_set(buf, 0, _MAX_SS); +	p = buf + MBR_Table; b_cyl = 0; +	for (i = 0; i < 4; i++, p += SZ_PTE) { +		p_cyl = (szt[i] <= 100) ? (DWORD)tot_cyl * szt[i] / 100 : szt[i] / sz_cyl; +		if (!p_cyl) continue; +		s_part = (DWORD)sz_cyl * b_cyl; +		sz_part = (DWORD)sz_cyl * p_cyl; +		if (i == 0) {	/* Exclude first track of cylinder 0 */ +			s_hd = 1; +			s_part += 63; sz_part -= 63; +		} else { +			s_hd = 0; +		} +		e_cyl = b_cyl + p_cyl - 1; +		if (e_cyl >= tot_cyl) return FR_INVALID_PARAMETER; + +		/* Set partition table */ +		p[1] = s_hd;						/* Start head */ +		p[2] = (BYTE)((b_cyl >> 2) + 1);	/* Start sector */ +		p[3] = (BYTE)b_cyl;					/* Start cylinder */ +		p[4] = 0x06;						/* System type (temporary setting) */ +		p[5] = e_hd;						/* End head */ +		p[6] = (BYTE)((e_cyl >> 2) + 63);	/* End sector */ +		p[7] = (BYTE)e_cyl;					/* End cylinder */ +		ST_DWORD(p + 8, s_part);			/* Start sector in LBA */ +		ST_DWORD(p + 12, sz_part);			/* Partition size */ + +		/* Next partition */ +		b_cyl += p_cyl; +	} +	ST_WORD(p, 0xAA55); + +	/* Write it to the MBR */ +	return (disk_write(pdrv, buf, 0, 1) || disk_ioctl(pdrv, CTRL_SYNC, 0)) ? FR_DISK_ERR : FR_OK; +} + + +#endif /* _MULTI_PARTITION == 2 */ +#endif /* _USE_MKFS && !_FS_READONLY */ + + + + +#if _USE_STRFUNC +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Get a string from the file                                            */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +TCHAR* f_gets ( +	TCHAR* buff,	/* Pointer to the string buffer to read */ +	int len,		/* Size of string buffer (characters) */ +	FIL* fil		/* Pointer to the file object */ +) +{ +	int n = 0; +	TCHAR c, *p = buff; +	BYTE s[2]; +	UINT rc; + + +	while (n < len - 1) {			/* Read bytes until buffer gets filled */ +		f_read(fil, s, 1, &rc); +		if (rc != 1) break;			/* Break on EOF or error */ +		c = s[0]; +#if _LFN_UNICODE					/* Read a character in UTF-8 encoding */ +		if (c >= 0x80) { +			if (c < 0xC0) continue;	/* Skip stray trailer */ +			if (c < 0xE0) {			/* Two-byte sequence */ +				f_read(fil, s, 1, &rc); +				if (rc != 1) break; +				c = ((c & 0x1F) << 6) | (s[0] & 0x3F); +				if (c < 0x80) c = '?'; +			} else { +				if (c < 0xF0) {		/* Three-byte sequence */ +					f_read(fil, s, 2, &rc); +					if (rc != 2) break; +					c = (c << 12) | ((s[0] & 0x3F) << 6) | (s[1] & 0x3F); +					if (c < 0x800) c = '?'; +				} else {			/* Reject four-byte sequence */ +					c = '?'; +				} +			} +		} +#endif +#if _USE_STRFUNC >= 2 +		if (c == '\r') continue;	/* Strip '\r' */ +#endif +		*p++ = c; +		n++; +		if (c == '\n') break;		/* Break on EOL */ +	} +	*p = 0; +	return n ? buff : 0;			/* When no data read (eof or error), return with error. */ +} + + + +#if !_FS_READONLY +#include <stdarg.h> +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Put a character to the file                                           */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +int f_putc ( +	TCHAR c,	/* A character to be output */ +	FIL* fil	/* Pointer to the file object */ +) +{ +	UINT bw, btw; +	BYTE s[3]; + + +#if _USE_STRFUNC >= 2 +	if (c == '\n') f_putc ('\r', fil);	/* LF -> CRLF conversion */ +#endif + +#if _LFN_UNICODE	/* Write the character in UTF-8 encoding */ +	if (c < 0x80) {			/* 7-bit */ +		s[0] = (BYTE)c; +		btw = 1; +	} else { +		if (c < 0x800) {	/* 11-bit */ +			s[0] = (BYTE)(0xC0 | (c >> 6)); +			s[1] = (BYTE)(0x80 | (c & 0x3F)); +			btw = 2; +		} else {			/* 16-bit */ +			s[0] = (BYTE)(0xE0 | (c >> 12)); +			s[1] = (BYTE)(0x80 | ((c >> 6) & 0x3F)); +			s[2] = (BYTE)(0x80 | (c & 0x3F)); +			btw = 3; +		} +	} +#else				/* Write the character without conversion */ +	s[0] = (BYTE)c; +	btw = 1; +#endif +	f_write(fil, s, btw, &bw);		/* Write the char to the file */ +	return (bw == btw) ? 1 : EOF;	/* Return the result */ +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Put a string to the file                                              */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +int f_puts ( +	const TCHAR* str,	/* Pointer to the string to be output */ +	FIL* fil			/* Pointer to the file object */ +) +{ +	int n; + + +	for (n = 0; *str; str++, n++) { +		if (f_putc(*str, fil) == EOF) return EOF; +	} +	return n; +} + + + + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Put a formatted string to the file                                    */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +int f_printf ( +	FIL* fil,			/* Pointer to the file object */ +	const TCHAR* str,	/* Pointer to the format string */ +	...					/* Optional arguments... */ +) +{ +	va_list arp; +	BYTE f, r; +	UINT i, j, w; +	ULONG v; +	TCHAR c, d, s[16], *p; +	int res, chc, cc; + + +	va_start(arp, str); + +	for (cc = res = 0; cc != EOF; res += cc) { +		c = *str++; +		if (c == 0) break;			/* End of string */ +		if (c != '%') {				/* Non escape character */ +			cc = f_putc(c, fil); +			if (cc != EOF) cc = 1; +			continue; +		} +		w = f = 0; +		c = *str++; +		if (c == '0') {				/* Flag: '0' padding */ +			f = 1; c = *str++; +		} else { +			if (c == '-') {			/* Flag: left justified */ +				f = 2; c = *str++; +			} +		} +		while (IsDigit(c)) {		/* Precision */ +			w = w * 10 + c - '0'; +			c = *str++; +		} +		if (c == 'l' || c == 'L') {	/* Prefix: Size is long int */ +			f |= 4; c = *str++; +		} +		if (!c) break; +		d = c; +		if (IsLower(d)) d -= 0x20; +		switch (d) {				/* Type is... */ +		case 'S' :					/* String */ +			p = va_arg(arp, TCHAR*); +			for (j = 0; p[j]; j++) ; +			chc = 0; +			if (!(f & 2)) { +				while (j++ < w) chc += (cc = f_putc(' ', fil)); +			} +			chc += (cc = f_puts(p, fil)); +			while (j++ < w) chc += (cc = f_putc(' ', fil)); +			if (cc != EOF) cc = chc; +			continue; +		case 'C' :					/* Character */ +			cc = f_putc((TCHAR)va_arg(arp, int), fil); continue; +		case 'B' :					/* Binary */ +			r = 2; break; +		case 'O' :					/* Octal */ +			r = 8; break; +		case 'D' :					/* Signed decimal */ +		case 'U' :					/* Unsigned decimal */ +			r = 10; break; +		case 'X' :					/* Hexdecimal */ +			r = 16; break; +		default:					/* Unknown type (pass-through) */ +			cc = f_putc(c, fil); continue; +		} + +		/* Get an argument and put it in numeral */ +		v = (f & 4) ? (ULONG)va_arg(arp, long) : ((d == 'D') ? (ULONG)(long)va_arg(arp, int) : (ULONG)va_arg(arp, unsigned int)); +		if (d == 'D' && (v & 0x80000000)) { +			v = 0 - v; +			f |= 8; +		} +		i = 0; +		do { +			d = (TCHAR)(v % r); v /= r; +			if (d > 9) d += (c == 'x') ? 0x27 : 0x07; +			s[i++] = d + '0'; +		} while (v && i < sizeof s / sizeof s[0]); +		if (f & 8) s[i++] = '-'; +		j = i; d = (f & 1) ? '0' : ' '; +		res = 0; +		while (!(f & 2) && j++ < w) res += (cc = f_putc(d, fil)); +		do res += (cc = f_putc(s[--i], fil)); while(i); +		while (j++ < w) res += (cc = f_putc(' ', fil)); +		if (cc != EOF) cc = res; +	} + +	va_end(arp); +	return (cc == EOF) ? cc : res; +} + +#endif /* !_FS_READONLY */ +#endif /* _USE_STRFUNC */ diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/ff.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/ff.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..627cbaabe6 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/ff.h @@ -0,0 +1,337 @@ +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/  FatFs - FAT file system module include file  R0.09a    (C)ChaN, 2012 +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ FatFs module is a generic FAT file system module for small embedded systems. +/ This is a free software that opened for education, research and commercial +/ developments under license policy of following terms. +/ +/  Copyright (C) 2012, ChaN, all right reserved. +/ +/ * The FatFs module is a free software and there is NO WARRANTY. +/ * No restriction on use. You can use, modify and redistribute it for +/   personal, non-profit or commercial product UNDER YOUR RESPONSIBILITY. +/ * Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice. +/ +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#ifndef _FATFS +#define _FATFS	4004	/* Revision ID */ + +#ifdef __cplusplus +extern "C" { +#endif + +#include "integer.h"	/* Basic integer types */ +#include "ffconf.h"		/* FatFs configuration options */ + +#if _FATFS != _FFCONF +#error Wrong configuration file (ffconf.h). +#endif + + + +/* Definitions of volume management */ + +#if _MULTI_PARTITION		/* Multiple partition configuration */ +typedef struct { +	BYTE pd;	/* Physical drive number */ +	BYTE pt;	/* Partition: 0:Auto detect, 1-4:Forced partition) */ +} PARTITION; +extern PARTITION VolToPart[];	/* Volume - Partition resolution table */ +#define LD2PD(vol) (VolToPart[vol].pd)	/* Get physical drive number */ +#define LD2PT(vol) (VolToPart[vol].pt)	/* Get partition index */ + +#else							/* Single partition configuration */ +#define LD2PD(vol) (BYTE)(vol)	/* Each logical drive is bound to the same physical drive number */ +#define LD2PT(vol) 0			/* Always mounts the 1st partition or in SFD */ + +#endif + + + +/* Type of path name strings on FatFs API */ + +#if _LFN_UNICODE			/* Unicode string */ +#if !_USE_LFN +#error _LFN_UNICODE must be 0 in non-LFN cfg. +#endif +#ifndef _INC_TCHAR +typedef WCHAR TCHAR; +#define _T(x) L ## x +#define _TEXT(x) L ## x +#endif + +#else						/* ANSI/OEM string */ +#ifndef _INC_TCHAR +typedef char TCHAR; +#define _T(x) x +#define _TEXT(x) x +#endif + +#endif + + + +/* File system object structure (FATFS) */ + +typedef struct { +	BYTE	fs_type;		/* FAT sub-type (0:Not mounted) */ +	BYTE	drv;			/* Physical drive number */ +	BYTE	csize;			/* Sectors per cluster (1,2,4...128) */ +	BYTE	n_fats;			/* Number of FAT copies (1,2) */ +	BYTE	wflag;			/* win[] dirty flag (1:must be written back) */ +	BYTE	fsi_flag;		/* fsinfo dirty flag (1:must be written back) */ +	WORD	id;				/* File system mount ID */ +	WORD	n_rootdir;		/* Number of root directory entries (FAT12/16) */ +#if _MAX_SS != 512 +	WORD	ssize;			/* Bytes per sector (512, 1024, 2048 or 4096) */ +#endif +#if _FS_REENTRANT +	_SYNC_t	sobj;			/* Identifier of sync object */ +#endif +#if !_FS_READONLY +	DWORD	last_clust;		/* Last allocated cluster */ +	DWORD	free_clust;		/* Number of free clusters */ +	DWORD	fsi_sector;		/* fsinfo sector (FAT32) */ +#endif +#if _FS_RPATH +	DWORD	cdir;			/* Current directory start cluster (0:root) */ +#endif +	DWORD	n_fatent;		/* Number of FAT entries (= number of clusters + 2) */ +	DWORD	fsize;			/* Sectors per FAT */ +	DWORD	fatbase;		/* FAT start sector */ +	DWORD	dirbase;		/* Root directory start sector (FAT32:Cluster#) */ +	DWORD	database;		/* Data start sector */ +	DWORD	winsect;		/* Current sector appearing in the win[] */ +	BYTE	win[_MAX_SS];	/* Disk access window for Directory, FAT (and Data on tiny cfg) */ +} FATFS; + + + +/* File object structure (FIL) */ + +typedef struct { +	FATFS*	fs;				/* Pointer to the related file system object */ +	WORD	id;				/* File system mount ID of the related file system object */ +	BYTE	flag;			/* File status flags */ +	BYTE	pad1; +	DWORD	fptr;			/* File read/write pointer (0ed on file open) */ +	DWORD	fsize;			/* File size */ +	DWORD	sclust;			/* File data start cluster (0:no data cluster, always 0 when fsize is 0) */ +	DWORD	clust;			/* Current cluster of fpter */ +	DWORD	dsect;			/* Current data sector of fpter */ +#if !_FS_READONLY +	DWORD	dir_sect;		/* Sector containing the directory entry */ +	BYTE*	dir_ptr;		/* Pointer to the directory entry in the window */ +#endif +#if _USE_FASTSEEK +	DWORD*	cltbl;			/* Pointer to the cluster link map table (null on file open) */ +#endif +#if _FS_LOCK +	UINT	lockid;			/* File lock ID (index of file semaphore table Files[]) */ +#endif +#if !_FS_TINY +	BYTE	buf[_MAX_SS];	/* File data read/write buffer */ +#endif +} FIL; + + + +/* Directory object structure (DIR) */ + +typedef struct { +	FATFS*	fs;				/* Pointer to the owner file system object */ +	WORD	id;				/* Owner file system mount ID */ +	WORD	index;			/* Current read/write index number */ +	DWORD	sclust;			/* Table start cluster (0:Root dir) */ +	DWORD	clust;			/* Current cluster */ +	DWORD	sect;			/* Current sector */ +	BYTE*	dir;			/* Pointer to the current SFN entry in the win[] */ +	BYTE*	fn;				/* Pointer to the SFN (in/out) {file[8],ext[3],status[1]} */ +#if _USE_LFN +	WCHAR*	lfn;			/* Pointer to the LFN working buffer */ +	WORD	lfn_idx;		/* Last matched LFN index number (0xFFFF:No LFN) */ +#endif +} DIR; + + + +/* File status structure (FILINFO) */ + +typedef struct { +	DWORD	fsize;			/* File size */ +	WORD	fdate;			/* Last modified date */ +	WORD	ftime;			/* Last modified time */ +	BYTE	fattrib;		/* Attribute */ +	TCHAR	fname[13];		/* Short file name (8.3 format) */ +#if _USE_LFN +	TCHAR*	lfname;			/* Pointer to the LFN buffer */ +	UINT 	lfsize;			/* Size of LFN buffer in TCHAR */ +#endif +} FILINFO; + + + +/* File function return code (FRESULT) */ + +typedef enum { +	FR_OK = 0,				/* (0) Succeeded */ +	FR_DISK_ERR,			/* (1) A hard error occurred in the low level disk I/O layer */ +	FR_INT_ERR,				/* (2) Assertion failed */ +	FR_NOT_READY,			/* (3) The physical drive cannot work */ +	FR_NO_FILE,				/* (4) Could not find the file */ +	FR_NO_PATH,				/* (5) Could not find the path */ +	FR_INVALID_NAME,		/* (6) The path name format is invalid */ +	FR_DENIED,				/* (7) Access denied due to prohibited access or directory full */ +	FR_EXIST,				/* (8) Access denied due to prohibited access */ +	FR_INVALID_OBJECT,		/* (9) The file/directory object is invalid */ +	FR_WRITE_PROTECTED,		/* (10) The physical drive is write protected */ +	FR_INVALID_DRIVE,		/* (11) The logical drive number is invalid */ +	FR_NOT_ENABLED,			/* (12) The volume has no work area */ +	FR_NO_FILESYSTEM,		/* (13) There is no valid FAT volume */ +	FR_MKFS_ABORTED,		/* (14) The f_mkfs() aborted due to any parameter error */ +	FR_TIMEOUT,				/* (15) Could not get a grant to access the volume within defined period */ +	FR_LOCKED,				/* (16) The operation is rejected according to the file sharing policy */ +	FR_NOT_ENOUGH_CORE,		/* (17) LFN working buffer could not be allocated */ +	FR_TOO_MANY_OPEN_FILES,	/* (18) Number of open files > _FS_SHARE */ +	FR_INVALID_PARAMETER	/* (19) Given parameter is invalid */ +} FRESULT; + + + +/*--------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* FatFs module application interface                           */ + +FRESULT f_mount (BYTE, FATFS*);						/* Mount/Unmount a logical drive */ +FRESULT f_open (FIL*, const TCHAR*, BYTE);			/* Open or create a file */ +FRESULT f_read (FIL*, void*, UINT, UINT*);			/* Read data from a file */ +FRESULT f_lseek (FIL*, DWORD);						/* Move file pointer of a file object */ +FRESULT f_close (FIL*);								/* Close an open file object */ +FRESULT f_opendir (DIR*, const TCHAR*);				/* Open an existing directory */ +FRESULT f_readdir (DIR*, FILINFO*);					/* Read a directory item */ +FRESULT f_stat (const TCHAR*, FILINFO*);			/* Get file status */ +FRESULT f_write (FIL*, const void*, UINT, UINT*);	/* Write data to a file */ +FRESULT f_getfree (const TCHAR*, DWORD*, FATFS**);	/* Get number of free clusters on the drive */ +FRESULT f_truncate (FIL*);							/* Truncate file */ +FRESULT f_sync (FIL*);								/* Flush cached data of a writing file */ +FRESULT f_unlink (const TCHAR*);					/* Delete an existing file or directory */ +FRESULT	f_mkdir (const TCHAR*);						/* Create a new directory */ +FRESULT f_chmod (const TCHAR*, BYTE, BYTE);			/* Change attribute of the file/dir */ +FRESULT f_utime (const TCHAR*, const FILINFO*);		/* Change times-tamp of the file/dir */ +FRESULT f_rename (const TCHAR*, const TCHAR*);		/* Rename/Move a file or directory */ +FRESULT f_chdrive (BYTE);							/* Change current drive */ +FRESULT f_chdir (const TCHAR*);						/* Change current directory */ +FRESULT f_getcwd (TCHAR*, UINT);					/* Get current directory */ +FRESULT f_forward (FIL*, UINT(*)(const BYTE*,UINT), UINT, UINT*);	/* Forward data to the stream */ +FRESULT f_mkfs (BYTE, BYTE, UINT);					/* Create a file system on the drive */ +FRESULT	f_fdisk (BYTE, const DWORD[], void*);		/* Divide a physical drive into some partitions */ +int f_putc (TCHAR, FIL*);							/* Put a character to the file */ +int f_puts (const TCHAR*, FIL*);					/* Put a string to the file */ +int f_printf (FIL*, const TCHAR*, ...);				/* Put a formatted string to the file */ +TCHAR* f_gets (TCHAR*, int, FIL*);					/* Get a string from the file */ + +#define f_eof(fp) (((fp)->fptr == (fp)->fsize) ? 1 : 0) +#define f_error(fp) (((fp)->flag & FA__ERROR) ? 1 : 0) +#define f_tell(fp) ((fp)->fptr) +#define f_size(fp) ((fp)->fsize) + +#ifndef EOF +#define EOF (-1) +#endif + + + + +/*--------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Additional user defined functions                            */ + +/* RTC function */ +#if !_FS_READONLY +DWORD get_fattime (void); +#endif + +/* Unicode support functions */ +#if _USE_LFN						/* Unicode - OEM code conversion */ +WCHAR ff_convert (WCHAR, UINT);		/* OEM-Unicode bidirectional conversion */ +WCHAR ff_wtoupper (WCHAR);			/* Unicode upper-case conversion */ +#if _USE_LFN == 3					/* Memory functions */ +void* ff_memalloc (UINT);			/* Allocate memory block */ +void ff_memfree (void*);			/* Free memory block */ +#endif +#endif + +/* Sync functions */ +#if _FS_REENTRANT +int ff_cre_syncobj (BYTE, _SYNC_t*);/* Create a sync object */ +int ff_req_grant (_SYNC_t);			/* Lock sync object */ +void ff_rel_grant (_SYNC_t);		/* Unlock sync object */ +int ff_del_syncobj (_SYNC_t);		/* Delete a sync object */ +#endif + + + + +/*--------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Flags and offset address                                     */ + + +/* File access control and file status flags (FIL.flag) */ + +#define	FA_READ				0x01 +#define	FA_OPEN_EXISTING	0x00 +#define FA__ERROR			0x80 + +#if !_FS_READONLY +#define	FA_WRITE			0x02 +#define	FA_CREATE_NEW		0x04 +#define	FA_CREATE_ALWAYS	0x08 +#define	FA_OPEN_ALWAYS		0x10 +#define FA__WRITTEN			0x20 +#define FA__DIRTY			0x40 +#endif + + +/* FAT sub type (FATFS.fs_type) */ + +#define FS_FAT12	1 +#define FS_FAT16	2 +#define FS_FAT32	3 + + +/* File attribute bits for directory entry */ + +#define	AM_RDO	0x01	/* Read only */ +#define	AM_HID	0x02	/* Hidden */ +#define	AM_SYS	0x04	/* System */ +#define	AM_VOL	0x08	/* Volume label */ +#define AM_LFN	0x0F	/* LFN entry */ +#define AM_DIR	0x10	/* Directory */ +#define AM_ARC	0x20	/* Archive */ +#define AM_MASK	0x3F	/* Mask of defined bits */ + + +/* Fast seek feature */ +#define CREATE_LINKMAP	0xFFFFFFFF + + + +/*--------------------------------*/ +/* Multi-byte word access macros  */ + +#if _WORD_ACCESS == 1	/* Enable word access to the FAT structure */ +#define	LD_WORD(ptr)		(WORD)(*(WORD*)(BYTE*)(ptr)) +#define	LD_DWORD(ptr)		(DWORD)(*(DWORD*)(BYTE*)(ptr)) +#define	ST_WORD(ptr,val)	*(WORD*)(BYTE*)(ptr)=(WORD)(val) +#define	ST_DWORD(ptr,val)	*(DWORD*)(BYTE*)(ptr)=(DWORD)(val) +#else					/* Use byte-by-byte access to the FAT structure */ +#define	LD_WORD(ptr)		(WORD)(((WORD)*((BYTE*)(ptr)+1)<<8)|(WORD)*(BYTE*)(ptr)) +#define	LD_DWORD(ptr)		(DWORD)(((DWORD)*((BYTE*)(ptr)+3)<<24)|((DWORD)*((BYTE*)(ptr)+2)<<16)|((WORD)*((BYTE*)(ptr)+1)<<8)|*(BYTE*)(ptr)) +#define	ST_WORD(ptr,val)	*(BYTE*)(ptr)=(BYTE)(val); *((BYTE*)(ptr)+1)=(BYTE)((WORD)(val)>>8) +#define	ST_DWORD(ptr,val)	*(BYTE*)(ptr)=(BYTE)(val); *((BYTE*)(ptr)+1)=(BYTE)((WORD)(val)>>8); *((BYTE*)(ptr)+2)=(BYTE)((DWORD)(val)>>16); *((BYTE*)(ptr)+3)=(BYTE)((DWORD)(val)>>24) +#endif + +#ifdef __cplusplus +} +#endif + +#endif /* _FATFS */ diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/ffconf.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/ffconf.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..243a20fa22 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/ffconf.h @@ -0,0 +1,190 @@ +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/  FatFs - FAT file system module configuration file  R0.09a (C)ChaN, 2012 +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ +/ CAUTION! Do not forget to make clean the project after any changes to +/ the configuration options. +/ +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#ifndef _FFCONF +#define _FFCONF 4004	/* Revision ID */ + + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ Function and Buffer Configurations +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#define	_FS_TINY	1		/* 0:Normal or 1:Tiny */ +/* When _FS_TINY is set to 1, FatFs uses the sector buffer in the file system +/  object instead of the sector buffer in the individual file object for file +/  data transfer. This reduces memory consumption 512 bytes each file object. */ + + +#define _FS_READONLY	1	/* 0:Read/Write or 1:Read only */ +/* Setting _FS_READONLY to 1 defines read only configuration. This removes +/  writing functions, f_write, f_sync, f_unlink, f_mkdir, f_chmod, f_rename, +/  f_truncate and useless f_getfree. */ + + +#define _FS_MINIMIZE	2	/* 0 to 3 */ +/* The _FS_MINIMIZE option defines minimization level to remove some functions. +/ +/   0: Full function. +/   1: f_stat, f_getfree, f_unlink, f_mkdir, f_chmod, f_truncate and f_rename +/      are removed. +/   2: f_opendir and f_readdir are removed in addition to 1. +/   3: f_lseek is removed in addition to 2. */ + + +#define	_USE_STRFUNC	0	/* 0:Disable or 1-2:Enable */ +/* To enable string functions, set _USE_STRFUNC to 1 or 2. */ + + +#define	_USE_MKFS	0		/* 0:Disable or 1:Enable */ +/* To enable f_mkfs function, set _USE_MKFS to 1 and set _FS_READONLY to 0 */ + + +#define	_USE_FORWARD	0	/* 0:Disable or 1:Enable */ +/* To enable f_forward function, set _USE_FORWARD to 1 and set _FS_TINY to 1. */ + + +#define	_USE_FASTSEEK	0	/* 0:Disable or 1:Enable */ +/* To enable fast seek feature, set _USE_FASTSEEK to 1. */ + + + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ Locale and Namespace Configurations +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#define _CODE_PAGE	932 +/* The _CODE_PAGE specifies the OEM code page to be used on the target system. +/  Incorrect setting of the code page can cause a file open failure. +/ +/   932  - Japanese Shift-JIS (DBCS, OEM, Windows) +/   936  - Simplified Chinese GBK (DBCS, OEM, Windows) +/   949  - Korean (DBCS, OEM, Windows) +/   950  - Traditional Chinese Big5 (DBCS, OEM, Windows) +/   1250 - Central Europe (Windows) +/   1251 - Cyrillic (Windows) +/   1252 - Latin 1 (Windows) +/   1253 - Greek (Windows) +/   1254 - Turkish (Windows) +/   1255 - Hebrew (Windows) +/   1256 - Arabic (Windows) +/   1257 - Baltic (Windows) +/   1258 - Vietnam (OEM, Windows) +/   437  - U.S. (OEM) +/   720  - Arabic (OEM) +/   737  - Greek (OEM) +/   775  - Baltic (OEM) +/   850  - Multilingual Latin 1 (OEM) +/   858  - Multilingual Latin 1 + Euro (OEM) +/   852  - Latin 2 (OEM) +/   855  - Cyrillic (OEM) +/   866  - Russian (OEM) +/   857  - Turkish (OEM) +/   862  - Hebrew (OEM) +/   874  - Thai (OEM, Windows) +/	1    - ASCII only (Valid for non LFN cfg.) +*/ + + +#define	_USE_LFN	0		/* 0 to 3 */ +#define	_MAX_LFN	255		/* Maximum LFN length to handle (12 to 255) */ +/* The _USE_LFN option switches the LFN support. +/ +/   0: Disable LFN feature. _MAX_LFN and _LFN_UNICODE have no effect. +/   1: Enable LFN with static working buffer on the BSS. Always NOT reentrant. +/   2: Enable LFN with dynamic working buffer on the STACK. +/   3: Enable LFN with dynamic working buffer on the HEAP. +/ +/  The LFN working buffer occupies (_MAX_LFN + 1) * 2 bytes. To enable LFN, +/  Unicode handling functions ff_convert() and ff_wtoupper() must be added +/  to the project. When enable to use heap, memory control functions +/  ff_memalloc() and ff_memfree() must be added to the project. */ + + +#define	_LFN_UNICODE	0	/* 0:ANSI/OEM or 1:Unicode */ +/* To switch the character code set on FatFs API to Unicode, +/  enable LFN feature and set _LFN_UNICODE to 1. */ + + +#define _FS_RPATH		0	/* 0 to 2 */ +/* The _FS_RPATH option configures relative path feature. +/ +/   0: Disable relative path feature and remove related functions. +/   1: Enable relative path. f_chdrive() and f_chdir() are available. +/   2: f_getcwd() is available in addition to 1. +/ +/  Note that output of the f_readdir function is affected by this option. */ + + + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ Physical Drive Configurations +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#define _VOLUMES	1 +/* Number of volumes (logical drives) to be used. */ + + +#define	_MAX_SS		512		/* 512, 1024, 2048 or 4096 */ +/* Maximum sector size to be handled. +/  Always set 512 for memory card and hard disk but a larger value may be +/  required for on-board flash memory, floppy disk and optical disk. +/  When _MAX_SS is larger than 512, it configures FatFs to variable sector size +/  and GET_SECTOR_SIZE command must be implemented to the disk_ioctl function. */ + + +#define	_MULTI_PARTITION	0	/* 0:Single partition, 1/2:Enable multiple partition */ +/* When set to 0, each volume is bound to the same physical drive number and +/ it can mount only first primary partition. When it is set to 1, each volume +/ is tied to the partitions listed in VolToPart[]. */ + + +#define	_USE_ERASE	0	/* 0:Disable or 1:Enable */ +/* To enable sector erase feature, set _USE_ERASE to 1. CTRL_ERASE_SECTOR command +/  should be added to the disk_ioctl function. */ + + + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------/ +/ System Configurations +/----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#define _WORD_ACCESS	1	/* 0 or 1 */ +/* Set 0 first and it is always compatible with all platforms. The _WORD_ACCESS +/  option defines which access method is used to the word data on the FAT volume. +/ +/   0: Byte-by-byte access. +/   1: Word access. Do not choose this unless following condition is met. +/ +/  When the byte order on the memory is big-endian or address miss-aligned word +/  access results incorrect behavior, the _WORD_ACCESS must be set to 0. +/  If it is not the case, the value can also be set to 1 to improve the +/  performance and code size. */ + + +/* A header file that defines sync object types on the O/S, such as +/  windows.h, ucos_ii.h and semphr.h, must be included prior to ff.h. */ + +#define _FS_REENTRANT	0		/* 0:Disable or 1:Enable */ +#define _FS_TIMEOUT		1000	/* Timeout period in unit of time ticks */ +#define	_SYNC_t			HANDLE	/* O/S dependent type of sync object. e.g. HANDLE, OS_EVENT*, ID and etc.. */ + +/* The _FS_REENTRANT option switches the reentrancy (thread safe) of the FatFs module. +/ +/   0: Disable reentrancy. _SYNC_t and _FS_TIMEOUT have no effect. +/   1: Enable reentrancy. Also user provided synchronization handlers, +/      ff_req_grant, ff_rel_grant, ff_del_syncobj and ff_cre_syncobj +/      function must be added to the project. */ + + +#define	_FS_LOCK	0	/* 0:Disable or >=1:Enable */ +/* To enable file lock control feature, set _FS_LOCK to 1 or greater. +   The value defines how many files can be opened simultaneously. */ + + +#endif /* _FFCONFIG */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/integer.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/integer.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5408fe6b3e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/FATFs/integer.h @@ -0,0 +1,38 @@ +/*-------------------------------------------*/ +/* Integer type definitions for FatFs module */ +/*-------------------------------------------*/ + +#ifndef _INTEGER +#define _INTEGER + +#ifdef _WIN32	/* FatFs development platform */ + +#include <windows.h> +#include <tchar.h> + +#else			/* Embedded platform */ + +/* These types must be 16-bit, 32-bit or larger integer */ +typedef int				INT; +typedef unsigned int	UINT; + +/* These types must be 8-bit integer */ +typedef char			CHAR; +typedef unsigned char	UCHAR; +typedef unsigned char	BYTE; + +/* These types must be 16-bit integer */ +typedef short			SHORT; +typedef unsigned short	USHORT; +typedef unsigned short	WORD; +typedef unsigned short	WCHAR; + +/* These types must be 32-bit integer */ +typedef long			LONG; +typedef unsigned long	ULONG; +typedef unsigned long	DWORD; + +#endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/HTTPServerApp.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/HTTPServerApp.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..ba5ce8b995 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/HTTPServerApp.c @@ -0,0 +1,284 @@ +/* +             LUFA Library +     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + +  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +           www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* +  Copyright 2017  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + +  Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this +  software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted +  without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in +  all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this +  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting +  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in +  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the +  software without specific, written prior permission. + +  The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this +  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability +  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any +  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages +  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether +  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, +  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of +  this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + *  Simple HTTP Webserver Application. When connected to the uIP stack, + *  this will serve out files to HTTP clients on port 80. + */ + +#define  INCLUDE_FROM_HTTPSERVERAPP_C +#include "HTTPServerApp.h" + +/** HTTP server response header, for transmission before the page contents. This indicates to the host that a page exists at the + *  given location, and gives extra connection information. + */ +const char PROGMEM HTTP200Header[] = "HTTP/1.1 200 OK\r\n" +                                     "Server: LUFA " LUFA_VERSION_STRING "\r\n" +                                     "Connection: close\r\n" +                                     "MIME-version: 1.0\r\n" +                                     "Content-Type: "; + +/** HTTP server response header, for transmission before a resource not found error. This indicates to the host that the given + *  URL is invalid, and gives extra error information. + */ +const char PROGMEM HTTP404Header[] = "HTTP/1.1 404 Not Found\r\n" +                                     "Server: LUFA " LUFA_VERSION_STRING "\r\n" +                                     "Connection: close\r\n" +                                     "MIME-version: 1.0\r\n" +                                     "Content-Type: text/plain\r\n\r\n" +                                     "Error 404: File Not Found: /"; + +/** Default filename to fetch when a directory is requested */ +const char PROGMEM DefaultDirFileName[] = "index.htm"; + +/** Default MIME type sent if no other MIME type can be determined. */ +const char PROGMEM DefaultMIMEType[] = "text/plain"; + +/** List of MIME types for each supported file extension. */ +const MIME_Type_t MIMETypes[] = +	{ +		{.Extension = "htm", .MIMEType = "text/html"}, +		{.Extension = "jpg", .MIMEType = "image/jpeg"}, +		{.Extension = "gif", .MIMEType = "image/gif"}, +		{.Extension = "bmp", .MIMEType = "image/bmp"}, +		{.Extension = "png", .MIMEType = "image/png"}, +		{.Extension = "ico", .MIMEType = "image/x-icon"}, +		{.Extension = "exe", .MIMEType = "application/octet-stream"}, +		{.Extension = "gz",  .MIMEType = "application/x-gzip"}, +		{.Extension = "zip", .MIMEType = "application/zip"}, +		{.Extension = "pdf", .MIMEType = "application/pdf"}, +	}; + +/** FATFs structure to hold the internal state of the FAT driver for the Dataflash contents. */ +FATFS DiskFATState; + + +/** Initialization function for the simple HTTP webserver. */ +void HTTPServerApp_Init(void) +{ +	/* Listen on port 80 for HTTP connections from hosts */ +	uip_listen(HTONS(HTTP_SERVER_PORT)); + +	/* Mount the Dataflash disk via FatFS */ +	f_mount(0, &DiskFATState); +} + +/** uIP stack application callback for the simple HTTP webserver. This function must be called each time the + *  TCP/IP stack needs a TCP packet to be processed. + */ +void HTTPServerApp_Callback(void) +{ +	uip_tcp_appstate_t* const AppState = &uip_conn->appstate; + +	if (uip_aborted() || uip_timedout() || uip_closed()) +	{ +		/* Lock to the closed state so that no further processing will occur on the connection */ +		AppState->HTTPServer.CurrentState  = WEBSERVER_STATE_Closing; +		AppState->HTTPServer.NextState     = WEBSERVER_STATE_Closing; +	} + +	if (uip_connected()) +	{ +		/* New connection - initialize connection state values */ +		AppState->HTTPServer.CurrentState  = WEBSERVER_STATE_OpenRequestedFile; +		AppState->HTTPServer.NextState     = WEBSERVER_STATE_OpenRequestedFile; +		AppState->HTTPServer.FileOpen      = false; +		AppState->HTTPServer.ACKedFilePos  = 0; +		AppState->HTTPServer.SentChunkSize = 0; +	} + +	if (uip_acked()) +	{ +		/* Add the amount of ACKed file data to the total sent file bytes counter */ +		AppState->HTTPServer.ACKedFilePos += AppState->HTTPServer.SentChunkSize; + +		/* Progress to the next state once the current state's data has been ACKed */ +		AppState->HTTPServer.CurrentState = AppState->HTTPServer.NextState; +	} + +	if (uip_rexmit()) +	{ +		/* Return file pointer to the last ACKed position */ +		f_lseek(&AppState->HTTPServer.FileHandle, AppState->HTTPServer.ACKedFilePos); +	} + +	if (uip_rexmit() || uip_acked() || uip_newdata() || uip_connected() || uip_poll()) +	{ +		switch (AppState->HTTPServer.CurrentState) +		{ +			case WEBSERVER_STATE_OpenRequestedFile: +				HTTPServerApp_OpenRequestedFile(); +				break; +			case WEBSERVER_STATE_SendResponseHeader: +				HTTPServerApp_SendResponseHeader(); +				break; +			case WEBSERVER_STATE_SendData: +				HTTPServerApp_SendData(); +				break; +			case WEBSERVER_STATE_Closing: +				/* Connection is being terminated for some reason - close file handle */ +				f_close(&AppState->HTTPServer.FileHandle); +				AppState->HTTPServer.FileOpen = false; + +				/* If connection is not already closed, close it */ +				uip_close(); + +				AppState->HTTPServer.CurrentState = WEBSERVER_STATE_Closed; +				AppState->HTTPServer.NextState    = WEBSERVER_STATE_Closed; +				break; +		} +	} +} + +/** HTTP Server State handler for the Request Process state. This state manages the processing of incoming HTTP + *  GET requests to the server from the receiving HTTP client. + */ +static void HTTPServerApp_OpenRequestedFile(void) +{ +	uip_tcp_appstate_t* const AppState    = &uip_conn->appstate; +	char*               const AppData     = (char*)uip_appdata; + +	/* No HTTP header received from the client, abort processing */ +	if (!(uip_newdata())) +	  return; + +	char* RequestToken      = strtok(AppData, " "); +	char* RequestedFileName = strtok(NULL, " "); + +	/* Must be a GET request, abort otherwise */ +	if (strcmp_P(RequestToken, PSTR("GET")) != 0) +	{ +		uip_abort(); +		return; +	} + +	/* Copy over the requested filename */ +	strlcpy(AppState->HTTPServer.FileName, &RequestedFileName[1], sizeof(AppState->HTTPServer.FileName)); + +	/* Determine the length of the URI so that it can be checked to see if it is a directory */ +	uint8_t FileNameLen = strlen(AppState->HTTPServer.FileName); + +	/* If the URI is a directory, append the default filename */ +	if ((AppState->HTTPServer.FileName[FileNameLen - 1] == '/') || !(FileNameLen)) +	{ +		strlcpy_P(&AppState->HTTPServer.FileName[FileNameLen], DefaultDirFileName, +		          (sizeof(AppState->HTTPServer.FileName) - FileNameLen)); +	} + +	/* Try to open the file from the Dataflash disk */ +	AppState->HTTPServer.FileOpen     = (f_open(&AppState->HTTPServer.FileHandle, AppState->HTTPServer.FileName, +	                                            (FA_OPEN_EXISTING | FA_READ)) == FR_OK); + +	/* Lock to the SendResponseHeader state until connection terminated */ +	AppState->HTTPServer.CurrentState = WEBSERVER_STATE_SendResponseHeader; +	AppState->HTTPServer.NextState    = WEBSERVER_STATE_SendResponseHeader; +} + +/** HTTP Server State handler for the HTTP Response Header Send state. This state manages the transmission of + *  the HTTP response header to the receiving HTTP client. + */ +static void HTTPServerApp_SendResponseHeader(void) +{ +	uip_tcp_appstate_t* const AppState    = &uip_conn->appstate; +	char*               const AppData     = (char*)uip_appdata; + +	char* Extension     = strpbrk(AppState->HTTPServer.FileName, "."); +	bool  FoundMIMEType = false; + +	/* If the file isn't already open, it wasn't found - send back a 404 error response and abort */ +	if (!(AppState->HTTPServer.FileOpen)) +	{ +		/* Copy over the HTTP 404 response header and send it to the receiving client */ +		strcpy_P(AppData, HTTP404Header); +		strcat(AppData, AppState->HTTPServer.FileName); +		uip_send(AppData, strlen(AppData)); + +		AppState->HTTPServer.NextState = WEBSERVER_STATE_Closing; +		return; +	} + +	/* Copy over the HTTP 200 response header and send it to the receiving client */ +	strcpy_P(AppData, HTTP200Header); + +	/* Check to see if a MIME type for the requested file's extension was found */ +	if (Extension != NULL) +	{ +		/* Look through the MIME type list, copy over the required MIME type if found */ +		for (uint8_t i = 0; i < (sizeof(MIMETypes) / sizeof(MIMETypes[0])); i++) +		{ +			if (strcmp(&Extension[1], MIMETypes[i].Extension) == 0) +			{ +				strcat(AppData, MIMETypes[i].MIMEType); +				FoundMIMEType = true; +				break; +			} +		} +	} + +	/* Check if a MIME type was found and copied to the output buffer */ +	if (!(FoundMIMEType)) +	{ +		/* MIME type not found - copy over the default MIME type */ +		strcat_P(AppData, DefaultMIMEType); +	} + +	/* Add the end-of-line terminator and end-of-headers terminator after the MIME type */ +	strcat_P(AppData, PSTR("\r\n\r\n")); + +	/* Send the MIME header to the receiving client */ +	uip_send(AppData, strlen(AppData)); + +	/* When the MIME header is ACKed, progress to the data send stage */ +	AppState->HTTPServer.NextState = WEBSERVER_STATE_SendData; +} + +/** HTTP Server State handler for the Data Send state. This state manages the transmission of file chunks + *  to the receiving HTTP client. + */ +static void HTTPServerApp_SendData(void) +{ +	uip_tcp_appstate_t* const AppState    = &uip_conn->appstate; +	char*               const AppData     = (char*)uip_appdata; + +	/* Get the maximum segment size for the current packet */ +	uint16_t MaxChunkSize = uip_mss(); + +	/* Read the next chunk of data from the open file */ +	f_read(&AppState->HTTPServer.FileHandle, AppData, MaxChunkSize, &AppState->HTTPServer.SentChunkSize); + +	/* Send the next file chunk to the receiving client */ +	uip_send(AppData, AppState->HTTPServer.SentChunkSize); + +	/* Check if we are at the last chunk of the file, if so next ACK should close the connection */ +	if (MaxChunkSize != AppState->HTTPServer.SentChunkSize) +	  AppState->HTTPServer.NextState = WEBSERVER_STATE_Closing; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/HTTPServerApp.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/HTTPServerApp.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..11c39d87ed --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/HTTPServerApp.h @@ -0,0 +1,84 @@ +/* +             LUFA Library +     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + +  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +           www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* +  Copyright 2017  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + +  Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this +  software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted +  without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in +  all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this +  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting +  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in +  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the +  software without specific, written prior permission. + +  The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this +  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability +  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any +  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages +  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether +  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, +  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of +  this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + *  Header file for HTTPServerApp.c. + */ + +#ifndef _HTTPSERVER_APP_H_ +#define _HTTPSERVER_APP_H_ + +	/* Includes: */ +		#include <avr/pgmspace.h> +		#include <string.h> + +		#include <LUFA/Version.h> + +		#include "Config/AppConfig.h" + +		#include <uip.h> +		#include <ff.h> + +	/* Enums: */ +		/** States for each HTTP connection to the webserver. */ +		enum Webserver_States_t +		{ +			WEBSERVER_STATE_OpenRequestedFile, /**< Currently opening requested file */ +			WEBSERVER_STATE_SendResponseHeader, /**< Currently sending HTTP response headers to the client */ +			WEBSERVER_STATE_SendData, /**< Currently sending HTTP page data to the client */ +			WEBSERVER_STATE_Closing, /**< Ready to close the connection to the client */ +			WEBSERVER_STATE_Closed, /**< Connection closed after all data sent */ +		}; + +	/* Type Defines: */ +		/** Type define for a MIME type handler. */ +		typedef struct +		{ +			char* Extension; /**< File extension (no leading '.' character) */ +			char* MIMEType;  /**< Appropriate MIME type to send when the extension is encountered */ +		} MIME_Type_t; + +	/* Macros: */ +		/** TCP listen port for incoming HTTP traffic. */ +		#define HTTP_SERVER_PORT  80 + +	/* Function Prototypes: */ +		void HTTPServerApp_Init(void); +		void HTTPServerApp_Callback(void); + +		#if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_HTTPSERVERAPP_C) +			static void HTTPServerApp_OpenRequestedFile(void); +			static void HTTPServerApp_SendResponseHeader(void); +			static void HTTPServerApp_SendData(void); +		#endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/SCSI.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/SCSI.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4fbbfd60e8 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/SCSI.c @@ -0,0 +1,344 @@ +/* +             LUFA Library +     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + +  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +           www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* +  Copyright 2017  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + +  Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this +  software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted +  without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in +  all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this +  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting +  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in +  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the +  software without specific, written prior permission. + +  The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this +  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability +  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any +  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages +  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether +  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, +  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of +  this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + *  SCSI command processing routines, for SCSI commands issued by the host. Mass Storage + *  devices use a thin "Bulk-Only Transport" protocol for issuing commands and status information, + *  which wrap around standard SCSI device commands for controlling the actual storage medium. + */ + +#define  INCLUDE_FROM_SCSI_C +#include "SCSI.h" + +/** Structure to hold the SCSI response data to a SCSI INQUIRY command. This gives information about the device's + *  features and capabilities. + */ +static const SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t InquiryData = +	{ +		.DeviceType          = DEVICE_TYPE_BLOCK, +		.PeripheralQualifier = 0, + +		.Removable           = true, + +		.Version             = 0, + +		.ResponseDataFormat  = 2, +		.NormACA             = false, +		.TrmTsk              = false, +		.AERC                = false, + +		.AdditionalLength    = 0x1F, + +		.SoftReset           = false, +		.CmdQue              = false, +		.Linked              = false, +		.Sync                = false, +		.WideBus16Bit        = false, +		.WideBus32Bit        = false, +		.RelAddr             = false, + +		.VendorID            = "LUFA", +		.ProductID           = "Dataflash Disk", +		.RevisionID          = {'0','.','0','0'}, +	}; + +/** Structure to hold the sense data for the last issued SCSI command, which is returned to the host after a SCSI REQUEST SENSE + *  command is issued. This gives information on exactly why the last command failed to complete. + */ +static SCSI_Request_Sense_Response_t SenseData = +	{ +		.ResponseCode        = 0x70, +		.AdditionalLength    = 0x0A, +	}; + + +/** Main routine to process the SCSI command located in the Command Block Wrapper read from the host. This dispatches + *  to the appropriate SCSI command handling routine if the issued command is supported by the device, else it returns + *  a command failure due to a ILLEGAL REQUEST. + * + *  \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo  Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + *  \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise + */ +bool SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ +	bool CommandSuccess = false; + +	/* Run the appropriate SCSI command hander function based on the passed command */ +	switch (MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[0]) +	{ +		case SCSI_CMD_INQUIRY: +			CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Inquiry(MSInterfaceInfo); +			break; +		case SCSI_CMD_REQUEST_SENSE: +			CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(MSInterfaceInfo); +			break; +		case SCSI_CMD_READ_CAPACITY_10: +			CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(MSInterfaceInfo); +			break; +		case SCSI_CMD_SEND_DIAGNOSTIC: +			CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(MSInterfaceInfo); +			break; +		case SCSI_CMD_WRITE_10: +			CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(MSInterfaceInfo, DATA_WRITE); +			break; +		case SCSI_CMD_READ_10: +			CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(MSInterfaceInfo, DATA_READ); +			break; +		case SCSI_CMD_MODE_SENSE_6: +			CommandSuccess = SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(MSInterfaceInfo); +			break; +		case SCSI_CMD_START_STOP_UNIT: +		case SCSI_CMD_TEST_UNIT_READY: +		case SCSI_CMD_PREVENT_ALLOW_MEDIUM_REMOVAL: +		case SCSI_CMD_VERIFY_10: +			/* These commands should just succeed, no handling required */ +			CommandSuccess = true; +			MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength = 0; +			break; +		default: +			/* Update the SENSE key to reflect the invalid command */ +			SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, +		                   SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_COMMAND, +		                   SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); +			break; +	} + +	/* Check if command was successfully processed */ +	if (CommandSuccess) +	{ +		SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_GOOD, +		               SCSI_ASENSE_NO_ADDITIONAL_INFORMATION, +		               SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + +		return true; +	} + +	return false; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI INQUIRY command. This command returns information about the device's features + *  and capabilities to the host. + * + *  \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo  Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + *  \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Inquiry(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ +	uint16_t AllocationLength  = SwapEndian_16(*(uint16_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[3]); +	uint16_t BytesTransferred  = MIN(AllocationLength, sizeof(InquiryData)); + +	/* Only the standard INQUIRY data is supported, check if any optional INQUIRY bits set */ +	if ((MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[1] & ((1 << 0) | (1 << 1))) || +	     MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[2]) +	{ +		/* Optional but unsupported bits set - update the SENSE key and fail the request */ +		SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, +		               SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_FIELD_IN_CDB, +		               SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + +		return false; +	} + +	Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&InquiryData, BytesTransferred, NULL); + +	/* Pad out remaining bytes with 0x00 */ +	Endpoint_Null_Stream((AllocationLength - BytesTransferred), NULL); + +	/* Finalize the stream transfer to send the last packet */ +	Endpoint_ClearIN(); + +	/* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ +	MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= BytesTransferred; + +	return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI REQUEST SENSE command. This command returns information about the last issued command, + *  including the error code and additional error information so that the host can determine why a command failed to complete. + * + *  \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo  Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + *  \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ +	uint8_t  AllocationLength = MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[4]; +	uint8_t  BytesTransferred = MIN(AllocationLength, sizeof(SenseData)); + +	Endpoint_Write_Stream_LE(&SenseData, BytesTransferred, NULL); +	Endpoint_Null_Stream((AllocationLength - BytesTransferred), NULL); +	Endpoint_ClearIN(); + +	/* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ +	MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= BytesTransferred; + +	return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI READ CAPACITY (10) command. This command returns information about the device's capacity + *  on the selected Logical Unit (drive), as a number of OS-sized blocks. + * + *  \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo  Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + *  \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ +	uint32_t LastBlockAddressInLUN = (VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCKS - 1); +	uint32_t MediaBlockSize        = VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE; + +	Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(&LastBlockAddressInLUN, sizeof(LastBlockAddressInLUN), NULL); +	Endpoint_Write_Stream_BE(&MediaBlockSize, sizeof(MediaBlockSize), NULL); +	Endpoint_ClearIN(); + +	/* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ +	MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= 8; + +	return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI SEND DIAGNOSTIC command. This command performs a quick check of the Dataflash ICs on the + *  board, and indicates if they are present and functioning correctly. Only the Self-Test portion of the diagnostic command is + *  supported. + * + *  \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo  Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + *  \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ +	/* Check to see if the SELF TEST bit is not set */ +	if (!(MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[1] & (1 << 2))) +	{ +		/* Only self-test supported - update SENSE key and fail the command */ +		SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, +		               SCSI_ASENSE_INVALID_FIELD_IN_CDB, +		               SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + +		return false; +	} + +	/* Check to see if all attached Dataflash ICs are functional */ +	if (!(DataflashManager_CheckDataflashOperation())) +	{ +		/* Update SENSE key with a hardware error condition and return command fail */ +		SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_HARDWARE_ERROR, +		               SCSI_ASENSE_NO_ADDITIONAL_INFORMATION, +		               SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + +		return false; +	} + +	/* Succeed the command and update the bytes transferred counter */ +	MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength = 0; + +	return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI READ (10) or WRITE (10) command. This command reads in the block start address + *  and total number of blocks to process, then calls the appropriate low-level Dataflash routine to handle the actual + *  reading and writing of the data. + * + *  \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo  Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + *  \param[in] IsDataRead  Indicates if the command is a READ (10) command or WRITE (10) command (DATA_READ or DATA_WRITE) + * + *  \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, +                                      const bool IsDataRead) +{ +	uint32_t BlockAddress; +	uint16_t TotalBlocks; + +	/* Check if the disk is write protected or not */ +	if ((IsDataRead == DATA_WRITE) && DISK_READ_ONLY) +	{ +		/* Block address is invalid, update SENSE key and return command fail */ +		SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_DATA_PROTECT, +		               SCSI_ASENSE_WRITE_PROTECTED, +		               SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + +		return false; +	} + +	/* Load in the 32-bit block address (SCSI uses big-endian, so have to reverse the byte order) */ +	BlockAddress = SwapEndian_32(*(uint32_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[2]); + +	/* Load in the 16-bit total blocks (SCSI uses big-endian, so have to reverse the byte order) */ +	TotalBlocks  = SwapEndian_16(*(uint16_t*)&MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.SCSICommandData[7]); + +	/* Check if the block address is outside the maximum allowable value for the LUN */ +	if (BlockAddress >= VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCKS) +	{ +		/* Block address is invalid, update SENSE key and return command fail */ +		SCSI_SET_SENSE(SCSI_SENSE_KEY_ILLEGAL_REQUEST, +		               SCSI_ASENSE_LOGICAL_BLOCK_ADDRESS_OUT_OF_RANGE, +		               SCSI_ASENSEQ_NO_QUALIFIER); + +		return false; +	} + +	/* Determine if the packet is a READ (10) or WRITE (10) command, call appropriate function */ +	if (IsDataRead == DATA_READ) +	  DataflashManager_ReadBlocks(MSInterfaceInfo, BlockAddress, TotalBlocks); +	else +	  DataflashManager_WriteBlocks(MSInterfaceInfo, BlockAddress, TotalBlocks); + +	/* Update the bytes transferred counter and succeed the command */ +	MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= ((uint32_t)TotalBlocks * VIRTUAL_MEMORY_BLOCK_SIZE); + +	return true; +} + +/** Command processing for an issued SCSI MODE SENSE (6) command. This command returns various informational pages about + *  the SCSI device, as well as the device's Write Protect status. + * + *  \param[in] MSInterfaceInfo  Pointer to the Mass Storage class interface structure that the command is associated with + * + *  \return Boolean \c true if the command completed successfully, \c false otherwise. + */ +static bool SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo) +{ +	/* Send an empty header response with the Write Protect flag status */ +	Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); +	Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); +	Endpoint_Write_8(DISK_READ_ONLY ? 0x80 : 0x00); +	Endpoint_Write_8(0x00); +	Endpoint_ClearIN(); + +	/* Update the bytes transferred counter and succeed the command */ +	MSInterfaceInfo->State.CommandBlock.DataTransferLength -= 4; + +	return true; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/SCSI.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/SCSI.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..8f41f63b43 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/SCSI.h @@ -0,0 +1,87 @@ +/* +             LUFA Library +     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + +  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +           www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* +  Copyright 2017  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + +  Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this +  software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted +  without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in +  all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this +  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting +  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in +  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the +  software without specific, written prior permission. + +  The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this +  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability +  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any +  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages +  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether +  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, +  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of +  this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + *  Header file for SCSI.c. + */ + +#ifndef _SCSI_H_ +#define _SCSI_H_ + +	/* Includes: */ +		#include <avr/io.h> +		#include <avr/pgmspace.h> + +		#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + +		#include "../Descriptors.h" +		#include "DataflashManager.h" + +	/* Macros: */ +		/** Macro to set the current SCSI sense data to the given key, additional sense code and additional sense qualifier. This +		 *  is for convenience, as it allows for all three sense values (returned upon request to the host to give information about +		 *  the last command failure) in a quick and easy manner. +		 * +		 *  \param[in] Key    New SCSI sense key to set the sense code to +		 *  \param[in] Acode  New SCSI additional sense key to set the additional sense code to +		 *  \param[in] Aqual  New SCSI additional sense key qualifier to set the additional sense qualifier code to +		 */ +		#define SCSI_SET_SENSE(Key, Acode, Aqual)  do { SenseData.SenseKey                 = (Key);   \ +		                                                SenseData.AdditionalSenseCode      = (Acode); \ +		                                                SenseData.AdditionalSenseQualifier = (Aqual); } while (0) + +		/** Macro for the \ref SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10() function, to indicate that data is to be read from the storage medium. */ +		#define DATA_READ           true + +		/** Macro for the \ref SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10() function, to indicate that data is to be written to the storage medium. */ +		#define DATA_WRITE          false + +		/** Value for the DeviceType entry in the SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t enum, indicating a Block Media device. */ +		#define DEVICE_TYPE_BLOCK   0x00 + +		/** Value for the DeviceType entry in the SCSI_Inquiry_Response_t enum, indicating a CD-ROM device. */ +		#define DEVICE_TYPE_CDROM   0x05 + +	/* Function Prototypes: */ +		bool SCSI_DecodeSCSICommand(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); + +		#if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_SCSI_C) +			static bool SCSI_Command_Inquiry(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); +			static bool SCSI_Command_Request_Sense(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); +			static bool SCSI_Command_Read_Capacity_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); +			static bool SCSI_Command_Send_Diagnostic(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); +			static bool SCSI_Command_ReadWrite_10(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo, +			                                      const bool IsDataRead); +			static bool SCSI_Command_ModeSense_6(USB_ClassInfo_MS_Device_t* const MSInterfaceInfo); +		#endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/TELNETServerApp.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/TELNETServerApp.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4500a4b781 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/TELNETServerApp.c @@ -0,0 +1,163 @@ +/* +             LUFA Library +     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + +  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +           www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* +  Copyright 2017  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + +  Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this +  software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted +  without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in +  all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this +  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting +  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in +  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the +  software without specific, written prior permission. + +  The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this +  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability +  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any +  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages +  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether +  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, +  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of +  this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + *  TELNET Webserver Application. When connected to the uIP stack, + *  this will serve out raw TELNET to the client on port 23. + */ + +#define  INCLUDE_FROM_TELNETSERVERAPP_C +#include "TELNETServerApp.h" + +#if defined(ENABLE_TELNET_SERVER) || defined(__DOXYGEN__) + +/** Welcome message to send to a TELNET client when a connection is first made. */ +const char PROGMEM WelcomeHeader[] = "********************************************\r\n" +                                     "*       LUFA uIP Webserver (TELNET)        *\r\n" +                                     "********************************************\r\n"; + +/** Main TELNET menu, giving the user the list of available commands they may issue */ +const char PROGMEM TELNETMenu[] = "\r\n" +                                  "  == Available Commands: ==\r\n" +                                  "     c) List Active TCP Connections\r\n" +                                  "  =========================\r\n" +                                  "\r\n>"; + +/** Header to print before the current connections are printed to the client */ +const char PROGMEM CurrentConnectionsHeader[] = "\r\n* Current TCP Connections: *\r\n"; + +/** Initialization function for the simple TELNET webserver. */ +void TELNETServerApp_Init(void) +{ +	/* Listen on port 23 for TELNET connections from hosts */ +	uip_listen(HTONS(TELNET_SERVER_PORT)); +} + +/** uIP stack application callback for the TELNET server. This function must be called each time the + *  TCP/IP stack needs a TCP packet to be processed. + */ +void TELNETServerApp_Callback(void) +{ +	uip_tcp_appstate_t* const AppState   = &uip_conn->appstate; +	char*               const AppData    = (char*)uip_appdata; + +	if (uip_connected()) +	{ +		/* New connection - initialize connection state values */ +		AppState->TELNETServer.CurrentState = TELNET_STATE_SendHeader; +	} + +	if (uip_acked()) +	{ +		/* Progress to the next state once the current state's data has been ACKed */ +		AppState->TELNETServer.CurrentState = AppState->TELNETServer.NextState; +	} + +	if (uip_rexmit() || uip_acked() || uip_newdata() || uip_connected() || uip_poll()) +	{ +		switch (AppState->TELNETServer.CurrentState) +		{ +			case TELNET_STATE_SendHeader: +				/* Copy over and send the TELNET welcome message upon first connection */ +				strcpy_P(AppData, WelcomeHeader); +				uip_send(AppData, strlen(AppData)); + +				AppState->TELNETServer.NextState = TELNET_STATE_SendMenu; +				break; +			case TELNET_STATE_SendMenu: +				/* Copy over and send the TELNET menu to the client */ +				strcpy_P(AppData, TELNETMenu); +				uip_send(AppData, strlen(AppData)); + +				AppState->TELNETServer.NextState = TELNET_STATE_GetCommand; +				break; +			case TELNET_STATE_GetCommand: +				if (!(uip_datalen())) +				  break; + +				/* Save the issued command for later processing */ +				AppState->TELNETServer.IssuedCommand = AppData[0]; + +				AppState->TELNETServer.CurrentState  = TELNET_STATE_SendResponse; +				break; +			case TELNET_STATE_SendResponse: +				/* Determine which command was issued, perform command processing */ +				switch (AppState->TELNETServer.IssuedCommand) +				{ +					case 'c': +						TELNETServerApp_DisplayTCPConnections(); +						break; +					default: +						strcpy_P(AppData, PSTR("Invalid Command.\r\n")); +						uip_send(AppData, strlen(AppData)); +						break; +				} + +				AppState->TELNETServer.NextState = TELNET_STATE_SendMenu; +				break; +		} +	} +} + +/** Sends a list of active TCP connections to the TELNET client. */ +static void TELNETServerApp_DisplayTCPConnections(void) +{ +	char* const AppData    = (char*)uip_appdata; + +	strcpy_P(AppData, CurrentConnectionsHeader); + +	uint16_t ResponseLen     = strlen(AppData); +	uint8_t  ActiveConnCount = 0; + +	/* Loop through the complete uIP TCP connections list, looking for active connections */ +	for (uint8_t i = 0; i < UIP_CONNS; i++) +	{ +		struct uip_conn* CurrConnection = &uip_conns[i]; + +		/* If the connection is not closed, it is active and must be added to the out buffer */ +		if (CurrConnection->tcpstateflags != UIP_CLOSED) +		{ +			/* Add the current connection's details to the out buffer */ +			ResponseLen += sprintf_P(&AppData[ResponseLen], PSTR("%u) %d.%d.%d.%d (Local Port %u <=> Remote Port %u)\r\n"), +			                         ++ActiveConnCount, +			                         CurrConnection->ripaddr.u8[0], +			                         CurrConnection->ripaddr.u8[1], +			                         CurrConnection->ripaddr.u8[2], +			                         CurrConnection->ripaddr.u8[3], +			                         HTONS(CurrConnection->lport), HTONS(CurrConnection->rport)); +		} +	} + +	uip_send(AppData, ResponseLen); +} + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/TELNETServerApp.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/TELNETServerApp.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..67301ba09c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/TELNETServerApp.h @@ -0,0 +1,71 @@ +/* +             LUFA Library +     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + +  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +           www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* +  Copyright 2017  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + +  Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this +  software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted +  without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in +  all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this +  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting +  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in +  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the +  software without specific, written prior permission. + +  The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this +  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability +  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any +  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages +  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether +  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, +  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of +  this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + *  Header file for TELNETServerApp.c. + */ + +#ifndef _TELNETSERVER_APP_H_ +#define _TELNETSERVER_APP_H_ + +	/* Includes: */ +		#include <avr/pgmspace.h> +		#include <string.h> +		#include <stdio.h> + +		#include <uip.h> + +		#include "Config/AppConfig.h" + +	/* Macros: */ +		/** TCP listen port for incoming TELNET traffic. */ +		#define TELNET_SERVER_PORT  23 + +	/* Enums: */ +		/** States for each TELNET connection to the server. */ +		enum TELNET_States_t +		{ +			TELNET_STATE_SendHeader, /**< Currently sending welcome header to the client */ +			TELNET_STATE_SendMenu, /**< Currently sending the command list menu to the client */ +			TELNET_STATE_GetCommand, /**< Currently waiting for a command from the client */ +			TELNET_STATE_SendResponse, /**< Processing the issued command and sending a response */ +		}; + +	/* Function Prototypes: */ +		void TELNETServerApp_Init(void); +		void TELNETServerApp_Callback(void); + +		#if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_TELNETSERVERAPP_C) +			static void TELNETServerApp_DisplayTCPConnections(void); +		#endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uIPManagement.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uIPManagement.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..12f6c8f9e7 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uIPManagement.c @@ -0,0 +1,298 @@ +/* +             LUFA Library +     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + +  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +           www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* +  Copyright 2017  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + +  Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this +  software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted +  without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in +  all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this +  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting +  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in +  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the +  software without specific, written prior permission. + +  The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this +  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability +  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any +  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages +  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether +  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, +  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of +  this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + *  uIP Management functions. This file contains the functions and globals needed to maintain the uIP + *  stack once an RNDIS device has been attached to the system. + */ + +#define  INCLUDE_FROM_UIPMANAGEMENT_C +#include "uIPManagement.h" + +/** Connection timer, to retain the time elapsed since the last time the uIP connections were managed. */ +static struct timer ConnectionTimer; + +/** ARP timer, to retain the time elapsed since the ARP cache was last updated. */ +static struct timer ARPTimer; + +/** MAC address of the RNDIS device, when enumerated. */ +struct uip_eth_addr MACAddress; + + +/** Configures the uIP stack ready for network traffic processing. */ +void uIPManagement_Init(void) +{ +	/* uIP Timing Initialization */ +	clock_init(); +	timer_set(&ConnectionTimer, CLOCK_SECOND / 2); +	timer_set(&ARPTimer, CLOCK_SECOND * 10); + +	/* uIP Stack Initialization */ +	uip_init(); +	uip_arp_init(); + +	/* DHCP/Server IP Settings Initialization */ +	if (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Device) +	{ +		MACAddress.addr[0] = SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS[0]; +		MACAddress.addr[1] = SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS[1]; +		MACAddress.addr[2] = SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS[2]; +		MACAddress.addr[3] = SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS[3]; +		MACAddress.addr[4] = SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS[4]; +		MACAddress.addr[5] = SERVER_MAC_ADDRESS[5]; + +		#if defined(ENABLE_DHCP_SERVER) +		DHCPServerApp_Init(); +		#endif + +		uip_ipaddr_t IPAddress, Netmask, GatewayIPAddress; +		uip_ipaddr(&IPAddress,        DEVICE_IP_ADDRESS[0], DEVICE_IP_ADDRESS[1], DEVICE_IP_ADDRESS[2], DEVICE_IP_ADDRESS[3]); +		uip_ipaddr(&Netmask,          DEVICE_NETMASK[0],    DEVICE_NETMASK[1],    DEVICE_NETMASK[2],    DEVICE_NETMASK[3]); +		uip_ipaddr(&GatewayIPAddress, DEVICE_GATEWAY[0],    DEVICE_GATEWAY[1],    DEVICE_GATEWAY[2],    DEVICE_GATEWAY[3]); +		uip_sethostaddr(&IPAddress); +		uip_setnetmask(&Netmask); +		uip_setdraddr(&GatewayIPAddress); +	} +	else +	{ +		#if defined(ENABLE_DHCP_CLIENT) +		DHCPClientApp_Init(); +		#else +		uip_ipaddr_t IPAddress, Netmask, GatewayIPAddress; +		uip_ipaddr(&IPAddress,        DEVICE_IP_ADDRESS[0], DEVICE_IP_ADDRESS[1], DEVICE_IP_ADDRESS[2], DEVICE_IP_ADDRESS[3]); +		uip_ipaddr(&Netmask,          DEVICE_NETMASK[0],    DEVICE_NETMASK[1],    DEVICE_NETMASK[2],    DEVICE_NETMASK[3]); +		uip_ipaddr(&GatewayIPAddress, DEVICE_GATEWAY[0],    DEVICE_GATEWAY[1],    DEVICE_GATEWAY[2],    DEVICE_GATEWAY[3]); +		uip_sethostaddr(&IPAddress); +		uip_setnetmask(&Netmask); +		uip_setdraddr(&GatewayIPAddress); +		#endif +	} + +	/* Virtual Webserver Ethernet Address Configuration */ +	uip_setethaddr(MACAddress); + +	/* HTTP Webserver Initialization */ +	HTTPServerApp_Init(); + +	/* TELNET Server Initialization */ +	#if defined(ENABLE_TELNET_SERVER) +	TELNETServerApp_Init(); +	#endif +} + +/** uIP Management function. This function manages the uIP stack when called while an RNDIS device has been + *  attached to the system. + */ +void uIPManagement_ManageNetwork(void) +{ +	if (((USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Host)   && (USB_HostState   == HOST_STATE_Configured)) || +	    ((USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Device) && (USB_DeviceState == DEVICE_STATE_Configured))) +	{ +		uIPManagement_ProcessIncomingPacket(); +		uIPManagement_ManageConnections(); +	} +} + +/** uIP TCP/IP network stack callback function for the processing of a given TCP connection. This routine dispatches + *  to the appropriate TCP protocol application based on the connection's listen port number. + */ +void uIPManagement_TCPCallback(void) +{ +	/* Call the correct TCP application based on the port number the connection is listening on */ +	switch (uip_conn->lport) +	{ +		case HTONS(HTTP_SERVER_PORT): +			HTTPServerApp_Callback(); +			break; +		#if defined(ENABLE_TELNET_SERVER) +		case HTONS(TELNET_SERVER_PORT): +			TELNETServerApp_Callback(); +			break; +		#endif +	} +} + +/** uIP TCP/IP network stack callback function for the processing of a given UDP connection. This routine dispatches + *  to the appropriate UDP protocol application based on the connection's listen port number. + */ +void uIPManagement_UDPCallback(void) +{ +	/* Call the correct UDP application based on the port number the connection is listening on */ +	switch (uip_udp_conn->lport) +	{ +		#if defined(ENABLE_DHCP_CLIENT) +		case HTONS(DHCP_CLIENT_PORT): +			DHCPClientApp_Callback(); +			break; +		#endif +		#if defined(ENABLE_DHCP_SERVER) +		case HTONS(DHCP_SERVER_PORT): +			DHCPServerApp_Callback(); +			break; +		#endif +	} +} + +/** Processes Incoming packets to the server from the connected RNDIS device, creating responses as needed. */ +static void uIPManagement_ProcessIncomingPacket(void) +{ +	/* Determine which USB mode the system is currently initialized in */ +	if (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Device) +	{ +		/* If no packet received, exit processing routine */ +		if (!(RNDIS_Device_IsPacketReceived(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Device))) +		  return; + +		LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + +		/* Read the Incoming packet straight into the UIP packet buffer */ +		RNDIS_Device_ReadPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Device, uip_buf, &uip_len); +	} +	else +	{ +		/* If no packet received, exit processing routine */ +		if (!(RNDIS_Host_IsPacketReceived(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Host))) +		  return; + +		LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + +		/* Read the Incoming packet straight into the UIP packet buffer */ +		RNDIS_Host_ReadPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Host, uip_buf, &uip_len); +	} + +	/* If the packet contains an Ethernet frame, process it */ +	if (uip_len > 0) +	{ +		switch (((struct uip_eth_hdr*)uip_buf)->type) +		{ +			case HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_IP): +				/* Filter packet by MAC destination */ +				uip_arp_ipin(); + +				/* Process Incoming packet */ +				uip_input(); + +				/* If a response was generated, send it */ +				if (uip_len > 0) +				{ +					/* Add destination MAC to outgoing packet */ +					uip_arp_out(); + +					uip_split_output(); +				} + +				break; +			case HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_ARP): +				/* Process ARP packet */ +				uip_arp_arpin(); + +				/* If a response was generated, send it */ +				if (uip_len > 0) +				  uip_split_output(); + +				break; +		} +	} + +	LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +} + +/** Manages the currently open network connections, including TCP and (if enabled) UDP. */ +static void uIPManagement_ManageConnections(void) +{ +	/* Poll TCP connections for more data to send back to the host */ +	for (uint8_t i = 0; i < UIP_CONNS; i++) +	{ +		uip_poll_conn(&uip_conns[i]); + +		/* If a response was generated, send it */ +		if (uip_len > 0) +		{ +			/* Add destination MAC to outgoing packet */ +			uip_arp_out(); + +			/* Split and send the outgoing packet */ +			uip_split_output(); +		} +	} + +	/* Manage open connections for timeouts */ +	if (timer_expired(&ConnectionTimer)) +	{ +		timer_reset(&ConnectionTimer); + +		LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_BUSY); + +		for (uint8_t i = 0; i < UIP_CONNS; i++) +		{ +			/* Run periodic connection management for each TCP connection */ +			uip_periodic(i); + +			/* If a response was generated, send it */ +			if (uip_len > 0) +			{ +				/* Add destination MAC to outgoing packet */ +				uip_arp_out(); + +				/* Split and send the outgoing packet */ +				uip_split_output(); +			} +		} + +		#if defined(ENABLE_DHCP_CLIENT) +		for (uint8_t i = 0; i < UIP_UDP_CONNS; i++) +		{ +			/* Run periodic connection management for each UDP connection */ +			uip_udp_periodic(i); + +			/* If a response was generated, send it */ +			if (uip_len > 0) +			{ +				/* Add destination MAC to outgoing packet */ +				uip_arp_out(); + +				/* Split and send the outgoing packet */ +				uip_split_output(); +			} +		} +		#endif + +		LEDs_SetAllLEDs(LEDMASK_USB_READY); +	} + +	/* Manage ARP cache refreshing */ +	if (timer_expired(&ARPTimer)) +	{ +		timer_reset(&ARPTimer); +		uip_arp_timer(); +	} +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uIPManagement.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uIPManagement.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..3bdc5c96b1 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uIPManagement.h @@ -0,0 +1,69 @@ +/* +             LUFA Library +     Copyright (C) Dean Camera, 2017. + +  dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com +           www.lufa-lib.org +*/ + +/* +  Copyright 2017  Dean Camera (dean [at] fourwalledcubicle [dot] com) + +  Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and sell this +  software and its documentation for any purpose is hereby granted +  without fee, provided that the above copyright notice appear in +  all copies and that both that the copyright notice and this +  permission notice and warranty disclaimer appear in supporting +  documentation, and that the name of the author not be used in +  advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the +  software without specific, written prior permission. + +  The author disclaims all warranties with regard to this +  software, including all implied warranties of merchantability +  and fitness.  In no event shall the author be liable for any +  special, indirect or consequential damages or any damages +  whatsoever resulting from loss of use, data or profits, whether +  in an action of contract, negligence or other tortious action, +  arising out of or in connection with the use or performance of +  this software. +*/ + +/** \file + * + *  Header file for uIPManagement.c. + */ + +#ifndef _UIP_MANAGEMENT_H_ +#define _UIP_MANAGEMENT_H_ + +	/* Includes: */ +		#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + +		#include <uip.h> +		#include <uip_arp.h> +		#include <uip-split.h> +		#include <timer.h> + +		#include "Config/AppConfig.h" + +		#include "DHCPClientApp.h" +		#include "DHCPServerApp.h" +		#include "HTTPServerApp.h" +		#include "TELNETServerApp.h" + +	/* External Variables: */ +		extern struct uip_eth_addr MACAddress; + +	/* Function Prototypes: */ +		void uIPManagement_Init(void); +		void uIPManagement_ManageNetwork(void); +		void uIPManagement_TCPCallback(void); +		void uIPManagement_UDPCallback(void); + +		#if defined(INCLUDE_FROM_UIPMANAGEMENT_C) +			static void uIPManagement_ProcessIncomingPacket(void); +			static void uIPManagement_ManageConnections(void); +		#endif + +#endif + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/clock.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/clock.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..e71f7209d2 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/clock.c @@ -0,0 +1,37 @@ +#include <stdint.h> +#include <stdlib.h> +#include <stdio.h> + +#include <LUFA/Common/Common.h> + +#include "clock.h" + +//Counted time +volatile clock_time_t clock_datetime = 0; + +//Overflow interrupt +ISR(TIMER1_COMPA_vect, ISR_BLOCK) +{ +	clock_datetime += 1; +} + +//Initialise the clock +void clock_init() +{ +	OCR1A  = (((F_CPU / 1024) / 100) - 1); +	TCCR1B = ((1 << WGM12) | (1 << CS12) | (1 << CS10)); +	TIMSK1 = (1 << OCIE1A); +} + +//Return time +clock_time_t clock_time() +{ +	clock_time_t time; + +	GlobalInterruptDisable(); +	time = clock_datetime; +	GlobalInterruptEnable(); + +	return time; +} + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/clock.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/clock.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..bbfa4ac0e3 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/clock.h @@ -0,0 +1,13 @@ +#ifndef __CLOCK_ARCH_H__ +#define __CLOCK_ARCH_H__ + +#include <stdint.h> +#include <util/atomic.h> + +typedef uint16_t clock_time_t; +#define CLOCK_SECOND 100 +void clock_init(void); +clock_time_t clock_time(void); + +#endif /* __CLOCK_ARCH_H__ */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/timer.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/timer.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..eae06f43bd --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/timer.c @@ -0,0 +1,128 @@ +/** + * \addtogroup timer + * @{ + */ + +/** + * \file + * Timer library implementation. + * \author + * Adam Dunkels <adam@sics.se> + */ + +/* + * Copyright (c) 2004, Swedish Institute of Computer Science. + * All rights reserved. + * + * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without + * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions + * are met: + * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright + *    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + *    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + *    documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + * 3. Neither the name of the Institute nor the names of its contributors + *    may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software + *    without specific prior written permission. + * + * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE INSTITUTE AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND + * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE + * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE + * ARE DISCLAIMED.  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE INSTITUTE OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE + * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL + * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS + * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) + * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT + * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY + * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF + * SUCH DAMAGE. + * + * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack + * + * Author: Adam Dunkels <adam@sics.se> + * + * $Id: timer.c,v 1.2 2006/06/12 08:00:30 adam Exp $ + */ + +#include "clock.h" +#include "timer.h" + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * Set a timer. + * + * This function is used to set a timer for a time sometime in the + * future. The function timer_expired() will evaluate to true after + * the timer has expired. + * + * \param t A pointer to the timer + * \param interval The interval before the timer expires. + * + */ +void +timer_set(struct timer *t, clock_time_t interval) +{ +  t->interval = interval; +  t->start = clock_time(); +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * Reset the timer with the same interval. + * + * This function resets the timer with the same interval that was + * given to the timer_set() function. The start point of the interval + * is the exact time that the timer last expired. Therefore, this + * function will cause the timer to be stable over time, unlike the + * timer_restart() function. + * + * \param t A pointer to the timer. + * + * \sa timer_restart() + */ +void +timer_reset(struct timer *t) +{ +  t->start += t->interval; +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * Restart the timer from the current point in time + * + * This function restarts a timer with the same interval that was + * given to the timer_set() function. The timer will start at the + * current time. + * + * \note A periodic timer will drift if this function is used to reset + * it. For periodic timers, use the timer_reset() function instead. + * + * \param t A pointer to the timer. + * + * \sa timer_reset() + */ +void +timer_restart(struct timer *t) +{ +  t->start = clock_time(); +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * Check if a timer has expired. + * + * This function tests if a timer has expired and returns true or + * false depending on its status. + * + * \param t A pointer to the timer + * + * \return Non-zero if the timer has expired, zero otherwise. + * + */ +int +timer_expired(struct timer *t) +{ +  return (clock_time_t)(clock_time() - t->start) >= (clock_time_t)t->interval; +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/timer.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/timer.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..04917e4c52 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/timer.h @@ -0,0 +1,87 @@ +/** + * \defgroup timer Timer library + * + * The timer library provides functions for setting, resetting and + * restarting timers, and for checking if a timer has expired. An + * application must "manually" check if its timers have expired; this + * is not done automatically. + * + * A timer is declared as a \c struct \c timer and all access to the + * timer is made by a pointer to the declared timer. + * + * \note The timer library uses the \ref clock "Clock library" to + * measure time. Intervals should be specified in the format used by + * the clock library. + * + * @{ + */ + + +/** + * \file + * Timer library header file. + * \author + * Adam Dunkels <adam@sics.se> + */ + +/* + * Copyright (c) 2004, Swedish Institute of Computer Science. + * All rights reserved. + * + * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without + * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions + * are met: + * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright + *    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + *    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + *    documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + * 3. Neither the name of the Institute nor the names of its contributors + *    may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software + *    without specific prior written permission. + * + * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE INSTITUTE AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND + * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE + * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE + * ARE DISCLAIMED.  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE INSTITUTE OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE + * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL + * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS + * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) + * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT + * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY + * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF + * SUCH DAMAGE. + * + * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack + * + * Author: Adam Dunkels <adam@sics.se> + * + * $Id: timer.h,v 1.3 2006/06/11 21:46:39 adam Exp $ + */ +#ifndef __TIMER_H__ +#define __TIMER_H__ + +#include "clock.h" + +/** + * A timer. + * + * This structure is used for declaring a timer. The timer must be set + * with timer_set() before it can be used. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +struct timer { +  clock_time_t start; +  clock_time_t interval; +}; + +void timer_set(struct timer *t, clock_time_t interval); +void timer_reset(struct timer *t); +void timer_restart(struct timer *t); +int timer_expired(struct timer *t); + +#endif /* __TIMER_H__ */ + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip-split.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip-split.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..5222a05b63 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip-split.c @@ -0,0 +1,151 @@ +/* + * Copyright (c) 2004, Swedish Institute of Computer Science. + * All rights reserved. + * + * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without + * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions + * are met: + * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright + *    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + *    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + *    documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + * 3. Neither the name of the Institute nor the names of its contributors + *    may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software + *    without specific prior written permission. + * + * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE INSTITUTE AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND + * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE + * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE + * ARE DISCLAIMED.  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE INSTITUTE OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE + * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL + * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS + * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) + * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT + * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY + * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF + * SUCH DAMAGE. + * + * This file is part of the Contiki operating system. + * + * Author: Adam Dunkels <adam@sics.se> + * + * $Id: uip-split.c,v 1.2 2008/10/14 13:39:12 julienabeille Exp $ + */ + +#include "uip-split.h" + + +#define BUF ((struct uip_tcpip_hdr *)&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN]) + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_split_output(void) +{ +#if UIP_TCP +  u16_t tcplen, len1, len2; + +  /* We only try to split maximum sized TCP segments. */ +  if(BUF->proto == UIP_PROTO_TCP  && uip_len == UIP_BUFSIZE) { + +    tcplen = uip_len - UIP_TCPIP_HLEN - UIP_LLH_LEN; +    /* Split the segment in two. If the original packet length was +       odd, we make the second packet one byte larger. */ +    len1 = len2 = tcplen / 2; +    if(len1 + len2 < tcplen) { +      ++len2; +    } + +    /* Create the first packet. This is done by altering the length +       field of the IP header and updating the checksums. */ +    uip_len = len1 + UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN; +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +    /* For IPv6, the IP length field does not include the IPv6 IP header +       length. */ +    BUF->len[0] = ((uip_len - UIP_IPH_LEN) >> 8); +    BUF->len[1] = ((uip_len - UIP_IPH_LEN) & 0xff); +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +    BUF->len[0] = (uip_len - UIP_LLH_LEN) >> 8; +    BUF->len[1] = (uip_len - UIP_LLH_LEN) & 0xff; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +    /* Recalculate the TCP checksum. */ +    BUF->tcpchksum = 0; +    BUF->tcpchksum = ~(uip_tcpchksum()); + +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 +    /* Recalculate the IP checksum. */ +    BUF->ipchksum = 0; +    BUF->ipchksum = ~(uip_ipchksum()); +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +    /* Transmit the first packet. */ +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +    tcpip_ipv6_output(); +#else +	if (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Device) +	  RNDIS_Device_SendPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Device, uip_buf, uip_len); +	else +	  RNDIS_Host_SendPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Host, uip_buf, uip_len); +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +    /* Now, create the second packet. To do this, it is not enough to +       just alter the length field, but we must also update the TCP +       sequence number and point the uip_appdata to a new place in +       memory. This place is determined by the length of the first +       packet (len1). */ +    uip_len = len2 + UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN; +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +    /* For IPv6, the IP length field does not include the IPv6 IP header +       length. */ +    BUF->len[0] = ((uip_len - UIP_IPH_LEN) >> 8); +    BUF->len[1] = ((uip_len - UIP_IPH_LEN) & 0xff); +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +    BUF->len[0] = (uip_len  - UIP_LLH_LEN) >> 8; +    BUF->len[1] = (uip_len - UIP_LLH_LEN) & 0xff; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +    memcpy(uip_appdata, (u8_t *)uip_appdata + len1, len2); + +    uip_add32(BUF->seqno, len1); +    BUF->seqno[0] = uip_acc32[0]; +    BUF->seqno[1] = uip_acc32[1]; +    BUF->seqno[2] = uip_acc32[2]; +    BUF->seqno[3] = uip_acc32[3]; + +    /* Recalculate the TCP checksum. */ +    BUF->tcpchksum = 0; +    BUF->tcpchksum = ~(uip_tcpchksum()); + +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 +    /* Recalculate the IP checksum. */ +    BUF->ipchksum = 0; +    BUF->ipchksum = ~(uip_ipchksum()); +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +    /* Transmit the second packet. */ +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +    tcpip_ipv6_output(); +#else +	if (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Device) +	  RNDIS_Device_SendPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Device, uip_buf, uip_len); +	else +	  RNDIS_Host_SendPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Host, uip_buf, uip_len); +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +    return; +  } +#endif /* UIP_TCP */ + +  /*    uip_fw_output();*/ +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +	tcpip_ipv6_output(); +#else +	if (USB_CurrentMode == USB_MODE_Device) +	  RNDIS_Device_SendPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Device, uip_buf, uip_len); +	else +	  RNDIS_Host_SendPacket(&Ethernet_RNDIS_Interface_Host, uip_buf, uip_len); +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +} + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip-split.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip-split.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..0c768ce40a --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip-split.h @@ -0,0 +1,104 @@ +/* + * Copyright (c) 2004, Swedish Institute of Computer Science. + * All rights reserved. + * + * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without + * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions + * are met: + * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright + *    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + *    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + *    documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + * 3. Neither the name of the Institute nor the names of its contributors + *    may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software + *    without specific prior written permission. + * + * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE INSTITUTE AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND + * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE + * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE + * ARE DISCLAIMED.  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE INSTITUTE OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE + * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL + * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS + * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) + * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT + * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY + * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF + * SUCH DAMAGE. + * + * This file is part of the Contiki operating system. + * + * Author: Adam Dunkels <adam@sics.se> + * + * $Id: uip-split.h,v 1.1 2006/06/17 22:41:19 adamdunkels Exp $ + */ +/** + * \addtogroup uip + * @{ + */ + +/** + * \defgroup uipsplit uIP TCP throughput booster hack + * @{ + * + * The basic uIP TCP implementation only allows each TCP connection to + * have a single TCP segment in flight at any given time. Because of + * the delayed ACK algorithm employed by most TCP receivers, uIP's + * limit on the amount of in-flight TCP segments seriously reduces the + * maximum achievable throughput for sending data from uIP. + * + * The uip-split module is a hack which tries to remedy this + * situation. By splitting maximum sized outgoing TCP segments into + * two, the delayed ACK algorithm is not invoked at TCP + * receivers. This improves the throughput when sending data from uIP + * by orders of magnitude. + * + * The uip-split module uses the uip-fw module (uIP IP packet + * forwarding) for sending packets. Therefore, the uip-fw module must + * be set up with the appropriate network interfaces for this module + * to work. + */ + + +/** + * \file + * Module for splitting outbound TCP segments in two to avoid the + * delayed ACK throughput degradation. + * \author + * Adam Dunkels <adam@sics.se> + * + */ + +#ifndef __UIP_SPLIT_H__ +#define __UIP_SPLIT_H__ + +#include <string.h> +#include <uip.h> + +#include "../../USBHostMode.h" + +#include <LUFA/Drivers/USB/USB.h> + +/** + * Handle outgoing packets. + * + * This function inspects an outgoing packet in the uip_buf buffer and + * sends it out using the uip_fw_output() function. If the packet is a + * full-sized TCP segment it will be split into two segments and + * transmitted separately. This function should be called instead of + * the actual device driver output function, or the uip_fw_output() + * function. + * + * The headers of the outgoing packet is assumed to be in the uip_buf + * buffer and the payload is assumed to be wherever uip_appdata + * points. The length of the outgoing packet is assumed to be in the + * uip_len variable. + * + */ +void uip_split_output(void); +void uip_add32(u8_t *op32, u16_t op16); +#endif /* __UIP_SPLIT_H__ */ + +/** @} */ +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fead75775c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip.c @@ -0,0 +1,1941 @@ +#define DEBUG_PRINTF(...) /*printf(__VA_ARGS__)*/ + +/** + * \addtogroup uip + * @{ + */ + +/** + * \file + * The uIP TCP/IP stack code. + * \author Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> + */ + +/* + * Copyright (c) 2001-2003, Adam Dunkels. + * All rights reserved. + * + * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without + * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions + * are met: + * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright + *    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + *    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + *    documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote + *    products derived from this software without specific prior + *    written permission. + * + * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS + * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED + * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE + * ARE DISCLAIMED.  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY + * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL + * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE + * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS + * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, + * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING + * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS + * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. + * + * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. + * + * $Id: uip.c,v 1.15 2008/10/15 08:08:32 adamdunkels Exp $ + * + */ + +/* + * uIP is a small implementation of the IP, UDP and TCP protocols (as + * well as some basic ICMP stuff). The implementation couples the IP, + * UDP, TCP and the application layers very tightly. To keep the size + * of the compiled code down, this code frequently uses the goto + * statement. While it would be possible to break the uip_process() + * function into many smaller functions, this would increase the code + * size because of the overhead of parameter passing and the fact that + * the optimizer would not be as efficient. + * + * The principle is that we have a small buffer, called the uip_buf, + * in which the device driver puts an incoming packet. The TCP/IP + * stack parses the headers in the packet, and calls the + * application. If the remote host has sent data to the application, + * this data is present in the uip_buf and the application read the + * data from there. It is up to the application to put this data into + * a byte stream if needed. The application will not be fed with data + * that is out of sequence. + * + * If the application whishes to send data to the peer, it should put + * its data into the uip_buf. The uip_appdata pointer points to the + * first available byte. The TCP/IP stack will calculate the + * checksums, and fill in the necessary header fields and finally send + * the packet back to the peer. +*/ + +#include "uip.h" +#include "uipopt.h" +#include "uip_arp.h" + +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 /* If UIP_CONF_IPV6 is defined, we compile the +		      uip6.c file instead of this one. Therefore +		      this #ifndef removes the entire compilation +		      output of the uip.c file */ + + +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +#include "net/uip-neighbor.h" +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +#include <string.h> + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Variable definitions. */ + + +/* The IP address of this host. If it is defined to be fixed (by +   setting UIP_FIXEDADDR to 1 in uipopt.h), the address is set +   here. Otherwise, the address */ +#if UIP_FIXEDADDR > 0 +const uip_ipaddr_t uip_hostaddr = +  { UIP_IPADDR0, UIP_IPADDR1, UIP_IPADDR2, UIP_IPADDR3 }; +const uip_ipaddr_t uip_draddr = +  { UIP_DRIPADDR0, UIP_DRIPADDR1, UIP_DRIPADDR2, UIP_DRIPADDR3 }; +const uip_ipaddr_t uip_netmask = +  { UIP_NETMASK0, UIP_NETMASK1, UIP_NETMASK2, UIP_NETMASK3 }; +#else +uip_ipaddr_t uip_hostaddr, uip_draddr, uip_netmask; +#endif /* UIP_FIXEDADDR */ + +const uip_ipaddr_t uip_broadcast_addr = +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +  { { 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, +      0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff } }; +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +  { { 0xff, 0xff, 0xff, 0xff } }; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +const uip_ipaddr_t uip_all_zeroes_addr = { { 0x0, /* rest is 0 */ } }; + +#if UIP_FIXEDETHADDR +const struct uip_eth_addr uip_ethaddr = {{UIP_ETHADDR0, +					  UIP_ETHADDR1, +					  UIP_ETHADDR2, +					  UIP_ETHADDR3, +					  UIP_ETHADDR4, +					  UIP_ETHADDR5}}; +#else +struct uip_eth_addr uip_ethaddr = {{0,0,0,0,0,0}}; +#endif + +#ifndef UIP_CONF_EXTERNAL_BUFFER +u8_t uip_buf[UIP_BUFSIZE + 2];   /* The packet buffer that contains +				    incoming packets. */ +#endif /* UIP_CONF_EXTERNAL_BUFFER */ + +void *uip_appdata;               /* The uip_appdata pointer points to +				    application data. */ +void *uip_sappdata;              /* The uip_appdata pointer points to +				    the application data which is to +				    be sent. */ +#if UIP_URGDATA > 0 +void *uip_urgdata;               /* The uip_urgdata pointer points to +   				    urgent data (out-of-band data), if +   				    present. */ +u16_t uip_urglen, uip_surglen; +#endif /* UIP_URGDATA > 0 */ + +u16_t uip_len, uip_slen; +                             /* The uip_len is either 8 or 16 bits, +				depending on the maximum packet +				size. */ + +u8_t uip_flags;     /* The uip_flags variable is used for +				communication between the TCP/IP stack +				and the application program. */ +struct uip_conn *uip_conn;   /* uip_conn always points to the current +				connection. */ + +struct uip_conn uip_conns[UIP_CONNS]; +                             /* The uip_conns array holds all TCP +				connections. */ +u16_t uip_listenports[UIP_LISTENPORTS]; +                             /* The uip_listenports list all currently +				listening ports. */ +#if UIP_UDP +struct uip_udp_conn *uip_udp_conn; +struct uip_udp_conn uip_udp_conns[UIP_UDP_CONNS]; +#endif /* UIP_UDP */ + +static u16_t ipid;           /* Ths ipid variable is an increasing +				number that is used for the IP ID +				field. */ + +void uip_setipid(u16_t id) { ipid = id; } + +static u8_t iss[4];          /* The iss variable is used for the TCP +				initial sequence number. */ + +#if UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN +static u16_t lastport;       /* Keeps track of the last port used for +				a new connection. */ +#endif /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ + +/* Temporary variables. */ +u8_t uip_acc32[4]; +static u8_t c, opt; +static u16_t tmp16; + +/* Structures and definitions. */ +#define TCP_FIN 0x01 +#define TCP_SYN 0x02 +#define TCP_RST 0x04 +#define TCP_PSH 0x08 +#define TCP_ACK 0x10 +#define TCP_URG 0x20 +#define TCP_CTL 0x3f + +#define TCP_OPT_END     0   /* End of TCP options list */ +#define TCP_OPT_NOOP    1   /* "No-operation" TCP option */ +#define TCP_OPT_MSS     2   /* Maximum segment size TCP option */ + +#define TCP_OPT_MSS_LEN 4   /* Length of TCP MSS option. */ + +#define ICMP_ECHO_REPLY 0 +#define ICMP_ECHO       8 + +#define ICMP_DEST_UNREACHABLE        3 +#define ICMP_PORT_UNREACHABLE        3 + +#define ICMP6_ECHO_REPLY             129 +#define ICMP6_ECHO                   128 +#define ICMP6_NEIGHBOR_SOLICITATION  135 +#define ICMP6_NEIGHBOR_ADVERTISEMENT 136 + +#define ICMP6_FLAG_S (1 << 6) + +#define ICMP6_OPTION_SOURCE_LINK_ADDRESS 1 +#define ICMP6_OPTION_TARGET_LINK_ADDRESS 2 + + +/* Macros. */ +#define BUF ((struct uip_tcpip_hdr *)&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN]) +#define FBUF ((struct uip_tcpip_hdr *)&uip_reassbuf[0]) +#define ICMPBUF ((struct uip_icmpip_hdr *)&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN]) +#define UDPBUF ((struct uip_udpip_hdr *)&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN]) + + +#if UIP_STATISTICS == 1 +struct uip_stats uip_stat; +#define UIP_STAT(s) s +#else +#define UIP_STAT(s) +#endif /* UIP_STATISTICS == 1 */ + +#if UIP_LOGGING == 1 +#include <stdio.h> +void uip_log(char *msg); +#define UIP_LOG(m) uip_log(m) +#else +#define UIP_LOG(m) +#endif /* UIP_LOGGING == 1 */ + +#if ! UIP_ARCH_ADD32 +void +uip_add32(u8_t *op32, u16_t op16) +{ +  uip_acc32[3] = op32[3] + (op16 & 0xff); +  uip_acc32[2] = op32[2] + (op16 >> 8); +  uip_acc32[1] = op32[1]; +  uip_acc32[0] = op32[0]; + +  if(uip_acc32[2] < (op16 >> 8)) { +    ++uip_acc32[1]; +    if(uip_acc32[1] == 0) { +      ++uip_acc32[0]; +    } +  } + + +  if(uip_acc32[3] < (op16 & 0xff)) { +    ++uip_acc32[2]; +    if(uip_acc32[2] == 0) { +      ++uip_acc32[1]; +      if(uip_acc32[1] == 0) { +	++uip_acc32[0]; +      } +    } +  } +} + +#endif /* UIP_ARCH_ADD32 */ + +#if ! UIP_ARCH_CHKSUM +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +static u16_t +chksum(u16_t sum, const u8_t *data, u16_t len) +{ +  u16_t t; +  const u8_t *dataptr; +  const u8_t *last_byte; + +  dataptr = data; +  last_byte = data + len - 1; + +  while(dataptr < last_byte) {	/* At least two more bytes */ +    t = (dataptr[0] << 8) + dataptr[1]; +    sum += t; +    if(sum < t) { +      sum++;		/* carry */ +    } +    dataptr += 2; +  } + +  if(dataptr == last_byte) { +    t = (dataptr[0] << 8) + 0; +    sum += t; +    if(sum < t) { +      sum++;		/* carry */ +    } +  } + +  /* Return sum in host byte order. */ +  return sum; +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +u16_t +uip_chksum(u16_t *data, u16_t len) +{ +  return htons(chksum(0, (u8_t *)data, len)); +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#ifndef UIP_ARCH_IPCHKSUM +u16_t +uip_ipchksum(void) +{ +  u16_t sum; + +  sum = chksum(0, &uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN], UIP_IPH_LEN); +  DEBUG_PRINTF("uip_ipchksum: sum 0x%04x\n", sum); +  return (sum == 0) ? 0xffff : htons(sum); +} +#endif +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +static u16_t +upper_layer_chksum(u8_t proto) +{ +  u16_t upper_layer_len; +  u16_t sum; + +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +  upper_layer_len = (((u16_t)(BUF->len[0]) << 8) + BUF->len[1]); +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +  upper_layer_len = (((u16_t)(BUF->len[0]) << 8) + BUF->len[1]) - UIP_IPH_LEN; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +  /* First sum pseudo-header. */ + +  /* IP protocol and length fields. This addition cannot carry. */ +  sum = upper_layer_len + proto; +  /* Sum IP source and destination addresses. */ +  sum = chksum(sum, (u8_t *)&BUF->srcipaddr, 2 * sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); + +  /* Sum TCP header and data. */ +  sum = chksum(sum, &uip_buf[UIP_IPH_LEN + UIP_LLH_LEN], +	       upper_layer_len); + +  return (sum == 0) ? 0xffff : htons(sum); +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +u16_t +uip_icmp6chksum(void) +{ +  return upper_layer_chksum(UIP_PROTO_ICMP6); + +} +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +u16_t +uip_tcpchksum(void) +{ +  return upper_layer_chksum(UIP_PROTO_TCP); +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS +u16_t +uip_udpchksum(void) +{ +  return upper_layer_chksum(UIP_PROTO_UDP); +} +#endif /* UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS */ +#endif /* UIP_ARCH_CHKSUM */ +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_init(void) +{ +  for(c = 0; c < UIP_LISTENPORTS; ++c) { +    uip_listenports[c] = 0; +  } +  for(c = 0; c < UIP_CONNS; ++c) { +    uip_conns[c].tcpstateflags = UIP_CLOSED; +  } +#if UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN +  lastport = 1024; +#endif /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ + +#if UIP_UDP +  for(c = 0; c < UIP_UDP_CONNS; ++c) { +    uip_udp_conns[c].lport = 0; +  } +#endif /* UIP_UDP */ + + +  /* IPv4 initialization. */ +#if UIP_FIXEDADDR == 0 +  /*  uip_hostaddr[0] = uip_hostaddr[1] = 0;*/ +#endif /* UIP_FIXEDADDR */ + +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN +struct uip_conn * +uip_connect(uip_ipaddr_t *ripaddr, u16_t rport) +{ +  register struct uip_conn *conn, *cconn; + +  /* Find an unused local port. */ + again: +  ++lastport; + +  if(lastport >= 32000) { +    lastport = 4096; +  } + +  /* Check if this port is already in use, and if so try to find +     another one. */ +  for(c = 0; c < UIP_CONNS; ++c) { +    conn = &uip_conns[c]; +    if(conn->tcpstateflags != UIP_CLOSED && +       conn->lport == htons(lastport)) { +      goto again; +    } +  } + +  conn = 0; +  for(c = 0; c < UIP_CONNS; ++c) { +    cconn = &uip_conns[c]; +    if(cconn->tcpstateflags == UIP_CLOSED) { +      conn = cconn; +      break; +    } +    if(cconn->tcpstateflags == UIP_TIME_WAIT) { +      if(conn == 0 || +	 cconn->timer > conn->timer) { +	conn = cconn; +      } +    } +  } + +  if(conn == 0) { +    return 0; +  } + +  conn->tcpstateflags = UIP_SYN_SENT; + +  conn->snd_nxt[0] = iss[0]; +  conn->snd_nxt[1] = iss[1]; +  conn->snd_nxt[2] = iss[2]; +  conn->snd_nxt[3] = iss[3]; + +  conn->initialmss = conn->mss = UIP_TCP_MSS; + +  conn->len = 1;   /* TCP length of the SYN is one. */ +  conn->nrtx = 0; +  conn->timer = 1; /* Send the SYN next time around. */ +  conn->rto = UIP_RTO; +  conn->sa = 0; +  conn->sv = 16;   /* Initial value of the RTT variance. */ +  conn->lport = htons(lastport); +  conn->rport = rport; +  uip_ipaddr_copy(&conn->ripaddr, ripaddr); + +  return conn; +} +#endif /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if UIP_UDP +struct uip_udp_conn * +uip_udp_new(const uip_ipaddr_t *ripaddr, u16_t rport) +{ +  register struct uip_udp_conn *conn; + +  /* Find an unused local port. */ + again: +  ++lastport; + +  if(lastport >= 32000) { +    lastport = 4096; +  } + +  for(c = 0; c < UIP_UDP_CONNS; ++c) { +    if(uip_udp_conns[c].lport == htons(lastport)) { +      goto again; +    } +  } + + +  conn = 0; +  for(c = 0; c < UIP_UDP_CONNS; ++c) { +    if(uip_udp_conns[c].lport == 0) { +      conn = &uip_udp_conns[c]; +      break; +    } +  } + +  if(conn == 0) { +    return 0; +  } + +  conn->lport = HTONS(lastport); +  conn->rport = rport; +  if(ripaddr == NULL) { +    memset(&conn->ripaddr, 0, sizeof(uip_ipaddr_t)); +  } else { +    uip_ipaddr_copy(&conn->ripaddr, ripaddr); +  } +  conn->ttl = UIP_TTL; + +  return conn; +} +#endif /* UIP_UDP */ +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_unlisten(u16_t port) +{ +  for(c = 0; c < UIP_LISTENPORTS; ++c) { +    if(uip_listenports[c] == port) { +      uip_listenports[c] = 0; +      return; +    } +  } +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_listen(u16_t port) +{ +  for(c = 0; c < UIP_LISTENPORTS; ++c) { +    if(uip_listenports[c] == 0) { +      uip_listenports[c] = port; +      return; +    } +  } +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* XXX: IP fragment reassembly: not well-tested. */ + +#if UIP_REASSEMBLY && !UIP_CONF_IPV6 +#define UIP_REASS_BUFSIZE (UIP_BUFSIZE - UIP_LLH_LEN) +static u8_t uip_reassbuf[UIP_REASS_BUFSIZE]; +static u8_t uip_reassbitmap[UIP_REASS_BUFSIZE / (8 * 8)]; +static const u8_t bitmap_bits[8] = {0xff, 0x7f, 0x3f, 0x1f, +				    0x0f, 0x07, 0x03, 0x01}; +static u16_t uip_reasslen; +static u8_t uip_reassflags; +#define UIP_REASS_FLAG_LASTFRAG 0x01 +static u8_t uip_reasstmr; + +#define IP_MF   0x20 + +static u8_t +uip_reass(void) +{ +  u16_t offset, len; +  u16_t i; + +  /* If ip_reasstmr is zero, no packet is present in the buffer, so we +     write the IP header of the fragment into the reassembly +     buffer. The timer is updated with the maximum age. */ +  if(uip_reasstmr == 0) { +    memcpy(uip_reassbuf, &BUF->vhl, UIP_IPH_LEN); +    uip_reasstmr = UIP_REASS_MAXAGE; +    uip_reassflags = 0; +    /* Clear the bitmap. */ +    memset(uip_reassbitmap, 0, sizeof(uip_reassbitmap)); +  } + +  /* Check if the incoming fragment matches the one currently present +     in the reasembly buffer. If so, we proceed with copying the +     fragment into the buffer. */ +  if(BUF->srcipaddr[0] == FBUF->srcipaddr[0] && +     BUF->srcipaddr[1] == FBUF->srcipaddr[1] && +     BUF->destipaddr[0] == FBUF->destipaddr[0] && +     BUF->destipaddr[1] == FBUF->destipaddr[1] && +     BUF->ipid[0] == FBUF->ipid[0] && +     BUF->ipid[1] == FBUF->ipid[1]) { + +    len = (BUF->len[0] << 8) + BUF->len[1] - (BUF->vhl & 0x0f) * 4; +    offset = (((BUF->ipoffset[0] & 0x3f) << 8) + BUF->ipoffset[1]) * 8; + +    /* If the offset or the offset + fragment length overflows the +       reassembly buffer, we discard the entire packet. */ +    if(offset > UIP_REASS_BUFSIZE || +       offset + len > UIP_REASS_BUFSIZE) { +      uip_reasstmr = 0; +      goto nullreturn; +    } + +    /* Copy the fragment into the reassembly buffer, at the right +       offset. */ +    memcpy(&uip_reassbuf[UIP_IPH_LEN + offset], +	   (char *)BUF + (int)((BUF->vhl & 0x0f) * 4), +	   len); + +    /* Update the bitmap. */ +    if(offset / (8 * 8) == (offset + len) / (8 * 8)) { +      /* If the two endpoints are in the same byte, we only update +	 that byte. */ + +      uip_reassbitmap[offset / (8 * 8)] |= +	     bitmap_bits[(offset / 8 ) & 7] & +	     ~bitmap_bits[((offset + len) / 8 ) & 7]; +    } else { +      /* If the two endpoints are in different bytes, we update the +	 bytes in the endpoints and fill the stuff in-between with +	 0xff. */ +      uip_reassbitmap[offset / (8 * 8)] |= +	bitmap_bits[(offset / 8 ) & 7]; +      for(i = 1 + offset / (8 * 8); i < (offset + len) / (8 * 8); ++i) { +	uip_reassbitmap[i] = 0xff; +      } +      uip_reassbitmap[(offset + len) / (8 * 8)] |= +	~bitmap_bits[((offset + len) / 8 ) & 7]; +    } + +    /* If this fragment has the More Fragments flag set to zero, we +       know that this is the last fragment, so we can calculate the +       size of the entire packet. We also set the +       IP_REASS_FLAG_LASTFRAG flag to indicate that we have received +       the final fragment. */ + +    if((BUF->ipoffset[0] & IP_MF) == 0) { +      uip_reassflags |= UIP_REASS_FLAG_LASTFRAG; +      uip_reasslen = offset + len; +    } + +    /* Finally, we check if we have a full packet in the buffer. We do +       this by checking if we have the last fragment and if all bits +       in the bitmap are set. */ +    if(uip_reassflags & UIP_REASS_FLAG_LASTFRAG) { +      /* Check all bytes up to and including all but the last byte in +	 the bitmap. */ +      for(i = 0; i < uip_reasslen / (8 * 8) - 1; ++i) { +	if(uip_reassbitmap[i] != 0xff) { +	  goto nullreturn; +	} +      } +      /* Check the last byte in the bitmap. It should contain just the +	 right amount of bits. */ +      if(uip_reassbitmap[uip_reasslen / (8 * 8)] != +	 (u8_t)~bitmap_bits[uip_reasslen / 8 & 7]) { +	goto nullreturn; +      } + +      /* If we have come this far, we have a full packet in the +	 buffer, so we allocate a pbuf and copy the packet into it. We +	 also reset the timer. */ +      uip_reasstmr = 0; +      memcpy(BUF, FBUF, uip_reasslen); + +      /* Pretend to be a "normal" (i.e., not fragmented) IP packet +	 from now on. */ +      BUF->ipoffset[0] = BUF->ipoffset[1] = 0; +      BUF->len[0] = uip_reasslen >> 8; +      BUF->len[1] = uip_reasslen & 0xff; +      BUF->ipchksum = 0; +      BUF->ipchksum = ~(uip_ipchksum()); + +      return uip_reasslen; +    } +  } + + nullreturn: +  return 0; +} +#endif /* UIP_REASSEMBLY */ +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +static void +uip_add_rcv_nxt(u16_t n) +{ +  uip_add32(uip_conn->rcv_nxt, n); +  uip_conn->rcv_nxt[0] = uip_acc32[0]; +  uip_conn->rcv_nxt[1] = uip_acc32[1]; +  uip_conn->rcv_nxt[2] = uip_acc32[2]; +  uip_conn->rcv_nxt[3] = uip_acc32[3]; +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_process(u8_t flag) +{ +  register struct uip_conn *uip_connr = uip_conn; + +#if UIP_UDP +  if(flag == UIP_UDP_SEND_CONN) { +    goto udp_send; +  } +#endif /* UIP_UDP */ + +  uip_sappdata = uip_appdata = &uip_buf[UIP_IPTCPH_LEN + UIP_LLH_LEN]; + +  /* Check if we were invoked because of a poll request for a +     particular connection. */ +  if(flag == UIP_POLL_REQUEST) { +    if((uip_connr->tcpstateflags & UIP_TS_MASK) == UIP_ESTABLISHED && +       !uip_outstanding(uip_connr)) { +	uip_len = uip_slen = 0; +	uip_flags = UIP_POLL; +	UIP_APPCALL(); +	goto appsend; +    } +    goto drop; + +    /* Check if we were invoked because of the periodic timer firing. */ +  } else if(flag == UIP_TIMER) { +#if UIP_REASSEMBLY +    if(uip_reasstmr != 0) { +      --uip_reasstmr; +    } +#endif /* UIP_REASSEMBLY */ +    /* Increase the initial sequence number. */ +    if(++iss[3] == 0) { +      if(++iss[2] == 0) { +	if(++iss[1] == 0) { +	  ++iss[0]; +	} +      } +    } + +    /* Reset the length variables. */ +    uip_len = 0; +    uip_slen = 0; + +    /* Check if the connection is in a state in which we simply wait +       for the connection to time out. If so, we increase the +       connection's timer and remove the connection if it times +       out. */ +    if(uip_connr->tcpstateflags == UIP_TIME_WAIT || +       uip_connr->tcpstateflags == UIP_FIN_WAIT_2) { +      ++(uip_connr->timer); +      if(uip_connr->timer == UIP_TIME_WAIT_TIMEOUT) { +	uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_CLOSED; +      } +    } else if(uip_connr->tcpstateflags != UIP_CLOSED) { +      /* If the connection has outstanding data, we increase the +	 connection's timer and see if it has reached the RTO value +	 in which case we retransmit. */ +      if(uip_outstanding(uip_connr)) { +	if(uip_connr->timer-- == 0) { +	  if(uip_connr->nrtx == UIP_MAXRTX || +	     ((uip_connr->tcpstateflags == UIP_SYN_SENT || +	       uip_connr->tcpstateflags == UIP_SYN_RCVD) && +	      uip_connr->nrtx == UIP_MAXSYNRTX)) { +	    uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_CLOSED; + +	    /* We call UIP_APPCALL() with uip_flags set to +	       UIP_TIMEDOUT to inform the application that the +	       connection has timed out. */ +	    uip_flags = UIP_TIMEDOUT; +	    UIP_APPCALL(); + +	    /* We also send a reset packet to the remote host. */ +	    BUF->flags = TCP_RST | TCP_ACK; +	    goto tcp_send_nodata; +	  } + +	  /* Exponential back-off. */ +	  uip_connr->timer = UIP_RTO << (uip_connr->nrtx > 4? +					 4: +					 uip_connr->nrtx); +	  ++(uip_connr->nrtx); + +	  /* Ok, so we need to retransmit. We do this differently +	     depending on which state we are in. In ESTABLISHED, we +	     call upon the application so that it may prepare the +	     data for the retransmit. In SYN_RCVD, we resend the +	     SYNACK that we sent earlier and in LAST_ACK we have to +	     retransmit our FINACK. */ +	  UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.rexmit); +	  switch(uip_connr->tcpstateflags & UIP_TS_MASK) { +	  case UIP_SYN_RCVD: +	    /* In the SYN_RCVD state, we should retransmit our +               SYNACK. */ +	    goto tcp_send_synack; + +#if UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN +	  case UIP_SYN_SENT: +	    /* In the SYN_SENT state, we retransmit out SYN. */ +	    BUF->flags = 0; +	    goto tcp_send_syn; +#endif /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ + +	  case UIP_ESTABLISHED: +	    /* In the ESTABLISHED state, we call upon the application +               to do the actual retransmit after which we jump into +               the code for sending out the packet (the apprexmit +               label). */ +	    uip_flags = UIP_REXMIT; +	    UIP_APPCALL(); +	    goto apprexmit; + +	  case UIP_FIN_WAIT_1: +	  case UIP_CLOSING: +	  case UIP_LAST_ACK: +	    /* In all these states we should retransmit a FINACK. */ +	    goto tcp_send_finack; + +	  } +	} +      } else if((uip_connr->tcpstateflags & UIP_TS_MASK) == UIP_ESTABLISHED) { +	/* If there was no need for a retransmission, we poll the +           application for new data. */ +	uip_len = uip_slen = 0; +	uip_flags = UIP_POLL; +	UIP_APPCALL(); +	goto appsend; +      } +    } +    goto drop; +  } +#if UIP_UDP +  if(flag == UIP_UDP_TIMER) { +    if(uip_udp_conn->lport != 0) { +      uip_conn = NULL; +      uip_sappdata = uip_appdata = &uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_IPUDPH_LEN]; +      uip_len = uip_slen = 0; +      uip_flags = UIP_POLL; +      UIP_UDP_APPCALL(); +      goto udp_send; +    } else { +      goto drop; +    } +  } +#endif + +  /* This is where the input processing starts. */ +  UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.recv); + +  /* Start of IP input header processing code. */ + +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +  /* Check validity of the IP header. */ +  if((BUF->vtc & 0xf0) != 0x60)  { /* IP version and header length. */ +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.vhlerr); +    UIP_LOG("ipv6: invalid version."); +    goto drop; +  } +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +  /* Check validity of the IP header. */ +  if(BUF->vhl != 0x45)  { /* IP version and header length. */ +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.vhlerr); +    UIP_LOG("ip: invalid version or header length."); +    goto drop; +  } +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +  /* Check the size of the packet. If the size reported to us in +     uip_len is smaller the size reported in the IP header, we assume +     that the packet has been corrupted in transit. If the size of +     uip_len is larger than the size reported in the IP packet header, +     the packet has been padded and we set uip_len to the correct +     value.. */ + +  if((BUF->len[0] << 8) + BUF->len[1] <= uip_len) { +    uip_len = (BUF->len[0] << 8) + BUF->len[1]; +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +    uip_len += 40; /* The length reported in the IPv6 header is the +		      length of the payload that follows the +		      header. However, uIP uses the uip_len variable +		      for holding the size of the entire packet, +		      including the IP header. For IPv4 this is not a +		      problem as the length field in the IPv4 header +		      contains the length of the entire packet. But +		      for IPv6 we need to add the size of the IPv6 +		      header (40 bytes). */ +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +  } else { +    UIP_LOG("ip: packet shorter than reported in IP header."); +    goto drop; +  } + +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 +  /* Check the fragment flag. */ +  if((BUF->ipoffset[0] & 0x3f) != 0 || +     BUF->ipoffset[1] != 0) { +#if UIP_REASSEMBLY +    uip_len = uip_reass(); +    if(uip_len == 0) { +      goto drop; +    } +#else /* UIP_REASSEMBLY */ +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.fragerr); +    UIP_LOG("ip: fragment dropped."); +    goto drop; +#endif /* UIP_REASSEMBLY */ +  } +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +  if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&uip_hostaddr, &uip_all_zeroes_addr)) { +    /* If we are configured to use ping IP address configuration and +       hasn't been assigned an IP address yet, we accept all ICMP +       packets. */ +#if UIP_PINGADDRCONF && !UIP_CONF_IPV6 +    if(BUF->proto == UIP_PROTO_ICMP) { +      UIP_LOG("ip: possible ping config packet received."); +      goto icmp_input; +    } else { +      UIP_LOG("ip: packet dropped since no address assigned."); +      goto drop; +    } +#endif /* UIP_PINGADDRCONF */ + +  } else { +    /* If IP broadcast support is configured, we check for a broadcast +       UDP packet, which may be destined to us. */ +#if UIP_BROADCAST +    DEBUG_PRINTF("UDP IP checksum 0x%04x\n", uip_ipchksum()); +    if(BUF->proto == UIP_PROTO_UDP && +       uip_ipaddr_cmp(&BUF->destipaddr, &uip_broadcast_addr)) +	{ +		if (uip_ipaddr_cmp(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_all_zeroes_addr)) +		  uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_broadcast_addr); + +		goto udp_input; +    } +#endif /* UIP_BROADCAST */ + +    /* Check if the packet is destined for our IP address. */ +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 +    if(!uip_ipaddr_cmp(&BUF->destipaddr, &uip_hostaddr)) { +      UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); +      goto drop; +    } +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +    /* For IPv6, packet reception is a little trickier as we need to +       make sure that we listen to certain multicast addresses (all +       hosts multicast address, and the solicited-node multicast +       address) as well. However, we will cheat here and accept all +       multicast packets that are sent to the ff02::/16 addresses. */ +    if(!uip_ipaddr_cmp(&BUF->destipaddr, &uip_hostaddr) && +       BUF->destipaddr.u16[0] != HTONS(0xff02)) { +      UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); +      goto drop; +    } +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +  } + +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 +  if(uip_ipchksum() != 0xffff) { /* Compute and check the IP header +				    checksum. */ +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.chkerr); +    UIP_LOG("ip: bad checksum."); +    goto drop; +  } +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +  if(BUF->proto == UIP_PROTO_TCP) { /* Check for TCP packet. If so, +				       proceed with TCP input +				       processing. */ +    goto tcp_input; +  } + +#if UIP_UDP +  if(BUF->proto == UIP_PROTO_UDP) { +    goto udp_input; +  } +#endif /* UIP_UDP */ + +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 +  /* ICMPv4 processing code follows. */ +  if(BUF->proto != UIP_PROTO_ICMP) { /* We only allow ICMP packets from +					here. */ +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.protoerr); +    UIP_LOG("ip: neither tcp nor icmp."); +    goto drop; +  } + +#if UIP_PINGADDRCONF + icmp_input: +#endif /* UIP_PINGADDRCONF */ +  UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.recv); + +  /* ICMP echo (i.e., ping) processing. This is simple, we only change +     the ICMP type from ECHO to ECHO_REPLY and adjust the ICMP +     checksum before we return the packet. */ +  if(ICMPBUF->type != ICMP_ECHO) { +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.drop); +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.typeerr); +    UIP_LOG("icmp: not icmp echo."); +    goto drop; +  } + +  /* If we are configured to use ping IP address assignment, we use +     the destination IP address of this ping packet and assign it to +     yourself. */ +#if UIP_PINGADDRCONF +  if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&uip_hostaddr, &uip_all_zeroes_addr)) { +    uip_hostaddr = BUF->destipaddr; +  } +#endif /* UIP_PINGADDRCONF */ + +  ICMPBUF->type = ICMP_ECHO_REPLY; + +  if(ICMPBUF->icmpchksum >= HTONS(0xffff - (ICMP_ECHO << 8))) { +    ICMPBUF->icmpchksum += HTONS(ICMP_ECHO << 8) + 1; +  } else { +    ICMPBUF->icmpchksum += HTONS(ICMP_ECHO << 8); +  } + +  /* Swap IP addresses. */ +  uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->destipaddr, &BUF->srcipaddr); +  uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_hostaddr); + +  UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.sent); +  BUF->ttl = UIP_TTL; +  goto ip_send_nolen; + +  /* End of IPv4 input header processing code. */ +#else /* !UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +  /* This is IPv6 ICMPv6 processing code. */ +  DEBUG_PRINTF("icmp6_input: length %d\n", uip_len); + +  if(BUF->proto != UIP_PROTO_ICMP6) { /* We only allow ICMPv6 packets from +					 here. */ +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.drop); +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.protoerr); +    UIP_LOG("ip: neither tcp nor icmp6."); +    goto drop; +  } + +  UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.recv); + +  /* If we get a neighbor solicitation for our address we should send +     a neighbor advertisement message back. */ +  if(ICMPBUF->type == ICMP6_NEIGHBOR_SOLICITATION) { +    if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&ICMPBUF->icmp6data, &uip_hostaddr)) { + +      if(ICMPBUF->options[0] == ICMP6_OPTION_SOURCE_LINK_ADDRESS) { +	/* Save the sender's address in our neighbor list. */ +	uip_neighbor_add(&ICMPBUF->srcipaddr, &(ICMPBUF->options[2])); +      } + +      /* We should now send a neighbor advertisement back to where the +	 neighbor solicitation came from. */ +      ICMPBUF->type = ICMP6_NEIGHBOR_ADVERTISEMENT; +      ICMPBUF->flags = ICMP6_FLAG_S; /* Solicited flag. */ + +      ICMPBUF->reserved1 = ICMPBUF->reserved2 = ICMPBUF->reserved3 = 0; + +      uip_ipaddr_copy(&ICMPBUF->destipaddr, &ICMPBUF->srcipaddr); +      uip_ipaddr_copy(&ICMPBUF->srcipaddr, &uip_hostaddr); +      ICMPBUF->options[0] = ICMP6_OPTION_TARGET_LINK_ADDRESS; +      ICMPBUF->options[1] = 1;  /* Options length, 1 = 8 bytes. */ +      memcpy(&(ICMPBUF->options[2]), &uip_ethaddr, sizeof(uip_ethaddr)); +      ICMPBUF->icmpchksum = 0; +      ICMPBUF->icmpchksum = ~uip_icmp6chksum(); + +      goto send; + +    } +    goto drop; +  } else if(ICMPBUF->type == ICMP6_ECHO) { +    /* ICMP echo (i.e., ping) processing. This is simple, we only +       change the ICMP type from ECHO to ECHO_REPLY and update the +       ICMP checksum before we return the packet. */ + +    ICMPBUF->type = ICMP6_ECHO_REPLY; + +    uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->destipaddr, &BUF->srcipaddr); +    uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_hostaddr); +    ICMPBUF->icmpchksum = 0; +    ICMPBUF->icmpchksum = ~uip_icmp6chksum(); + +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.sent); +    goto send; +  } else { +    DEBUG_PRINTF("Unknown icmp6 message type %d\n", ICMPBUF->type); +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.drop); +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.icmp.typeerr); +    UIP_LOG("icmp: unknown ICMP message."); +    goto drop; +  } + +  /* End of IPv6 ICMP processing. */ + +#endif /* !UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +#if UIP_UDP +  /* UDP input processing. */ + udp_input: +  /* UDP processing is really just a hack. We don't do anything to the +     UDP/IP headers, but let the UDP application do all the hard +     work. If the application sets uip_slen, it has a packet to +     send. */ +#if UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS +  uip_len = uip_len - UIP_IPUDPH_LEN; +  uip_appdata = &uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_IPUDPH_LEN]; +  if(UDPBUF->udpchksum != 0 && uip_udpchksum() != 0xffff) { +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.udp.drop); +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.udp.chkerr); +    UIP_LOG("udp: bad checksum."); +    goto drop; +  } +#else /* UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS */ +  uip_len = uip_len - UIP_IPUDPH_LEN; +#endif /* UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS */ + +  /* Demultiplex this UDP packet between the UDP "connections". */ +  for(uip_udp_conn = &uip_udp_conns[0]; +      uip_udp_conn < &uip_udp_conns[UIP_UDP_CONNS]; +      ++uip_udp_conn) { +    /* If the local UDP port is non-zero, the connection is considered +       to be used. If so, the local port number is checked against the +       destination port number in the received packet. If the two port +       numbers match, the remote port number is checked if the +       connection is bound to a remote port. Finally, if the +       connection is bound to a remote IP address, the source IP +       address of the packet is checked. */ +    if(uip_udp_conn->lport != 0 && +       UDPBUF->destport == uip_udp_conn->lport && +       (uip_udp_conn->rport == 0 || +        UDPBUF->srcport == uip_udp_conn->rport) && +       (uip_ipaddr_cmp(&uip_udp_conn->ripaddr, &uip_all_zeroes_addr) || +	uip_ipaddr_cmp(&uip_udp_conn->ripaddr, &uip_broadcast_addr) || +	uip_ipaddr_cmp(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_udp_conn->ripaddr))) { +      goto udp_found; +    } +  } +  UIP_LOG("udp: no matching connection found"); +#if UIP_CONF_ICMP_DEST_UNREACH && !UIP_CONF_IPV6 +  /* Copy fields from packet header into payload of this ICMP packet. */ +  memcpy(&(ICMPBUF->payload[0]), ICMPBUF, UIP_IPH_LEN + 8); + +  /* Set the ICMP type and code. */ +  ICMPBUF->type = ICMP_DEST_UNREACHABLE; +  ICMPBUF->icode = ICMP_PORT_UNREACHABLE; + +  /* Calculate the ICMP checksum. */ +  ICMPBUF->icmpchksum = 0; +  ICMPBUF->icmpchksum = ~uip_chksum((u16_t *)&(ICMPBUF->type), 36); + +  /* Set the IP destination address to be the source address of the +     original packet. */ +  uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->destipaddr, &BUF->srcipaddr); + +  /* Set our IP address as the source address. */ +  uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_hostaddr); + +  /* The size of the ICMP destination unreachable packet is 36 + the +     size of the IP header (20) = 56. */ +  uip_len = 36 + UIP_IPH_LEN; +  ICMPBUF->len[0] = 0; +  ICMPBUF->len[1] = (u8_t)uip_len; +  ICMPBUF->ttl = UIP_TTL; +  ICMPBUF->proto = UIP_PROTO_ICMP; + +  goto ip_send_nolen; +#else /* UIP_CONF_ICMP_DEST_UNREACH */ +  goto drop; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_ICMP_DEST_UNREACH */ + + udp_found: +  uip_conn = NULL; +  uip_flags = UIP_NEWDATA; +  uip_sappdata = uip_appdata = &uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_IPUDPH_LEN]; +  uip_slen = 0; +  UIP_UDP_APPCALL(); + + udp_send: +  if(uip_slen == 0) { +    goto drop; +  } +  uip_len = uip_slen + UIP_IPUDPH_LEN; + +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +  /* For IPv6, the IP length field does not include the IPv6 IP header +     length. */ +  BUF->len[0] = ((uip_len - UIP_IPH_LEN) >> 8); +  BUF->len[1] = ((uip_len - UIP_IPH_LEN) & 0xff); +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +  BUF->len[0] = (uip_len >> 8); +  BUF->len[1] = (uip_len & 0xff); +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +  BUF->ttl = uip_udp_conn->ttl; +  BUF->proto = UIP_PROTO_UDP; + +  UDPBUF->udplen = HTONS(uip_slen + UIP_UDPH_LEN); +  UDPBUF->udpchksum = 0; + +  BUF->srcport  = uip_udp_conn->lport; +  BUF->destport = uip_udp_conn->rport; + +  uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_hostaddr); +  uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->destipaddr, &uip_udp_conn->ripaddr); + +  uip_appdata = &uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_IPTCPH_LEN]; + +#if UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS +  /* Calculate UDP checksum. */ +  UDPBUF->udpchksum = ~(uip_udpchksum()); +  if(UDPBUF->udpchksum == 0) { +    UDPBUF->udpchksum = 0xffff; +  } +#endif /* UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS */ + +  goto ip_send_nolen; +#endif /* UIP_UDP */ + +  /* TCP input processing. */ + tcp_input: +  UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.recv); + +  /* Start of TCP input header processing code. */ + +  if(uip_tcpchksum() != 0xffff) {   /* Compute and check the TCP +				       checksum. */ +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.drop); +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.chkerr); +    UIP_LOG("tcp: bad checksum."); +    goto drop; +  } + +  /* Demultiplex this segment. */ +  /* First check any active connections. */ +  for(uip_connr = &uip_conns[0]; uip_connr <= &uip_conns[UIP_CONNS - 1]; +      ++uip_connr) { +    if(uip_connr->tcpstateflags != UIP_CLOSED && +       BUF->destport == uip_connr->lport && +       BUF->srcport == uip_connr->rport && +       uip_ipaddr_cmp(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_connr->ripaddr)) { +      goto found; +    } +  } + +  /* If we didn't find and active connection that expected the packet, +     either this packet is an old duplicate, or this is a SYN packet +     destined for a connection in LISTEN. If the SYN flag isn't set, +     it is an old packet and we send a RST. */ +  if((BUF->flags & TCP_CTL) != TCP_SYN) { +    goto reset; +  } + +  tmp16 = BUF->destport; +  /* Next, check listening connections. */ +  for(c = 0; c < UIP_LISTENPORTS; ++c) { +    if(tmp16 == uip_listenports[c]) { +      goto found_listen; +    } +  } + +  /* No matching connection found, so we send a RST packet. */ +  UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.synrst); + + reset: +  /* We do not send resets in response to resets. */ +  if(BUF->flags & TCP_RST) { +    goto drop; +  } + +  UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.rst); + +  BUF->flags = TCP_RST | TCP_ACK; +  uip_len = UIP_IPTCPH_LEN; +  BUF->tcpoffset = 5 << 4; + +  /* Flip the seqno and ackno fields in the TCP header. */ +  c = BUF->seqno[3]; +  BUF->seqno[3] = BUF->ackno[3]; +  BUF->ackno[3] = c; + +  c = BUF->seqno[2]; +  BUF->seqno[2] = BUF->ackno[2]; +  BUF->ackno[2] = c; + +  c = BUF->seqno[1]; +  BUF->seqno[1] = BUF->ackno[1]; +  BUF->ackno[1] = c; + +  c = BUF->seqno[0]; +  BUF->seqno[0] = BUF->ackno[0]; +  BUF->ackno[0] = c; + +  /* We also have to increase the sequence number we are +     acknowledging. If the least significant byte overflowed, we need +     to propagate the carry to the other bytes as well. */ +  if(++BUF->ackno[3] == 0) { +    if(++BUF->ackno[2] == 0) { +      if(++BUF->ackno[1] == 0) { +	++BUF->ackno[0]; +      } +    } +  } + +  /* Swap port numbers. */ +  tmp16 = BUF->srcport; +  BUF->srcport = BUF->destport; +  BUF->destport = tmp16; + +  /* Swap IP addresses. */ +  uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->destipaddr, &BUF->srcipaddr); +  uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_hostaddr); + +  /* And send out the RST packet! */ +  goto tcp_send_noconn; + +  /* This label will be jumped to if we matched the incoming packet +     with a connection in LISTEN. In that case, we should create a new +     connection and send a SYNACK in return. */ + found_listen: +  /* First we check if there are any connections available. Unused +     connections are kept in the same table as used connections, but +     unused ones have the tcpstate set to CLOSED. Also, connections in +     TIME_WAIT are kept track of and we'll use the oldest one if no +     CLOSED connections are found. Thanks to Eddie C. Dost for a very +     nice algorithm for the TIME_WAIT search. */ +  uip_connr = 0; +  for(c = 0; c < UIP_CONNS; ++c) { +    if(uip_conns[c].tcpstateflags == UIP_CLOSED) { +      uip_connr = &uip_conns[c]; +      break; +    } +    if(uip_conns[c].tcpstateflags == UIP_TIME_WAIT) { +      if(uip_connr == 0 || +	 uip_conns[c].timer > uip_connr->timer) { +	uip_connr = &uip_conns[c]; +      } +    } +  } + +  if(uip_connr == 0) { +    /* All connections are used already, we drop packet and hope that +       the remote end will retransmit the packet at a time when we +       have more spare connections. */ +    UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.syndrop); +    UIP_LOG("tcp: found no unused connections."); +    goto drop; +  } +  uip_conn = uip_connr; + +  /* Fill in the necessary fields for the new connection. */ +  uip_connr->rto = uip_connr->timer = UIP_RTO; +  uip_connr->sa = 0; +  uip_connr->sv = 4; +  uip_connr->nrtx = 0; +  uip_connr->lport = BUF->destport; +  uip_connr->rport = BUF->srcport; +  uip_ipaddr_copy(&uip_connr->ripaddr, &BUF->srcipaddr); +  uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_SYN_RCVD; + +  uip_connr->snd_nxt[0] = iss[0]; +  uip_connr->snd_nxt[1] = iss[1]; +  uip_connr->snd_nxt[2] = iss[2]; +  uip_connr->snd_nxt[3] = iss[3]; +  uip_connr->len = 1; + +  /* rcv_nxt should be the seqno from the incoming packet + 1. */ +  uip_connr->rcv_nxt[3] = BUF->seqno[3]; +  uip_connr->rcv_nxt[2] = BUF->seqno[2]; +  uip_connr->rcv_nxt[1] = BUF->seqno[1]; +  uip_connr->rcv_nxt[0] = BUF->seqno[0]; +  uip_add_rcv_nxt(1); + +  /* Parse the TCP MSS option, if present. */ +  if((BUF->tcpoffset & 0xf0) > 0x50) { +    for(c = 0; c < ((BUF->tcpoffset >> 4) - 5) << 2 ;) { +      opt = uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + c]; +      if(opt == TCP_OPT_END) { +	/* End of options. */ +	break; +      } else if(opt == TCP_OPT_NOOP) { +	++c; +	/* NOP option. */ +      } else if(opt == TCP_OPT_MSS && +		uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 1 + c] == TCP_OPT_MSS_LEN) { +	/* An MSS option with the right option length. */ +	tmp16 = ((u16_t)uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 2 + c] << 8) | +	  (u16_t)uip_buf[UIP_IPTCPH_LEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 3 + c]; +	uip_connr->initialmss = uip_connr->mss = +	  tmp16 > UIP_TCP_MSS? UIP_TCP_MSS: tmp16; + +	/* And we are done processing options. */ +	break; +      } else { +	/* All other options have a length field, so that we easily +	   can skip past them. */ +	if(uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 1 + c] == 0) { +	  /* If the length field is zero, the options are malformed +	     and we don't process them further. */ +	  break; +	} +	c += uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 1 + c]; +      } +    } +  } + +  /* Our response will be a SYNACK. */ +#if UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN + tcp_send_synack: +  BUF->flags = TCP_ACK; + + tcp_send_syn: +  BUF->flags |= TCP_SYN; +#else /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ + tcp_send_synack: +  BUF->flags = TCP_SYN | TCP_ACK; +#endif /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ + +  /* We send out the TCP Maximum Segment Size option with our +     SYNACK. */ +  BUF->optdata[0] = TCP_OPT_MSS; +  BUF->optdata[1] = TCP_OPT_MSS_LEN; +  BUF->optdata[2] = (UIP_TCP_MSS) / 256; +  BUF->optdata[3] = (UIP_TCP_MSS) & 255; +  uip_len = UIP_IPTCPH_LEN + TCP_OPT_MSS_LEN; +  BUF->tcpoffset = ((UIP_TCPH_LEN + TCP_OPT_MSS_LEN) / 4) << 4; +  goto tcp_send; + +  /* This label will be jumped to if we found an active connection. */ + found: +  uip_conn = uip_connr; +  uip_flags = 0; +  /* We do a very naive form of TCP reset processing; we just accept +     any RST and kill our connection. We should in fact check if the +     sequence number of this reset is within our advertised window +     before we accept the reset. */ +  if(BUF->flags & TCP_RST) { +    uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_CLOSED; +    UIP_LOG("tcp: got reset, aborting connection."); +    uip_flags = UIP_ABORT; +    UIP_APPCALL(); +    goto drop; +  } +  /* Calculate the length of the data, if the application has sent +     any data to us. */ +  c = (BUF->tcpoffset >> 4) << 2; +  /* uip_len will contain the length of the actual TCP data. This is +     calculated by subtracing the length of the TCP header (in +     c) and the length of the IP header (20 bytes). */ +  uip_len = uip_len - c - UIP_IPH_LEN; + +  /* First, check if the sequence number of the incoming packet is +     what we're expecting next. If not, we send out an ACK with the +     correct numbers in. */ +  if(!(((uip_connr->tcpstateflags & UIP_TS_MASK) == UIP_SYN_SENT) && +       ((BUF->flags & TCP_CTL) == (TCP_SYN | TCP_ACK)))) { +    if((uip_len > 0 || ((BUF->flags & (TCP_SYN | TCP_FIN)) != 0)) && +       (BUF->seqno[0] != uip_connr->rcv_nxt[0] || +	BUF->seqno[1] != uip_connr->rcv_nxt[1] || +	BUF->seqno[2] != uip_connr->rcv_nxt[2] || +	BUF->seqno[3] != uip_connr->rcv_nxt[3])) { +      goto tcp_send_ack; +    } +  } + +  /* Next, check if the incoming segment acknowledges any outstanding +     data. If so, we update the sequence number, reset the length of +     the outstanding data, calculate RTT estimations, and reset the +     retransmission timer. */ +  if((BUF->flags & TCP_ACK) && uip_outstanding(uip_connr)) { +    uip_add32(uip_connr->snd_nxt, uip_connr->len); + +    if(BUF->ackno[0] == uip_acc32[0] && +       BUF->ackno[1] == uip_acc32[1] && +       BUF->ackno[2] == uip_acc32[2] && +       BUF->ackno[3] == uip_acc32[3]) { +      /* Update sequence number. */ +      uip_connr->snd_nxt[0] = uip_acc32[0]; +      uip_connr->snd_nxt[1] = uip_acc32[1]; +      uip_connr->snd_nxt[2] = uip_acc32[2]; +      uip_connr->snd_nxt[3] = uip_acc32[3]; + +      /* Do RTT estimation, unless we have done retransmissions. */ +      if(uip_connr->nrtx == 0) { +	signed char m; +	m = uip_connr->rto - uip_connr->timer; +	/* This is taken directly from VJs original code in his paper */ +	m = m - (uip_connr->sa >> 3); +	uip_connr->sa += m; +	if(m < 0) { +	  m = -m; +	} +	m = m - (uip_connr->sv >> 2); +	uip_connr->sv += m; +	uip_connr->rto = (uip_connr->sa >> 3) + uip_connr->sv; + +      } +      /* Set the acknowledged flag. */ +      uip_flags = UIP_ACKDATA; +      /* Reset the retransmission timer. */ +      uip_connr->timer = uip_connr->rto; + +      /* Reset length of outstanding data. */ +      uip_connr->len = 0; +    } + +  } + +  /* Do different things depending on in what state the connection is. */ +  switch(uip_connr->tcpstateflags & UIP_TS_MASK) { +    /* CLOSED and LISTEN are not handled here. CLOSE_WAIT is not +	implemented, since we force the application to close when the +	peer sends a FIN (hence the application goes directly from +	ESTABLISHED to LAST_ACK). */ +  case UIP_SYN_RCVD: +    /* In SYN_RCVD we have sent out a SYNACK in response to a SYN, and +       we are waiting for an ACK that acknowledges the data we sent +       out the last time. Therefore, we want to have the UIP_ACKDATA +       flag set. If so, we enter the ESTABLISHED state. */ +    if(uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) { +      uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_ESTABLISHED; +      uip_flags = UIP_CONNECTED; +      uip_connr->len = 0; +      if(uip_len > 0) { +        uip_flags |= UIP_NEWDATA; +        uip_add_rcv_nxt(uip_len); +      } +      uip_slen = 0; +      UIP_APPCALL(); +      goto appsend; +    } +    goto drop; +#if UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN +  case UIP_SYN_SENT: +    /* In SYN_SENT, we wait for a SYNACK that is sent in response to +       our SYN. The rcv_nxt is set to sequence number in the SYNACK +       plus one, and we send an ACK. We move into the ESTABLISHED +       state. */ +    if((uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) && +       (BUF->flags & TCP_CTL) == (TCP_SYN | TCP_ACK)) { + +      /* Parse the TCP MSS option, if present. */ +      if((BUF->tcpoffset & 0xf0) > 0x50) { +	for(c = 0; c < ((BUF->tcpoffset >> 4) - 5) << 2 ;) { +	  opt = uip_buf[UIP_IPTCPH_LEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + c]; +	  if(opt == TCP_OPT_END) { +	    /* End of options. */ +	    break; +	  } else if(opt == TCP_OPT_NOOP) { +	    ++c; +	    /* NOP option. */ +	  } else if(opt == TCP_OPT_MSS && +		    uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 1 + c] == TCP_OPT_MSS_LEN) { +	    /* An MSS option with the right option length. */ +	    tmp16 = (uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 2 + c] << 8) | +	      uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 3 + c]; +	    uip_connr->initialmss = +	      uip_connr->mss = tmp16 > UIP_TCP_MSS? UIP_TCP_MSS: tmp16; + +	    /* And we are done processing options. */ +	    break; +	  } else { +	    /* All other options have a length field, so that we easily +	       can skip past them. */ +	    if(uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 1 + c] == 0) { +	      /* If the length field is zero, the options are malformed +		 and we don't process them further. */ +	      break; +	    } +	    c += uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN + 1 + c]; +	  } +	} +      } +      uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_ESTABLISHED; +      uip_connr->rcv_nxt[0] = BUF->seqno[0]; +      uip_connr->rcv_nxt[1] = BUF->seqno[1]; +      uip_connr->rcv_nxt[2] = BUF->seqno[2]; +      uip_connr->rcv_nxt[3] = BUF->seqno[3]; +      uip_add_rcv_nxt(1); +      uip_flags = UIP_CONNECTED | UIP_NEWDATA; +      uip_connr->len = 0; +      uip_len = 0; +      uip_slen = 0; +      UIP_APPCALL(); +      goto appsend; +    } +    /* Inform the application that the connection failed */ +    uip_flags = UIP_ABORT; +    UIP_APPCALL(); +    /* The connection is closed after we send the RST */ +    uip_conn->tcpstateflags = UIP_CLOSED; +    goto reset; +#endif /* UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN */ + +  case UIP_ESTABLISHED: +    /* In the ESTABLISHED state, we call upon the application to feed +    data into the uip_buf. If the UIP_ACKDATA flag is set, the +    application should put new data into the buffer, otherwise we are +    retransmitting an old segment, and the application should put that +    data into the buffer. + +    If the incoming packet is a FIN, we should close the connection on +    this side as well, and we send out a FIN and enter the LAST_ACK +    state. We require that there is no outstanding data; otherwise the +    sequence numbers will be screwed up. */ + +    if(BUF->flags & TCP_FIN && !(uip_connr->tcpstateflags & UIP_STOPPED)) { +      if(uip_outstanding(uip_connr)) { +	goto drop; +      } +      uip_add_rcv_nxt(1 + uip_len); +      uip_flags |= UIP_CLOSE; +      if(uip_len > 0) { +	uip_flags |= UIP_NEWDATA; +      } +      UIP_APPCALL(); +      uip_connr->len = 1; +      uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_LAST_ACK; +      uip_connr->nrtx = 0; +    tcp_send_finack: +      BUF->flags = TCP_FIN | TCP_ACK; +      goto tcp_send_nodata; +    } + +    /* Check the URG flag. If this is set, the segment carries urgent +       data that we must pass to the application. */ +    if((BUF->flags & TCP_URG) != 0) { +#if UIP_URGDATA > 0 +      uip_urglen = (BUF->urgp[0] << 8) | BUF->urgp[1]; +      if(uip_urglen > uip_len) { +	/* There is more urgent data in the next segment to come. */ +	uip_urglen = uip_len; +      } +      uip_add_rcv_nxt(uip_urglen); +      uip_len -= uip_urglen; +      uip_urgdata = uip_appdata; +      uip_appdata += uip_urglen; +    } else { +      uip_urglen = 0; +#else /* UIP_URGDATA > 0 */ +      uip_appdata = ((char *)uip_appdata) + ((BUF->urgp[0] << 8) | BUF->urgp[1]); +      uip_len -= (BUF->urgp[0] << 8) | BUF->urgp[1]; +#endif /* UIP_URGDATA > 0 */ +    } + +    /* If uip_len > 0 we have TCP data in the packet, and we flag this +       by setting the UIP_NEWDATA flag and update the sequence number +       we acknowledge. If the application has stopped the dataflow +       using uip_stop(), we must not accept any data packets from the +       remote host. */ +    if(uip_len > 0 && !(uip_connr->tcpstateflags & UIP_STOPPED)) { +      uip_flags |= UIP_NEWDATA; +      uip_add_rcv_nxt(uip_len); +    } + +    /* Check if the available buffer space advertised by the other end +       is smaller than the initial MSS for this connection. If so, we +       set the current MSS to the window size to ensure that the +       application does not send more data than the other end can +       handle. + +       If the remote host advertises a zero window, we set the MSS to +       the initial MSS so that the application will send an entire MSS +       of data. This data will not be acknowledged by the receiver, +       and the application will retransmit it. This is called the +       "persistent timer" and uses the retransmission mechanism. +    */ +    tmp16 = ((u16_t)BUF->wnd[0] << 8) + (u16_t)BUF->wnd[1]; +    if(tmp16 > uip_connr->initialmss || +       tmp16 == 0) { +      tmp16 = uip_connr->initialmss; +    } +    uip_connr->mss = tmp16; + +    /* If this packet constitutes an ACK for outstanding data (flagged +       by the UIP_ACKDATA flag, we should call the application since it +       might want to send more data. If the incoming packet had data +       from the peer (as flagged by the UIP_NEWDATA flag), the +       application must also be notified. + +       When the application is called, the global variable uip_len +       contains the length of the incoming data. The application can +       access the incoming data through the global pointer +       uip_appdata, which usually points UIP_IPTCPH_LEN + UIP_LLH_LEN +       bytes into the uip_buf array. + +       If the application wishes to send any data, this data should be +       put into the uip_appdata and the length of the data should be +       put into uip_len. If the application don't have any data to +       send, uip_len must be set to 0. */ +    if(uip_flags & (UIP_NEWDATA | UIP_ACKDATA)) { +      uip_slen = 0; +      UIP_APPCALL(); + +    appsend: + +      if(uip_flags & UIP_ABORT) { +	uip_slen = 0; +	uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_CLOSED; +	BUF->flags = TCP_RST | TCP_ACK; +	goto tcp_send_nodata; +      } + +      if(uip_flags & UIP_CLOSE) { +	uip_slen = 0; +	uip_connr->len = 1; +	uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_FIN_WAIT_1; +	uip_connr->nrtx = 0; +	BUF->flags = TCP_FIN | TCP_ACK; +	goto tcp_send_nodata; +      } + +      /* If uip_slen > 0, the application has data to be sent. */ +      if(uip_slen > 0) { + +	/* If the connection has acknowledged data, the contents of +	   the ->len variable should be discarded. */ +	if((uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) != 0) { +	  uip_connr->len = 0; +	} + +	/* If the ->len variable is non-zero the connection has +	   already data in transit and cannot send anymore right +	   now. */ +	if(uip_connr->len == 0) { + +	  /* The application cannot send more than what is allowed by +	     the mss (the minumum of the MSS and the available +	     window). */ +	  if(uip_slen > uip_connr->mss) { +	    uip_slen = uip_connr->mss; +	  } + +	  /* Remember how much data we send out now so that we know +	     when everything has been acknowledged. */ +	  uip_connr->len = uip_slen; +	} else { + +	  /* If the application already had unacknowledged data, we +	     make sure that the application does not send (i.e., +	     retransmit) out more than it previously sent out. */ +	  uip_slen = uip_connr->len; +	} +      } +      uip_connr->nrtx = 0; +    apprexmit: +      uip_appdata = uip_sappdata; + +      /* If the application has data to be sent, or if the incoming +         packet had new data in it, we must send out a packet. */ +      if(uip_slen > 0 && uip_connr->len > 0) { +	/* Add the length of the IP and TCP headers. */ +	uip_len = uip_connr->len + UIP_TCPIP_HLEN; +	/* We always set the ACK flag in response packets. */ +	BUF->flags = TCP_ACK | TCP_PSH; +	/* Send the packet. */ +	goto tcp_send_noopts; +      } +      /* If there is no data to send, just send out a pure ACK if +	 there is newdata. */ +      if(uip_flags & UIP_NEWDATA) { +	uip_len = UIP_TCPIP_HLEN; +	BUF->flags = TCP_ACK; +	goto tcp_send_noopts; +      } +    } +    goto drop; +  case UIP_LAST_ACK: +    /* We can close this connection if the peer has acknowledged our +       FIN. This is indicated by the UIP_ACKDATA flag. */ +    if(uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) { +      uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_CLOSED; +      uip_flags = UIP_CLOSE; +      UIP_APPCALL(); +    } +    break; + +  case UIP_FIN_WAIT_1: +    /* The application has closed the connection, but the remote host +       hasn't closed its end yet. Thus we do nothing but wait for a +       FIN from the other side. */ +    if(uip_len > 0) { +      uip_add_rcv_nxt(uip_len); +    } +    if(BUF->flags & TCP_FIN) { +      if(uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) { +	uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_TIME_WAIT; +	uip_connr->timer = 0; +	uip_connr->len = 0; +      } else { +	uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_CLOSING; +      } +      uip_add_rcv_nxt(1); +      uip_flags = UIP_CLOSE; +      UIP_APPCALL(); +      goto tcp_send_ack; +    } else if(uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) { +      uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_FIN_WAIT_2; +      uip_connr->len = 0; +      goto drop; +    } +    if(uip_len > 0) { +      goto tcp_send_ack; +    } +    goto drop; + +  case UIP_FIN_WAIT_2: +    if(uip_len > 0) { +      uip_add_rcv_nxt(uip_len); +    } +    if(BUF->flags & TCP_FIN) { +      uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_TIME_WAIT; +      uip_connr->timer = 0; +      uip_add_rcv_nxt(1); +      uip_flags = UIP_CLOSE; +      UIP_APPCALL(); +      goto tcp_send_ack; +    } +    if(uip_len > 0) { +      goto tcp_send_ack; +    } +    goto drop; + +  case UIP_TIME_WAIT: +    goto tcp_send_ack; + +  case UIP_CLOSING: +    if(uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) { +      uip_connr->tcpstateflags = UIP_TIME_WAIT; +      uip_connr->timer = 0; +    } +  } +  goto drop; + +  /* We jump here when we are ready to send the packet, and just want +     to set the appropriate TCP sequence numbers in the TCP header. */ + tcp_send_ack: +  BUF->flags = TCP_ACK; + + tcp_send_nodata: +  uip_len = UIP_IPTCPH_LEN; + + tcp_send_noopts: +  BUF->tcpoffset = (UIP_TCPH_LEN / 4) << 4; + +  /* We're done with the input processing. We are now ready to send a +     reply. Our job is to fill in all the fields of the TCP and IP +     headers before calculating the checksum and finally send the +     packet. */ + tcp_send: +  BUF->ackno[0] = uip_connr->rcv_nxt[0]; +  BUF->ackno[1] = uip_connr->rcv_nxt[1]; +  BUF->ackno[2] = uip_connr->rcv_nxt[2]; +  BUF->ackno[3] = uip_connr->rcv_nxt[3]; + +  BUF->seqno[0] = uip_connr->snd_nxt[0]; +  BUF->seqno[1] = uip_connr->snd_nxt[1]; +  BUF->seqno[2] = uip_connr->snd_nxt[2]; +  BUF->seqno[3] = uip_connr->snd_nxt[3]; + +  BUF->proto = UIP_PROTO_TCP; + +  BUF->srcport  = uip_connr->lport; +  BUF->destport = uip_connr->rport; + +  uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->srcipaddr, &uip_hostaddr); +  uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->destipaddr, &uip_connr->ripaddr); + +  if(uip_connr->tcpstateflags & UIP_STOPPED) { +    /* If the connection has issued uip_stop(), we advertise a zero +       window so that the remote host will stop sending data. */ +    BUF->wnd[0] = BUF->wnd[1] = 0; +  } else { +    BUF->wnd[0] = ((UIP_RECEIVE_WINDOW) >> 8); +    BUF->wnd[1] = ((UIP_RECEIVE_WINDOW) & 0xff); +  } + + tcp_send_noconn: +  BUF->ttl = UIP_TTL; +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +  /* For IPv6, the IP length field does not include the IPv6 IP header +     length. */ +  BUF->len[0] = ((uip_len - UIP_IPH_LEN) >> 8); +  BUF->len[1] = ((uip_len - UIP_IPH_LEN) & 0xff); +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +  BUF->len[0] = (uip_len >> 8); +  BUF->len[1] = (uip_len & 0xff); +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +  BUF->urgp[0] = BUF->urgp[1] = 0; + +  /* Calculate TCP checksum. */ +  BUF->tcpchksum = 0; +  BUF->tcpchksum = ~(uip_tcpchksum()); + + ip_send_nolen: +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +  BUF->vtc = 0x60; +  BUF->tcflow = 0x00; +  BUF->flow = 0x00; +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +  BUF->vhl = 0x45; +  BUF->tos = 0; +  BUF->ipoffset[0] = BUF->ipoffset[1] = 0; +  ++ipid; +  BUF->ipid[0] = ipid >> 8; +  BUF->ipid[1] = ipid & 0xff; +  /* Calculate IP checksum. */ +  BUF->ipchksum = 0; +  BUF->ipchksum = ~(uip_ipchksum()); +  DEBUG_PRINTF("uip ip_send_nolen: checksum 0x%04x\n", uip_ipchksum()); +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +  UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.tcp.sent); +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 + send: +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +  DEBUG_PRINTF("Sending packet with length %d (%d)\n", uip_len, +	       (BUF->len[0] << 8) | BUF->len[1]); + +  UIP_STAT(++uip_stat.ip.sent); +  /* Return and let the caller do the actual transmission. */ +  uip_flags = 0; +  return; + + drop: +  uip_len = 0; +  uip_flags = 0; +  return; +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +u16_t +htons(u16_t val) +{ +  return HTONS(val); +} + +u32_t +htonl(u32_t val) +{ +  return HTONL(val); +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_send(const void *data, int len) +{ +  int copylen; +#define MIN(a,b) ((a) < (b)? (a): (b)) +  copylen = MIN(len, UIP_BUFSIZE - UIP_LLH_LEN - UIP_TCPIP_HLEN - +		(int)((char *)uip_sappdata - (char *)&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_TCPIP_HLEN])); +  if(copylen > 0) { +    uip_slen = copylen; +    if(data != uip_sappdata) { +      memcpy(uip_sappdata, (data), uip_slen); +    } +  } +} +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** @} */ +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..7b87a2c77c --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip.h @@ -0,0 +1,2130 @@ + +/** + * \addtogroup uip + * @{ + */ + +/** + * \file + * Header file for the uIP TCP/IP stack. + * \author  Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> + * \author  Julien Abeille <jabeille@cisco.com> (IPv6 related code) + * \author  Mathilde Durvy <mdurvy@cisco.com> (IPv6 related code) + * + * The uIP TCP/IP stack header file contains definitions for a number + * of C macros that are used by uIP programs as well as internal uIP + * structures, TCP/IP header structures and function declarations. + * + */ + +/* + * Copyright (c) 2001-2003, Adam Dunkels. + * All rights reserved. + * + * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without + * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions + * are met: + * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright + *    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + *    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + *    documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote + *    products derived from this software without specific prior + *    written permission. + * + * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS + * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED + * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE + * ARE DISCLAIMED.  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY + * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL + * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE + * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS + * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, + * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING + * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS + * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. + * + * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. + * + * $Id: uip.h,v 1.24 2009/04/06 13:18:50 nvt-se Exp $ + * + */ + +#ifndef __UIP_H__ +#define __UIP_H__ + +#include "uipopt.h" + +/** + * Representation of an IP address. + * + */ +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +typedef union uip_ip6addr_t { +  u8_t  u8[16];			/* Initialiser, must come first!!! */ +  u16_t u16[8]; +} uip_ip6addr_t; + +typedef uip_ip6addr_t uip_ipaddr_t; +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +typedef union uip_ip4addr_t { +  u8_t  u8[4];			/* Initialiser, must come first!!! */ +  u16_t u16[2]; +#if 0 +  u32_t u32; +#endif +} uip_ip4addr_t; +typedef uip_ip4addr_t uip_ipaddr_t; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +/** \brief 16 bit 802.15.4 address */ +struct uip_802154_shortaddr { +  u8_t addr[2]; +}; +/** \brief 64 bit 802.15.4 address */ +struct uip_802154_longaddr { +  u8_t addr[8]; +}; + +/** \brief 802.11 address */ +struct uip_80211_addr { +  u8_t addr[6]; +}; + +/** \brief 802.3 address */ +struct uip_eth_addr { +  u8_t addr[6]; +}; + +#if UIP_CONF_LL_802154 +/** \brief 802.15.4 address */ +typedef struct uip_802154_longaddr uip_lladdr_t; +#define UIP_802154_SHORTADDR_LEN 2 +#define UIP_802154_LONGADDR_LEN  8 +#define UIP_LLADDR_LEN UIP_802154_LONGADDR_LEN +#else /*UIP_CONF_LL_802154*/ +#if UIP_CONF_LL_80211 +/** \brief 802.11 address */ +typedef struct uip_80211_addr uip_lladdr_t; +#define UIP_LLADDR_LEN 6 +#else /*UIP_CONF_LL_80211*/ +/** \brief Ethernet address */ +typedef struct uip_eth_addr uip_lladdr_t; +#define UIP_LLADDR_LEN 6 +#endif /*UIP_CONF_LL_80211*/ +#endif /*UIP_CONF_LL_802154*/ + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* First, the functions that should be called from the + * system. Initialization, the periodic timer, and incoming packets are + * handled by the following three functions. + */ +/** + * \defgroup uipconffunc uIP configuration functions + * @{ + * + * The uIP configuration functions are used for setting run-time + * parameters in uIP such as IP addresses. + */ + +/** + * Set the IP address of this host. + * + * The IP address is represented as a 4-byte array where the first + * octet of the IP address is put in the first member of the 4-byte + * array. + * + * Example: + \code + + uip_ipaddr_t addr; + + uip_ipaddr(&addr, 192,168,1,2); + uip_sethostaddr(&addr); + + \endcode + * \param addr A pointer to an IP address of type uip_ipaddr_t; + * + * \sa uip_ipaddr() + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_sethostaddr(addr) uip_ipaddr_copy(&uip_hostaddr, (addr)) + +/** + * Get the IP address of this host. + * + * The IP address is represented as a 4-byte array where the first + * octet of the IP address is put in the first member of the 4-byte + * array. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t hostaddr; + + uip_gethostaddr(&hostaddr); + \endcode + * \param addr A pointer to a uip_ipaddr_t variable that will be + * filled in with the currently configured IP address. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_gethostaddr(addr) uip_ipaddr_copy((addr), &uip_hostaddr) + +/** + * Set the default router's IP address. + * + * \param addr A pointer to a uip_ipaddr_t variable containing the IP + * address of the default router. + * + * \sa uip_ipaddr() + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_setdraddr(addr) uip_ipaddr_copy(&uip_draddr, (addr)) + +/** + * Set the netmask. + * + * \param addr A pointer to a uip_ipaddr_t variable containing the IP + * address of the netmask. + * + * \sa uip_ipaddr() + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_setnetmask(addr) uip_ipaddr_copy(&uip_netmask, (addr)) + + +/** + * Get the default router's IP address. + * + * \param addr A pointer to a uip_ipaddr_t variable that will be + * filled in with the IP address of the default router. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_getdraddr(addr) uip_ipaddr_copy((addr), &uip_draddr) + +/** + * Get the netmask. + * + * \param addr A pointer to a uip_ipaddr_t variable that will be + * filled in with the value of the netmask. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_getnetmask(addr) uip_ipaddr_copy((addr), &uip_netmask) + +/** @} */ + +/** + * \defgroup uipinit uIP initialization functions + * @{ + * + * The uIP initialization functions are used for booting uIP. + */ + +/** + * uIP initialization function. + * + * This function should be called at boot up to initialize the uIP + * TCP/IP stack. + */ +void uip_init(void); + +/** + * uIP initialization function. + * + * This function may be used at boot time to set the initial ip_id. + */ +void uip_setipid(u16_t id); + +/** @} */ + +/** + * \defgroup uipdevfunc uIP device driver functions + * @{ + * + * These functions are used by a network device driver for interacting + * with uIP. + */ + +/** + * Process an incoming packet. + * + * This function should be called when the device driver has received + * a packet from the network. The packet from the device driver must + * be present in the uip_buf buffer, and the length of the packet + * should be placed in the uip_len variable. + * + * When the function returns, there may be an outbound packet placed + * in the uip_buf packet buffer. If so, the uip_len variable is set to + * the length of the packet. If no packet is to be sent out, the + * uip_len variable is set to 0. + * + * The usual way of calling the function is presented by the source + * code below. + \code + uip_len = devicedriver_poll(); + if(uip_len > 0) { + uip_input(); + if(uip_len > 0) { + devicedriver_send(); + } + } + \endcode + * + * \note If you are writing a uIP device driver that needs ARP + * (Address Resolution Protocol), e.g., when running uIP over + * Ethernet, you will need to call the uIP ARP code before calling + * this function: + \code + #define BUF ((struct uip_eth_hdr *)&uip_buf[0]) + uip_len = ethernet_devicedrver_poll(); + if(uip_len > 0) { + if(BUF->type == HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_IP)) { + uip_arp_ipin(); + uip_input(); + if(uip_len > 0) { + uip_arp_out(); + ethernet_devicedriver_send(); + } + } else if(BUF->type == HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_ARP)) { + uip_arp_arpin(); + if(uip_len > 0) { + ethernet_devicedriver_send(); + } + } + \endcode + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_input()        uip_process(UIP_DATA) + + +/** + * Periodic processing for a connection identified by its number. + * + * This function does the necessary periodic processing (timers, + * polling) for a uIP TCP connection, and should be called when the + * periodic uIP timer goes off. It should be called for every + * connection, regardless of whether they are open of closed. + * + * When the function returns, it may have an outbound packet waiting + * for service in the uIP packet buffer, and if so the uip_len + * variable is set to a value larger than zero. The device driver + * should be called to send out the packet. + * + * The usual way of calling the function is through a for() loop like + * this: + \code + for(i = 0; i < UIP_CONNS; ++i) { + uip_periodic(i); + if(uip_len > 0) { + devicedriver_send(); + } + } + \endcode + * + * \note If you are writing a uIP device driver that needs ARP + * (Address Resolution Protocol), e.g., when running uIP over + * Ethernet, you will need to call the uip_arp_out() function before + * calling the device driver: + \code + for(i = 0; i < UIP_CONNS; ++i) { + uip_periodic(i); + if(uip_len > 0) { + uip_arp_out(); + ethernet_devicedriver_send(); + } + } + \endcode + * + * \param conn The number of the connection which is to be periodically polled. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#if UIP_TCP +#define uip_periodic(conn) do { uip_conn = &uip_conns[conn];    \ +    uip_process(UIP_TIMER); } while (0) + +/** + * + * + */ +#define uip_conn_active(conn) (uip_conns[conn].tcpstateflags != UIP_CLOSED) + +/** + * Perform periodic processing for a connection identified by a pointer + * to its structure. + * + * Same as uip_periodic() but takes a pointer to the actual uip_conn + * struct instead of an integer as its argument. This function can be + * used to force periodic processing of a specific connection. + * + * \param conn A pointer to the uip_conn struct for the connection to + * be processed. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_periodic_conn(conn) do { uip_conn = conn;   \ +    uip_process(UIP_TIMER); } while (0) + +/** + * Request that a particular connection should be polled. + * + * Similar to uip_periodic_conn() but does not perform any timer + * processing. The application is polled for new data. + * + * \param conn A pointer to the uip_conn struct for the connection to + * be processed. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_poll_conn(conn) do { uip_conn = conn;       \ +    uip_process(UIP_POLL_REQUEST); } while (0) + +#endif /* UIP_TCP */ + +#if UIP_UDP +/** + * Periodic processing for a UDP connection identified by its number. + * + * This function is essentially the same as uip_periodic(), but for + * UDP connections. It is called in a similar fashion as the + * uip_periodic() function: + \code + for(i = 0; i < UIP_UDP_CONNS; i++) { + uip_udp_periodic(i); + if(uip_len > 0) { + devicedriver_send(); + } + } + \endcode + * + * \note As for the uip_periodic() function, special care has to be + * taken when using uIP together with ARP and Ethernet: + \code + for(i = 0; i < UIP_UDP_CONNS; i++) { + uip_udp_periodic(i); + if(uip_len > 0) { + uip_arp_out(); + ethernet_devicedriver_send(); + } + } + \endcode + * + * \param conn The number of the UDP connection to be processed. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_udp_periodic(conn) do { uip_udp_conn = &uip_udp_conns[conn]; \ +    uip_process(UIP_UDP_TIMER); } while(0) + +/** + * Periodic processing for a UDP connection identified by a pointer to + * its structure. + * + * Same as uip_udp_periodic() but takes a pointer to the actual + * uip_conn struct instead of an integer as its argument. This + * function can be used to force periodic processing of a specific + * connection. + * + * \param conn A pointer to the uip_udp_conn struct for the connection + * to be processed. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_udp_periodic_conn(conn) do { uip_udp_conn = conn;   \ +    uip_process(UIP_UDP_TIMER); } while(0) +#endif /* UIP_UDP */ + +/** \brief Abandon the reassembly of the current packet */ +void uip_reass_over(void); + +/** + * The uIP packet buffer. + * + * The uip_buf array is used to hold incoming and outgoing + * packets. The device driver should place incoming data into this + * buffer. When sending data, the device driver should read the link + * level headers and the TCP/IP headers from this buffer. The size of + * the link level headers is configured by the UIP_LLH_LEN define. + * + * \note The application data need not be placed in this buffer, so + * the device driver must read it from the place pointed to by the + * uip_appdata pointer as illustrated by the following example: + \code + void + devicedriver_send(void) + { + hwsend(&uip_buf[0], UIP_LLH_LEN); + if(uip_len <= UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_TCPIP_HLEN) { + hwsend(&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN], uip_len - UIP_LLH_LEN); + } else { + hwsend(&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN], UIP_TCPIP_HLEN); + hwsend(uip_appdata, uip_len - UIP_TCPIP_HLEN - UIP_LLH_LEN); + } + } + \endcode +*/ +extern u8_t uip_buf[UIP_BUFSIZE+2]; + + + +/** @} */ + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* Functions that are used by the uIP application program. Opening and + * closing connections, sending and receiving data, etc. is all + * handled by the functions below. + */ +/** + * \defgroup uipappfunc uIP application functions + * @{ + * + * Functions used by an application running of top of uIP. + */ + +/** + * Start listening to the specified port. + * + * \note Since this function expects the port number in network byte + * order, a conversion using HTONS() or htons() is necessary. + * + \code + uip_listen(HTONS(80)); + \endcode + * + * \param port A 16-bit port number in network byte order. + */ +void uip_listen(u16_t port); + +/** + * Stop listening to the specified port. + * + * \note Since this function expects the port number in network byte + * order, a conversion using HTONS() or htons() is necessary. + * + \code + uip_unlisten(HTONS(80)); + \endcode + * + * \param port A 16-bit port number in network byte order. + */ +void uip_unlisten(u16_t port); + +/** + * Connect to a remote host using TCP. + * + * This function is used to start a new connection to the specified + * port on the specified host. It allocates a new connection identifier, + * sets the connection to the SYN_SENT state and sets the + * retransmission timer to 0. This will cause a TCP SYN segment to be + * sent out the next time this connection is periodically processed, + * which usually is done within 0.5 seconds after the call to + * uip_connect(). + * + * \note This function is available only if support for active open + * has been configured by defining UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN to 1 in uipopt.h. + * + * \note Since this function requires the port number to be in network + * byte order, a conversion using HTONS() or htons() is necessary. + * + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr; + + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr, 192,168,1,2); + uip_connect(&ipaddr, HTONS(80)); + \endcode + * + * \param ripaddr The IP address of the remote host. + * + * \param port A 16-bit port number in network byte order. + * + * \return A pointer to the uIP connection identifier for the new connection, + * or NULL if no connection could be allocated. + * + */ +struct uip_conn *uip_connect(uip_ipaddr_t *ripaddr, u16_t port); + + + +/** + * \internal + * + * Check if a connection has outstanding (i.e., unacknowledged) data. + * + * \param conn A pointer to the uip_conn structure for the connection. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_outstanding(conn) ((conn)->len) + +/** + * Send data on the current connection. + * + * This function is used to send out a single segment of TCP + * data. Only applications that have been invoked by uIP for event + * processing can send data. + * + * The amount of data that actually is sent out after a call to this + * function is determined by the maximum amount of data TCP allows. uIP + * will automatically crop the data so that only the appropriate + * amount of data is sent. The function uip_mss() can be used to query + * uIP for the amount of data that actually will be sent. + * + * \note This function does not guarantee that the sent data will + * arrive at the destination. If the data is lost in the network, the + * application will be invoked with the uip_rexmit() event being + * set. The application will then have to resend the data using this + * function. + * + * \param data A pointer to the data which is to be sent. + * + * \param len The maximum amount of data bytes to be sent. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +void uip_send(const void *data, int len); + +/** + * The length of any incoming data that is currently available (if available) + * in the uip_appdata buffer. + * + * The test function uip_data() must first be used to check if there + * is any data available at all. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +/*void uip_datalen(void);*/ +#define uip_datalen()       uip_len + +/** + * The length of any out-of-band data (urgent data) that has arrived + * on the connection. + * + * \note The configuration parameter UIP_URGDATA must be set for this + * function to be enabled. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_urgdatalen()    uip_urglen + +/** + * Close the current connection. + * + * This function will close the current connection in a nice way. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_close()         (uip_flags = UIP_CLOSE) + +/** + * Abort the current connection. + * + * This function will abort (reset) the current connection, and is + * usually used when an error has occurred that prevents using the + * uip_close() function. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_abort()         (uip_flags = UIP_ABORT) + +/** + * Tell the sending host to stop sending data. + * + * This function will close our receiver's window so that we stop + * receiving data for the current connection. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_stop()          (uip_conn->tcpstateflags |= UIP_STOPPED) + +/** + * Find out if the current connection has been previously stopped with + * uip_stop(). + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_stopped(conn)   ((conn)->tcpstateflags & UIP_STOPPED) + +/** + * Restart the current connection, if is has previously been stopped + * with uip_stop(). + * + * This function will open the receiver's window again so that we + * start receiving data for the current connection. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_restart()         do { uip_flags |= UIP_NEWDATA;    \ +    uip_conn->tcpstateflags &= ~UIP_STOPPED;                    \ +  } while(0) + + +/* uIP tests that can be made to determine in what state the current +   connection is, and what the application function should do. */ + +/** + * Is the current connection a UDP connection? + * + * This function checks whether the current connection is a UDP connection. + * + * \hideinitializer + * + */ +#define uip_udpconnection() (uip_conn == NULL) + +/** + * Is new incoming data available? + * + * Will reduce to non-zero if there is new data for the application + * present at the uip_appdata pointer. The size of the data is + * available through the uip_len variable. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_newdata()   (uip_flags & UIP_NEWDATA) + +/** + * Has previously sent data been acknowledged? + * + * Will reduce to non-zero if the previously sent data has been + * acknowledged by the remote host. This means that the application + * can send new data. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_acked()   (uip_flags & UIP_ACKDATA) + +/** + * Has the connection just been connected? + * + * Reduces to non-zero if the current connection has been connected to + * a remote host. This will happen both if the connection has been + * actively opened (with uip_connect()) or passively opened (with + * uip_listen()). + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_connected() (uip_flags & UIP_CONNECTED) + +/** + * Has the connection been closed by the other end? + * + * Is non-zero if the connection has been closed by the remote + * host. The application may then do the necessary clean-ups. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_closed()    (uip_flags & UIP_CLOSE) + +/** + * Has the connection been aborted by the other end? + * + * Non-zero if the current connection has been aborted (reset) by the + * remote host. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_aborted()    (uip_flags & UIP_ABORT) + +/** + * Has the connection timed out? + * + * Non-zero if the current connection has been aborted due to too many + * retransmissions. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_timedout()    (uip_flags & UIP_TIMEDOUT) + +/** + * Do we need to retransmit previously data? + * + * Reduces to non-zero if the previously sent data has been lost in + * the network, and the application should retransmit it. The + * application should send the exact same data as it did the last + * time, using the uip_send() function. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_rexmit()     (uip_flags & UIP_REXMIT) + +/** + * Is the connection being polled by uIP? + * + * Is non-zero if the reason the application is invoked is that the + * current connection has been idle for a while and should be + * polled. + * + * The polling event can be used for sending data without having to + * wait for the remote host to send data. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_poll()       (uip_flags & UIP_POLL) + +/** + * Get the initial maximum segment size (MSS) of the current + * connection. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_initialmss()             (uip_conn->initialmss) + +/** + * Get the current maximum segment size that can be sent on the current + * connection. + * + * The current maximum segment size that can be sent on the + * connection is computed from the receiver's window and the MSS of + * the connection (which also is available by calling + * uip_initialmss()). + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_mss()             (uip_conn->mss) + +/** + * Set up a new UDP connection. + * + * This function sets up a new UDP connection. The function will + * automatically allocate an unused local port for the new + * connection. However, another port can be chosen by using the + * uip_udp_bind() call, after the uip_udp_new() function has been + * called. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t addr; + struct uip_udp_conn *c; + + uip_ipaddr(&addr, 192,168,2,1); + c = uip_udp_new(&addr, HTONS(12345)); + if(c != NULL) { + uip_udp_bind(c, HTONS(12344)); + } + \endcode + * \param ripaddr The IP address of the remote host. + * + * \param rport The remote port number in network byte order. + * + * \return The uip_udp_conn structure for the new connection or NULL + * if no connection could be allocated. + */ +struct uip_udp_conn *uip_udp_new(const uip_ipaddr_t *ripaddr, u16_t rport); + +/** + * Removed a UDP connection. + * + * \param conn A pointer to the uip_udp_conn structure for the connection. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_udp_remove(conn) (conn)->lport = 0 + +/** + * Bind a UDP connection to a local port. + * + * \param conn A pointer to the uip_udp_conn structure for the + * connection. + * + * \param port The local port number, in network byte order. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_udp_bind(conn, port) (conn)->lport = port + +/** + * Send a UDP datagram of length len on the current connection. + * + * This function can only be called in response to a UDP event (poll + * or newdata). The data must be present in the uip_buf buffer, at the + * place pointed to by the uip_appdata pointer. + * + * \param len The length of the data in the uip_buf buffer. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_udp_send(len) uip_send((char *)uip_appdata, len) + +/** @} */ + +/* uIP convenience and converting functions. */ + +/** + * \defgroup uipconvfunc uIP conversion functions + * @{ + * + * These functions can be used for converting between different data + * formats used by uIP. + */ + +/** + * Convert an IP address to four bytes separated by commas. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr; + printf("ipaddr=%d.%d.%d.%d\n", uip_ipaddr_to_quad(&ipaddr)); + \endcode + * + * \param a A pointer to a uip_ipaddr_t. + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_ipaddr_to_quad(a) (a)->u8[0],(a)->u8[1],(a)->u8[2],(a)->u8[3] + +/** + * Construct an IP address from four bytes. + * + * This function constructs an IP address of the type that uIP handles + * internally from four bytes. The function is handy for specifying IP + * addresses to use with e.g. the uip_connect() function. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr; + struct uip_conn *c; + + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr, 192,168,1,2); + c = uip_connect(&ipaddr, HTONS(80)); + \endcode + * + * \param addr A pointer to a uip_ipaddr_t variable that will be + * filled in with the IP address. + * + * \param addr0 The first octet of the IP address. + * \param addr1 The second octet of the IP address. + * \param addr2 The third octet of the IP address. + * \param addr3 The forth octet of the IP address. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_ipaddr(addr, addr0,addr1,addr2,addr3) do {  \ +    (addr)->u8[0] = addr0;                              \ +    (addr)->u8[1] = addr1;                              \ +    (addr)->u8[2] = addr2;                              \ +    (addr)->u8[3] = addr3;                              \ +  } while(0) + +/** + * Construct an IPv6 address from eight 16-bit words. + * + * This function constructs an IPv6 address. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_ip6addr(addr, addr0,addr1,addr2,addr3,addr4,addr5,addr6,addr7) do { \ +    (addr)->u16[0] = HTONS(addr0);                                      \ +    (addr)->u16[1] = HTONS(addr1);                                      \ +    (addr)->u16[2] = HTONS(addr2);                                      \ +    (addr)->u16[3] = HTONS(addr3);                                      \ +    (addr)->u16[4] = HTONS(addr4);                                      \ +    (addr)->u16[5] = HTONS(addr5);                                      \ +    (addr)->u16[6] = HTONS(addr6);                                      \ +    (addr)->u16[7] = HTONS(addr7);                                      \ +  } while(0) + +/** + * Construct an IPv6 address from sixteen 8-bit words. + * + * This function constructs an IPv6 address. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_ip6addr_u8(addr, addr0,addr1,addr2,addr3,addr4,addr5,addr6,addr7,addr8,addr9,addr10,addr11,addr12,addr13,addr14,addr15) do { \ +    (addr)->u8[0] = addr0;                                       \ +    (addr)->u8[1] = addr1;                                       \ +    (addr)->u8[2] = addr2;                                       \ +    (addr)->u8[3] = addr3;                                       \ +    (addr)->u8[4] = addr4;                                       \ +    (addr)->u8[5] = addr5;                                       \ +    (addr)->u8[6] = addr6;                                       \ +    (addr)->u8[7] = addr7;                                       \ +    (addr)->u8[8] = addr8;                                       \ +    (addr)->u8[9] = addr9;                                       \ +    (addr)->u8[10] = addr10;                                     \ +    (addr)->u8[11] = addr11;                                     \ +    (addr)->u8[12] = addr12;                                     \ +    (addr)->u8[13] = addr13;                                     \ +    (addr)->u8[14] = addr14;                                     \ +    (addr)->u8[15] = addr15;                                     \ +  } while(0) + + +/** + * Copy an IP address to another IP address. + * + * Copies an IP address from one place to another. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr1, ipaddr2; + + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr1, 192,16,1,2); + uip_ipaddr_copy(&ipaddr2, &ipaddr1); + \endcode + * + * \param dest The destination for the copy. + * \param src The source from where to copy. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifndef uip_ipaddr_copy +#define uip_ipaddr_copy(dest, src) (*(dest) = *(src)) +#endif + +/** + * Compare two IP addresses + * + * Compares two IP addresses. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr1, ipaddr2; + + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr1, 192,16,1,2); + if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&ipaddr2, &ipaddr1)) { + printf("They are the same"); + } + \endcode + * + * \param addr1 The first IP address. + * \param addr2 The second IP address. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 +#define uip_ipaddr_cmp(addr1, addr2) ((addr1)->u16[0] == (addr2)->u16[0] && \ +				      (addr1)->u16[1] == (addr2)->u16[1]) +#else /* !UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +#define uip_ipaddr_cmp(addr1, addr2) (memcmp(addr1, addr2, sizeof(uip_ip6addr_t)) == 0) +#endif /* !UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +/** + * Compare two IP addresses with netmasks + * + * Compares two IP addresses with netmasks. The masks are used to mask + * out the bits that are to be compared. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr1, ipaddr2, mask; + + uip_ipaddr(&mask, 255,255,255,0); + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr1, 192,16,1,2); + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr2, 192,16,1,3); + if(uip_ipaddr_maskcmp(&ipaddr1, &ipaddr2, &mask)) { + printf("They are the same"); + } + \endcode + * + * \param addr1 The first IP address. + * \param addr2 The second IP address. + * \param mask The netmask. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 +#define uip_ipaddr_maskcmp(addr1, addr2, mask)          \ +  (((((u16_t *)addr1)[0] & ((u16_t *)mask)[0]) ==       \ +    (((u16_t *)addr2)[0] & ((u16_t *)mask)[0])) &&      \ +   ((((u16_t *)addr1)[1] & ((u16_t *)mask)[1]) ==       \ +    (((u16_t *)addr2)[1] & ((u16_t *)mask)[1]))) +#else +#define uip_ipaddr_prefixcmp(addr1, addr2, length) (memcmp(addr1, addr2, length>>3) == 0) +#endif + + +/** + * Check if an address is a broadcast address for a network. + * + * Checks if an address is the broadcast address for a network. The + * network is defined by an IP address that is on the network and the + * network's netmask. + * + * \param addr The IP address. + * \param netaddr The network's IP address. + * \param netmask The network's netmask. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +/*#define uip_ipaddr_isbroadcast(addr, netaddr, netmask) +  ((uip_ipaddr_t *)(addr)).u16 & ((uip_ipaddr_t *)(addr)).u16*/ + + + +/** + * Mask out the network part of an IP address. + * + * Masks out the network part of an IP address, given the address and + * the netmask. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr1, ipaddr2, netmask; + + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr1, 192,16,1,2); + uip_ipaddr(&netmask, 255,255,255,0); + uip_ipaddr_mask(&ipaddr2, &ipaddr1, &netmask); + \endcode + * + * In the example above, the variable "ipaddr2" will contain the IP + * address 192.168.1.0. + * + * \param dest Where the result is to be placed. + * \param src The IP address. + * \param mask The netmask. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_ipaddr_mask(dest, src, mask) do {                           \ +    ((u16_t *)dest)[0] = ((u16_t *)src)[0] & ((u16_t *)mask)[0];        \ +    ((u16_t *)dest)[1] = ((u16_t *)src)[1] & ((u16_t *)mask)[1];        \ +  } while(0) + +/** + * Pick the first octet of an IP address. + * + * Picks out the first octet of an IP address. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr; + u8_t octet; + + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr, 1,2,3,4); + octet = uip_ipaddr1(&ipaddr); + \endcode + * + * In the example above, the variable "octet" will contain the value 1. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_ipaddr1(addr) ((addr)->u8[0]) + +/** + * Pick the second octet of an IP address. + * + * Picks out the second octet of an IP address. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr; + u8_t octet; + + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr, 1,2,3,4); + octet = uip_ipaddr2(&ipaddr); + \endcode + * + * In the example above, the variable "octet" will contain the value 2. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_ipaddr2(addr) ((addr)->u8[1]) + +/** + * Pick the third octet of an IP address. + * + * Picks out the third octet of an IP address. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr; + u8_t octet; + + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr, 1,2,3,4); + octet = uip_ipaddr3(&ipaddr); + \endcode + * + * In the example above, the variable "octet" will contain the value 3. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_ipaddr3(addr) ((addr)->u8[2]) + +/** + * Pick the fourth octet of an IP address. + * + * Picks out the fourth octet of an IP address. + * + * Example: + \code + uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr; + u8_t octet; + + uip_ipaddr(&ipaddr, 1,2,3,4); + octet = uip_ipaddr4(&ipaddr); + \endcode + * + * In the example above, the variable "octet" will contain the value 4. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_ipaddr4(addr) ((addr)->u8[3]) + +/** + * Convert 16-bit quantity from host byte order to network byte order. + * + * This macro is primarily used for converting constants from host + * byte order to network byte order. For converting variables to + * network byte order, use the htons() function instead. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifndef HTONS +#   if UIP_BYTE_ORDER == UIP_BIG_ENDIAN +#      define HTONS(n) (n) +#      define HTONL(n) (n) +#   else /* UIP_BYTE_ORDER == UIP_BIG_ENDIAN */ +#      define HTONS(n) (u16_t)((((u16_t) (n)) << 8) | (((u16_t) (n)) >> 8)) +#      define HTONL(n) (((u32_t)HTONS(n) << 16) | HTONS((u32_t)(n) >> 16)) +#   endif /* UIP_BYTE_ORDER == UIP_BIG_ENDIAN */ +#else +#error "HTONS already defined!" +#endif /* HTONS */ + +/** + * Convert 16-bit quantity from host byte order to network byte order. + * + * This function is primarily used for converting variables from host + * byte order to network byte order. For converting constants to + * network byte order, use the HTONS() macro instead. + */ +#ifndef htons +u16_t htons(u16_t val); +#endif /* htons */ +#ifndef ntohs +#define ntohs htons +#endif + +#ifndef htonl +u32_t htonl(u32_t val); +#endif /* htonl */ +#ifndef ntohl +#define ntohl htonl +#endif + +/** @} */ + +/** + * Pointer to the application data in the packet buffer. + * + * This pointer points to the application data when the application is + * called. If the application wishes to send data, the application may + * use this space to write the data into before calling uip_send(). + */ +extern void *uip_appdata; + +#if UIP_URGDATA > 0 +/* u8_t *uip_urgdata: + * + * This pointer points to any urgent data that has been received. Only + * present if compiled with support for urgent data (UIP_URGDATA). + */ +extern void *uip_urgdata; +#endif /* UIP_URGDATA > 0 */ + + +/** + * \defgroup uipdrivervars Variables used in uIP device drivers + * @{ + * + * uIP has a few global variables that are used in device drivers for + * uIP. + */ + +/** + * The length of the packet in the uip_buf buffer. + * + * The global variable uip_len holds the length of the packet in the + * uip_buf buffer. + * + * When the network device driver calls the uIP input function, + * uip_len should be set to the length of the packet in the uip_buf + * buffer. + * + * When sending packets, the device driver should use the contents of + * the uip_len variable to determine the length of the outgoing + * packet. + * + */ +extern u16_t uip_len; + +/** + * The length of the extension headers + */ +extern u8_t uip_ext_len; +/** @} */ + +#if UIP_URGDATA > 0 +extern u16_t uip_urglen, uip_surglen; +#endif /* UIP_URGDATA > 0 */ + + +/** + * Representation of a uIP TCP connection. + * + * The uip_conn structure is used for identifying a connection. All + * but one field in the structure are to be considered read-only by an + * application. The only exception is the appstate field whose purpose + * is to let the application store application-specific state (e.g., + * file pointers) for the connection. The type of this field is + * configured in the "uipopt.h" header file. + */ +struct uip_conn { +  uip_ipaddr_t ripaddr;   /**< The IP address of the remote host. */ + +  u16_t lport;        /**< The local TCP port, in network byte order. */ +  u16_t rport;        /**< The local remote TCP port, in network byte +			 order. */ + +  u8_t rcv_nxt[4];    /**< The sequence number that we expect to +			 receive next. */ +  u8_t snd_nxt[4];    /**< The sequence number that was last sent by +                         us. */ +  u16_t len;          /**< Length of the data that was previously sent. */ +  u16_t mss;          /**< Current maximum segment size for the +			 connection. */ +  u16_t initialmss;   /**< Initial maximum segment size for the +			 connection. */ +  u8_t sa;            /**< Retransmission time-out calculation state +			 variable. */ +  u8_t sv;            /**< Retransmission time-out calculation state +			 variable. */ +  u8_t rto;           /**< Retransmission time-out. */ +  u8_t tcpstateflags; /**< TCP state and flags. */ +  u8_t timer;         /**< The retransmission timer. */ +  u8_t nrtx;          /**< The number of retransmissions for the last +			 segment sent. */ + +  /** The application state. */ +  uip_tcp_appstate_t appstate; +}; + + +/** + * Pointer to the current TCP connection. + * + * The uip_conn pointer can be used to access the current TCP + * connection. + */ + +extern struct uip_conn *uip_conn; +#if UIP_TCP +/* The array containing all uIP connections. */ +extern struct uip_conn uip_conns[UIP_CONNS]; +#endif + +/** + * \addtogroup uiparch + * @{ + */ + +/** + * 4-byte array used for the 32-bit sequence number calculations. + */ +extern u8_t uip_acc32[4]; +/** @} */ + +/** + * Representation of a uIP UDP connection. + */ +struct uip_udp_conn { +  uip_ipaddr_t ripaddr;   /**< The IP address of the remote peer. */ +  u16_t lport;        /**< The local port number in network byte order. */ +  u16_t rport;        /**< The remote port number in network byte order. */ +  u8_t  ttl;          /**< Default time-to-live. */ + +  /** The application state. */ +  uip_udp_appstate_t appstate; +}; + +/** + * The current UDP connection. + */ +extern struct uip_udp_conn *uip_udp_conn; +extern struct uip_udp_conn uip_udp_conns[UIP_UDP_CONNS]; + +struct uip_router { +  int (*activate)(void); +  int (*deactivate)(void); +  uip_ipaddr_t *(*lookup)(uip_ipaddr_t *destipaddr, uip_ipaddr_t *nexthop); +}; + +#if UIP_CONF_ROUTER +extern const struct uip_router *uip_router; + +/** + * uIP routing driver registration function. + */ +void uip_router_register(const struct uip_router *router); +#endif /*UIP_CONF_ROUTER*/ + +#if UIP_CONF_ICMP6 +struct uip_icmp6_conn { +  uip_icmp6_appstate_t appstate; +}; +extern struct uip_icmp6_conn uip_icmp6_conns; +#endif /*UIP_CONF_ICMP6*/ + +/** + * The uIP TCP/IP statistics. + * + * This is the variable in which the uIP TCP/IP statistics are gathered. + */ +#if UIP_STATISTICS == 1 +extern struct uip_stats uip_stat; +#define UIP_STAT(s) s +#else +#define UIP_STAT(s) +#endif /* UIP_STATISTICS == 1 */ + +/** + * The structure holding the TCP/IP statistics that are gathered if + * UIP_STATISTICS is set to 1. + * + */ +struct uip_stats { +  struct { +    uip_stats_t recv;     /**< Number of received packets at the IP +			     layer. */ +    uip_stats_t sent;     /**< Number of sent packets at the IP +			     layer. */ +    uip_stats_t forwarded;/**< Number of forwarded packets at the IP +			     layer. */ +    uip_stats_t drop;     /**< Number of dropped packets at the IP +			     layer. */ +    uip_stats_t vhlerr;   /**< Number of packets dropped due to wrong +			     IP version or header length. */ +    uip_stats_t hblenerr; /**< Number of packets dropped due to wrong +			     IP length, high byte. */ +    uip_stats_t lblenerr; /**< Number of packets dropped due to wrong +			     IP length, low byte. */ +    uip_stats_t fragerr;  /**< Number of packets dropped since they +			     were IP fragments. */ +    uip_stats_t chkerr;   /**< Number of packets dropped due to IP +			     checksum errors. */ +    uip_stats_t protoerr; /**< Number of packets dropped since they +			     were neither ICMP, UDP nor TCP. */ +  } ip;                   /**< IP statistics. */ +  struct { +    uip_stats_t recv;     /**< Number of received ICMP packets. */ +    uip_stats_t sent;     /**< Number of sent ICMP packets. */ +    uip_stats_t drop;     /**< Number of dropped ICMP packets. */ +    uip_stats_t typeerr;  /**< Number of ICMP packets with a wrong +			     type. */ +    uip_stats_t chkerr;   /**< Number of ICMP packets with a bad +			     checksum. */ +  } icmp;                 /**< ICMP statistics. */ +#if UIP_TCP +  struct { +    uip_stats_t recv;     /**< Number of received TCP segments. */ +    uip_stats_t sent;     /**< Number of sent TCP segments. */ +    uip_stats_t drop;     /**< Number of dropped TCP segments. */ +    uip_stats_t chkerr;   /**< Number of TCP segments with a bad +			     checksum. */ +    uip_stats_t ackerr;   /**< Number of TCP segments with a bad ACK +			     number. */ +    uip_stats_t rst;      /**< Number of received TCP RST (reset) segments. */ +    uip_stats_t rexmit;   /**< Number of retransmitted TCP segments. */ +    uip_stats_t syndrop;  /**< Number of dropped SYNs due to too few +			     connections was available. */ +    uip_stats_t synrst;   /**< Number of SYNs for closed ports, +			     triggering a RST. */ +  } tcp;                  /**< TCP statistics. */ +#endif +#if UIP_UDP +  struct { +    uip_stats_t drop;     /**< Number of dropped UDP segments. */ +    uip_stats_t recv;     /**< Number of received UDP segments. */ +    uip_stats_t sent;     /**< Number of sent UDP segments. */ +    uip_stats_t chkerr;   /**< Number of UDP segments with a bad +			     checksum. */ +  } udp;                  /**< UDP statistics. */ +#endif /* UIP_UDP */ +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +  struct { +    uip_stats_t drop;     /**< Number of dropped ND6 packets. */ +    uip_stats_t recv;     /**< Number of received ND6 packets */ +    uip_stats_t sent;     /**< Number of sent ND6 packets */ +  } nd6; +#endif /*UIP_CONF_IPV6*/ +}; + + +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/* All the stuff below this point is internal to uIP and should not be + * used directly by an application or by a device driver. + */ +/*---------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + + + +/* u8_t uip_flags: + * + * When the application is called, uip_flags will contain the flags + * that are defined in this file. Please read below for more + * information. + */ +extern u8_t uip_flags; + +/* The following flags may be set in the global variable uip_flags +   before calling the application callback. The UIP_ACKDATA, +   UIP_NEWDATA, and UIP_CLOSE flags may both be set at the same time, +   whereas the others are mutually exclusive. Note that these flags +   should *NOT* be accessed directly, but only through the uIP +   functions/macros. */ + +#define UIP_ACKDATA   1     /* Signifies that the outstanding data was +			       acked and the application should send +			       out new data instead of retransmitting +			       the last data. */ +#define UIP_NEWDATA   2     /* Flags the fact that the peer has sent +			       us new data. */ +#define UIP_REXMIT    4     /* Tells the application to retransmit the +			       data that was last sent. */ +#define UIP_POLL      8     /* Used for polling the application, to +			       check if the application has data that +			       it wants to send. */ +#define UIP_CLOSE     16    /* The remote host has closed the +			       connection, thus the connection has +			       gone away. Or the application signals +			       that it wants to close the +			       connection. */ +#define UIP_ABORT     32    /* The remote host has aborted the +			       connection, thus the connection has +			       gone away. Or the application signals +			       that it wants to abort the +			       connection. */ +#define UIP_CONNECTED 64    /* We have got a connection from a remote +                               host and have set up a new connection +                               for it, or an active connection has +                               been successfully established. */ + +#define UIP_TIMEDOUT  128   /* The connection has been aborted due to +			       too many retransmissions. */ + + +/** + * \brief process the options within a hop by hop or destination option header + * \retval 0: nothing to send, + * \retval 1: drop pkt + * \retval 2: ICMP error message to send +*/ +/*static u8_t +uip_ext_hdr_options_process(); */ + +/* uip_process(flag): + * + * The actual uIP function which does all the work. + */ +void uip_process(u8_t flag); + +  /* The following flags are passed as an argument to the uip_process() +   function. They are used to distinguish between the two cases where +   uip_process() is called. It can be called either because we have +   incoming data that should be processed, or because the periodic +   timer has fired. These values are never used directly, but only in +   the macros defined in this file. */ + +#define UIP_DATA          1     /* Tells uIP that there is incoming +				   data in the uip_buf buffer. The +				   length of the data is stored in the +				   global variable uip_len. */ +#define UIP_TIMER         2     /* Tells uIP that the periodic timer +				   has fired. */ +#define UIP_POLL_REQUEST  3     /* Tells uIP that a connection should +				   be polled. */ +#define UIP_UDP_SEND_CONN 4     /* Tells uIP that a UDP datagram +				   should be constructed in the +				   uip_buf buffer. */ +#if UIP_UDP +#define UIP_UDP_TIMER     5 +#endif /* UIP_UDP */ + +/* The TCP states used in the uip_conn->tcpstateflags. */ +#define UIP_CLOSED      0 +#define UIP_SYN_RCVD    1 +#define UIP_SYN_SENT    2 +#define UIP_ESTABLISHED 3 +#define UIP_FIN_WAIT_1  4 +#define UIP_FIN_WAIT_2  5 +#define UIP_CLOSING     6 +#define UIP_TIME_WAIT   7 +#define UIP_LAST_ACK    8 +#define UIP_TS_MASK     15 + +#define UIP_STOPPED      16 + +/* The TCP and IP headers. */ +struct uip_tcpip_hdr { +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +  /* IPv6 header. */ +  u8_t vtc, +    tcflow; +  u16_t flow; +  u8_t len[2]; +  u8_t proto, ttl; +  uip_ip6addr_t srcipaddr, destipaddr; +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +  /* IPv4 header. */ +  u8_t vhl, +    tos, +    len[2], +    ipid[2], +    ipoffset[2], +    ttl, +    proto; +  u16_t ipchksum; +  uip_ipaddr_t srcipaddr, destipaddr; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +  /* TCP header. */ +  u16_t srcport, +    destport; +  u8_t seqno[4], +    ackno[4], +    tcpoffset, +    flags, +    wnd[2]; +  u16_t tcpchksum; +  u8_t urgp[2]; +  u8_t optdata[4]; +}; + +/* The ICMP and IP headers. */ +struct uip_icmpip_hdr { +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +  /* IPv6 header. */ +  u8_t vtc, +    tcf; +  u16_t flow; +  u8_t len[2]; +  u8_t proto, ttl; +  uip_ip6addr_t srcipaddr, destipaddr; +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +  /* IPv4 header. */ +  u8_t vhl, +    tos, +    len[2], +    ipid[2], +    ipoffset[2], +    ttl, +    proto; +  u16_t ipchksum; +  uip_ipaddr_t srcipaddr, destipaddr; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +  /* ICMP header. */ +  u8_t type, icode; +  u16_t icmpchksum; +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 +  u16_t id, seqno; +  u8_t payload[1]; +#endif /* !UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +}; + + +/* The UDP and IP headers. */ +struct uip_udpip_hdr { +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +  /* IPv6 header. */ +  u8_t vtc, +    tcf; +  u16_t flow; +  u8_t len[2]; +  u8_t proto, ttl; +  uip_ip6addr_t srcipaddr, destipaddr; +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +  /* IP header. */ +  u8_t vhl, +    tos, +    len[2], +    ipid[2], +    ipoffset[2], +    ttl, +    proto; +  u16_t ipchksum; +  uip_ipaddr_t srcipaddr, destipaddr; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +  /* UDP header. */ +  u16_t srcport, +    destport; +  u16_t udplen; +  u16_t udpchksum; +}; + +/* + * In IPv6 the length of the L3 headers before the transport header is + * not fixed, due to the possibility to include extension option headers + * after the IP header. hence we split here L3 and L4 headers + */ +/* The IP header */ +struct uip_ip_hdr { +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +  /* IPV6 header */ +  u8_t vtc; +  u8_t tcflow; +  u16_t flow; +  u8_t len[2]; +  u8_t proto, ttl; +  uip_ip6addr_t srcipaddr, destipaddr; +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +  /* IPV4 header */ +  u8_t vhl, +    tos, +    len[2], +    ipid[2], +    ipoffset[2], +    ttl, +    proto; +  u16_t ipchksum; +  uip_ipaddr_t srcipaddr, destipaddr; +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +}; + + +/* + * IPv6 extension option headers: we are able to process + * the 4 extension headers defined in RFC2460 (IPv6): + * - Hop by hop option header, destination option header: + *   These two are not used by any core IPv6 protocol, hence + *   we just read them and go to the next. They convey options, + *   the options defined in RFC2460 are Pad1 and PadN, which do + *   some padding, and that we do not need to read (the length + *   field in the header is enough) + * - Routing header: this one is most notably used by MIPv6, + *   which we do not implement, hence we just read it and go + *   to the next + * - Fragmentation header: we read this header and are able to + *   reassemble packets + * + * We do not offer any means to send packets with extension headers + * + * We do not implement Authentication and ESP headers, which are + * used in IPSec and defined in RFC4302,4303,4305,4385 + */ +/* common header part */ +struct uip_ext_hdr { +  u8_t next; +  u8_t len; +}; + +/* Hop by Hop option header */ +struct uip_hbho_hdr { +  u8_t next; +  u8_t len; +}; + +/* destination option header */ +struct uip_desto_hdr { +  u8_t next; +  u8_t len; +}; + +/* We do not define structures for PAD1 and PADN options */ + +/* + * routing header + * the routing header as 4 common bytes, then routing header type + * specific data there are several types of routing header. Type 0 was + * deprecated as per RFC5095 most notable other type is 2, used in + * RFC3775 (MIPv6) here we do not implement MIPv6, so we just need to + * parse the 4 first bytes + */ +struct uip_routing_hdr { +  u8_t next; +  u8_t len; +  u8_t routing_type; +  u8_t seg_left; +}; + +/* fragmentation header */ +struct uip_frag_hdr { +  u8_t next; +  u8_t res; +  u16_t offsetresmore; +  u32_t id; +}; + +/* + * an option within the destination or hop by hop option headers + * it contains type an length, which is true for all options but PAD1 + */ +struct uip_ext_hdr_opt { +  u8_t type; +  u8_t len; +}; + +/* PADN option */ +struct uip_ext_hdr_opt_padn { +  u8_t opt_type; +  u8_t opt_len; +}; + +/* TCP header */ +struct uip_tcp_hdr { +  u16_t srcport; +  u16_t destport; +  u8_t seqno[4]; +  u8_t ackno[4]; +  u8_t tcpoffset; +  u8_t flags; +  u8_t  wnd[2]; +  u16_t tcpchksum; +  u8_t urgp[2]; +  u8_t optdata[4]; +}; + +/* The ICMP headers. */ +struct uip_icmp_hdr { +  u8_t type, icode; +  u16_t icmpchksum; +#if !UIP_CONF_IPV6 +  u16_t id, seqno; +#endif /* !UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +}; + + +/* The UDP headers. */ +struct uip_udp_hdr { +  u16_t srcport; +  u16_t destport; +  u16_t udplen; +  u16_t udpchksum; +}; + + +/** + * The buffer size available for user data in the \ref uip_buf buffer. + * + * This macro holds the available size for user data in the \ref + * uip_buf buffer. The macro is intended to be used for checking + * bounds of available user data. + * + * Example: + \code + snprintf(uip_appdata, UIP_APPDATA_SIZE, "%u\n", i); + \endcode + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define UIP_APPDATA_SIZE (UIP_BUFSIZE - UIP_LLH_LEN - UIP_TCPIP_HLEN) +#define UIP_APPDATA_PTR (void *)&uip_buf[UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_TCPIP_HLEN] + +#define UIP_PROTO_ICMP  1 +#define UIP_PROTO_TCP   6 +#define UIP_PROTO_UDP   17 +#define UIP_PROTO_ICMP6 58 + + +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +/** @{ */ +/** \brief  extension headers types */ +#define UIP_PROTO_HBHO        0 +#define UIP_PROTO_DESTO       60 +#define UIP_PROTO_ROUTING     43 +#define UIP_PROTO_FRAG        44 +#define UIP_PROTO_NONE        59 +/** @} */ + +/** @{ */ +/** \brief  Destination and Hop By Hop extension headers option types */ +#define UIP_EXT_HDR_OPT_PAD1  0 +#define UIP_EXT_HDR_OPT_PADN  1 +/** @} */ + +/** @{ */ +/** + * \brief Bitmaps for extension header processing + * + * When processing extension headers, we should record somehow which one we + * see, because you cannot have twice the same header, except for destination + * We store all this in one u8_t bitmap one bit for each header expected. The + * order in the bitmap is the order recommended in RFC2460 + */ +#define UIP_EXT_HDR_BITMAP_HBHO 0x01 +#define UIP_EXT_HDR_BITMAP_DESTO1 0x02 +#define UIP_EXT_HDR_BITMAP_ROUTING 0x04 +#define UIP_EXT_HDR_BITMAP_FRAG 0x08 +#define UIP_EXT_HDR_BITMAP_AH 0x10 +#define UIP_EXT_HDR_BITMAP_ESP 0x20 +#define UIP_EXT_HDR_BITMAP_DESTO2 0x40 +/** @} */ + + +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + + +/* Header sizes. */ +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +#define UIP_IPH_LEN    40 +#define UIP_FRAGH_LEN  8 +#else /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ +#define UIP_IPH_LEN    20    /* Size of IP header */ +#endif /* UIP_CONF_IPV6 */ + +#define UIP_UDPH_LEN    8    /* Size of UDP header */ +#define UIP_TCPH_LEN   20    /* Size of TCP header */ +#ifdef UIP_IPH_LEN +#define UIP_ICMPH_LEN   4    /* Size of ICMP header */ +#endif +#define UIP_IPUDPH_LEN (UIP_UDPH_LEN + UIP_IPH_LEN)    /* Size of IP + +                        * UDP +							   * header */ +#define UIP_IPTCPH_LEN (UIP_TCPH_LEN + UIP_IPH_LEN)    /* Size of IP + +							   * TCP +							   * header */ +#define UIP_TCPIP_HLEN UIP_IPTCPH_LEN +#define UIP_IPICMPH_LEN (UIP_IPH_LEN + UIP_ICMPH_LEN) /* size of ICMP +                                                         + IP header */ +#define UIP_LLIPH_LEN (UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_IPH_LEN)    /* size of L2 +                                                        + IP header */ +#if UIP_CONF_IPV6 +/** + * The sums below are quite used in ND. When used for uip_buf, we + * include link layer length when used for uip_len, we do not, hence + * we need values with and without LLH_LEN we do not use capital + * letters as these values are variable + */ +#define uip_l2_l3_hdr_len (UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_IPH_LEN + uip_ext_len) +#define uip_l2_l3_icmp_hdr_len (UIP_LLH_LEN + UIP_IPH_LEN + uip_ext_len + UIP_ICMPH_LEN) +#define uip_l3_hdr_len (UIP_IPH_LEN + uip_ext_len) +#define uip_l3_icmp_hdr_len (UIP_IPH_LEN + uip_ext_len + UIP_ICMPH_LEN) +#endif /*UIP_CONF_IPV6*/ + + +#if UIP_FIXEDADDR +extern const uip_ipaddr_t uip_hostaddr, uip_netmask, uip_draddr; +#else /* UIP_FIXEDADDR */ +extern uip_ipaddr_t uip_hostaddr, uip_netmask, uip_draddr; +#endif /* UIP_FIXEDADDR */ +extern const uip_ipaddr_t uip_broadcast_addr; +extern const uip_ipaddr_t uip_all_zeroes_addr; + +#if UIP_FIXEDETHADDR +extern const uip_lladdr_t uip_lladdr; +#else +extern uip_lladdr_t uip_lladdr; +#endif + + + + +#ifdef UIP_CONF_IPV6 +/** + * \brief Is IPv6 address a the unspecified address + * a is of type uip_ipaddr_t + */ +#define uip_is_addr_unspecified(a)               \ +  ((((a)->u16[0]) == 0) &&                       \ +   (((a)->u16[1]) == 0) &&                       \ +   (((a)->u16[2]) == 0) &&                       \ +   (((a)->u16[3]) == 0) &&                       \ +   (((a)->u16[4]) == 0) &&                       \ +   (((a)->u16[5]) == 0) &&                       \ +   (((a)->u16[6]) == 0) &&                       \ +   (((a)->u16[7]) == 0)) + +/** \brief Is IPv6 address a the link local all-nodes multicast address */ +#define uip_is_addr_linklocal_allnodes_mcast(a)     \ +  ((((a)->u8[0]) == 0xff) &&                        \ +   (((a)->u8[1]) == 0x02) &&                        \ +   (((a)->u16[1]) == 0) &&                          \ +   (((a)->u16[2]) == 0) &&                          \ +   (((a)->u16[3]) == 0) &&                          \ +   (((a)->u16[4]) == 0) &&                          \ +   (((a)->u16[5]) == 0) &&                          \ +   (((a)->u16[6]) == 0) &&                          \ +   (((a)->u8[14]) == 0) &&                          \ +   (((a)->u8[15]) == 0x01)) + +/** \brief set IP address a to unspecified */ +#define uip_create_unspecified(a) uip_ip6addr(a, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0) + +/** \brief set IP address a to the link local all-nodes multicast address */ +#define uip_create_linklocal_allnodes_mcast(a) uip_ip6addr(a, 0xff02, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0x0001) + +/** \brief set IP address a to the link local all-routers multicast address */ +#define uip_create_linklocal_allrouters_mcast(a) uip_ip6addr(a, 0xff02, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0x0002) + +/** + * \brief  is addr (a) a solicited node multicast address, see RFC3513 + *  a is of type uip_ipaddr_t* + */ +#define uip_is_addr_solicited_node(a)           \ +  ((((a)->u8[0]) == 0xFF) &&                     \ +  (((a)->u8[1]) == 0x02) &&                     \ +  (((a)->u16[1]) == 0) &&                       \ +  (((a)->u16[2]) == 0) &&                       \ +  (((a)->u16[3]) == 0) &&                       \ +  (((a)->u16[4]) == 0) &&                       \ +  (((a)->u16[5]) == 1) &&                       \ +  (((a)->u8[12]) == 0xFF)) + +/** + * \briefput in b the solicited node address corresponding to address a + * both a and b are of type uip_ipaddr_t* + * */ +#define uip_create_solicited_node(a, b)    \ +  (((b)->u8[0]) = 0xFF);                        \ +  (((b)->u8[1]) = 0x02);                        \ +  (((b)->u16[1]) = 0);                          \ +  (((b)->u16[2]) = 0);                          \ +  (((b)->u16[3]) = 0);                          \ +  (((b)->u16[4]) = 0);                          \ +  (((b)->u8[10]) = 0);                          \ +  (((b)->u8[11]) = 0x01);                       \ +  (((b)->u8[12]) = 0xFF);                       \ +  (((b)->u8[13]) = ((a)->u8[13]));              \ +  (((b)->u16[7]) = ((a)->u16[7])) + +/** + * \brief is addr (a) a link local unicast address, see RFC3513 + *  i.e. is (a) on prefix FE80::/10 + *  a is of type uip_ipaddr_t* + */ +#define uip_is_addr_link_local(a) \ +  ((((a)->u8[0]) == 0xFE) && \ +  (((a)->u8[1]) == 0x80)) + +/** + * \brief was addr (a) forged based on the mac address m + * a type is uip_ipaddr_t + * m type is uiplladdr_t + */ +#if UIP_CONF_LL_802154 +#define uip_is_addr_mac_addr_based(a, m) \ +  ((((a)->u8[8])  == (((m)->addr[0]) ^ 0x02)) &&   \ +   (((a)->u8[9])  == (m)->addr[1]) &&            \ +   (((a)->u8[10]) == (m)->addr[2]) &&            \ +   (((a)->u8[11]) == (m)->addr[3]) &&            \ +   (((a)->u8[12]) == (m)->addr[4]) &&            \ +   (((a)->u8[13]) == (m)->addr[5]) &&            \ +   (((a)->u8[14]) == (m)->addr[6]) &&            \ +   (((a)->u8[15]) == (m)->addr[7])) +#else + +#define uip_is_addr_mac_addr_based(a, m) \ +  ((((a)->u8[8])  == (((m)->addr[0]) | 0x02)) &&   \ +   (((a)->u8[9])  == (m)->addr[1]) &&            \ +   (((a)->u8[10]) == (m)->addr[2]) &&            \ +   (((a)->u8[11]) == 0xff) &&            \ +   (((a)->u8[12]) == 0xfe) &&            \ +   (((a)->u8[13]) == (m)->addr[3]) &&            \ +   (((a)->u8[14]) == (m)->addr[4]) &&            \ +   (((a)->u8[15]) == (m)->addr[5])) + +#endif /*UIP_CONF_LL_802154*/ + +/** + * \brief is address a multicast address, see RFC 3513 + * a is of type uip_ipaddr_t* + * */ +#define uip_is_addr_mcast(a)                    \ +  (((a)->u8[0]) == 0xFF) + +/** + * \brief is group-id of multicast address a + * the all nodes group-id + */ +#define uip_is_mcast_group_id_all_nodes(a) \ +  ((((a)->u16[1])  == 0) &&                 \ +   (((a)->u16[2])  == 0) &&                 \ +   (((a)->u16[3])  == 0) &&                 \ +   (((a)->u16[4])  == 0) &&                 \ +   (((a)->u16[5])  == 0) &&                 \ +   (((a)->u16[6])  == 0) &&                 \ +   (((a)->u8[14])  == 0) &&                 \ +   (((a)->u8[15])  == 1)) + +/** + * \brief is group-id of multicast address a + * the all routers group-id + */ +#define uip_is_mcast_group_id_all_routers(a) \ +  ((((a)->u16[1])  == 0) &&                 \ +   (((a)->u16[2])  == 0) &&                 \ +   (((a)->u16[3])  == 0) &&                 \ +   (((a)->u16[4])  == 0) &&                 \ +   (((a)->u16[5])  == 0) &&                 \ +   (((a)->u16[6])  == 0) &&                 \ +   (((a)->u8[14])  == 0) &&                 \ +   (((a)->u8[15])  == 2)) + + +#endif /*UIP_CONF_IPV6*/ + +/** + * Calculate the Internet checksum over a buffer. + * + * The Internet checksum is the one's complement of the one's + * complement sum of all 16-bit words in the buffer. + * + * See RFC1071. + * + * \param buf A pointer to the buffer over which the checksum is to be + * computed. + * + * \param len The length of the buffer over which the checksum is to + * be computed. + * + * \return The Internet checksum of the buffer. + */ +u16_t uip_chksum(u16_t *buf, u16_t len); + +/** + * Calculate the IP header checksum of the packet header in uip_buf. + * + * The IP header checksum is the Internet checksum of the 20 bytes of + * the IP header. + * + * \return The IP header checksum of the IP header in the uip_buf + * buffer. + */ +u16_t uip_ipchksum(void); + +/** + * Calculate the TCP checksum of the packet in uip_buf and uip_appdata. + * + * The TCP checksum is the Internet checksum of data contents of the + * TCP segment, and a pseudo-header as defined in RFC793. + * + * \return The TCP checksum of the TCP segment in uip_buf and pointed + * to by uip_appdata. + */ +u16_t uip_tcpchksum(void); + +/** + * Calculate the UDP checksum of the packet in uip_buf and uip_appdata. + * + * The UDP checksum is the Internet checksum of data contents of the + * UDP segment, and a pseudo-header as defined in RFC768. + * + * \return The UDP checksum of the UDP segment in uip_buf and pointed + * to by uip_appdata. + */ +u16_t uip_udpchksum(void); + +/** + * Calculate the ICMP checksum of the packet in uip_buf. + * + * \return The ICMP checksum of the ICMP packet in uip_buf + */ +u16_t uip_icmp6chksum(void); + + +#endif /* __UIP_H__ */ + + +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip_arp.c b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip_arp.c new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..fcb783b140 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip_arp.c @@ -0,0 +1,432 @@ +/** + * \addtogroup uip + * @{ + */ + +/** + * \defgroup uiparp uIP Address Resolution Protocol + * @{ + * + * The Address Resolution Protocol ARP is used for mapping between IP + * addresses and link level addresses such as the Ethernet MAC + * addresses. ARP uses broadcast queries to ask for the link level + * address of a known IP address and the host which is configured with + * the IP address for which the query was meant, will respond with its + * link level address. + * + * \note This ARP implementation only supports Ethernet. + */ + +/** + * \file + * Implementation of the ARP Address Resolution Protocol. + * \author Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> + * + */ + +/* + * Copyright (c) 2001-2003, Adam Dunkels. + * All rights reserved. + * + * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without + * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions + * are met: + * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright + *    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + *    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + *    documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote + *    products derived from this software without specific prior + *    written permission. + * + * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS + * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED + * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE + * ARE DISCLAIMED.  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY + * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL + * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE + * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS + * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, + * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING + * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS + * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. + * + * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. + * + * $Id: uip_arp.c,v 1.5 2008/02/07 01:35:00 adamdunkels Exp $ + * + */ + + +#include "uip_arp.h" + +#include <string.h> + +struct arp_hdr { +  struct uip_eth_hdr ethhdr; +  u16_t hwtype; +  u16_t protocol; +  u8_t hwlen; +  u8_t protolen; +  u16_t opcode; +  struct uip_eth_addr shwaddr; +  uip_ipaddr_t sipaddr; +  struct uip_eth_addr dhwaddr; +  uip_ipaddr_t dipaddr; +}; + +struct ethip_hdr { +  struct uip_eth_hdr ethhdr; +  /* IP header. */ +  u8_t vhl, +    tos, +    len[2], +    ipid[2], +    ipoffset[2], +    ttl, +    proto; +  u16_t ipchksum; +  uip_ipaddr_t srcipaddr, destipaddr; +}; + +#define ARP_REQUEST 1 +#define ARP_REPLY   2 + +#define ARP_HWTYPE_ETH 1 + +struct arp_entry { +  uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr; +  struct uip_eth_addr ethaddr; +  u8_t time; +}; + +static const struct uip_eth_addr broadcast_ethaddr = +  {{0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff,0xff}}; +static const u16_t broadcast_ipaddr[2] = {0xffff,0xffff}; + +static struct arp_entry arp_table[UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE]; +static uip_ipaddr_t ipaddr; +static u8_t i, c; + +static u8_t arptime; +static u8_t tmpage; + +#define BUF   ((struct arp_hdr *)&uip_buf[0]) +#define IPBUF ((struct ethip_hdr *)&uip_buf[0]) + +#define DEBUG 0 +#if DEBUG +#include <stdio.h> +#define PRINTF(...) printf(__VA_ARGS__) +#else +#define PRINTF(...) +#endif + +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * Initialize the ARP module. + * + */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_arp_init(void) +{ +  for(i = 0; i < UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE; ++i) { +    memset(&arp_table[i].ipaddr, 0, 4); +  } +} +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * Periodic ARP processing function. + * + * This function performs periodic timer processing in the ARP module + * and should be called at regular intervals. The recommended interval + * is 10 seconds between the calls. + * + */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_arp_timer(void) +{ +  struct arp_entry *tabptr = NULL; + +  ++arptime; +  for(i = 0; i < UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE; ++i) { +    tabptr = &arp_table[i]; +    if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&tabptr->ipaddr, &uip_all_zeroes_addr) && +       arptime - tabptr->time >= UIP_ARP_MAXAGE) { +      memset(&tabptr->ipaddr, 0, 4); +    } +  } + +} +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +static void +uip_arp_update(uip_ipaddr_t *ipaddr, struct uip_eth_addr *ethaddr) +{ +  register struct arp_entry *tabptr = NULL; +  /* Walk through the ARP mapping table and try to find an entry to +     update. If none is found, the IP -> MAC address mapping is +     inserted in the ARP table. */ +  for(i = 0; i < UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE; ++i) { + +    tabptr = &arp_table[i]; +    /* Only check those entries that are actually in use. */ +    if(!uip_ipaddr_cmp(&tabptr->ipaddr, &uip_all_zeroes_addr)) { + +      /* Check if the source IP address of the incoming packet matches +         the IP address in this ARP table entry. */ +      if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(ipaddr, &tabptr->ipaddr)) { + +	/* An old entry found, update this and return. */ +	memcpy(tabptr->ethaddr.addr, ethaddr->addr, 6); +	tabptr->time = arptime; + +	return; +      } +    } +  } + +  /* If we get here, no existing ARP table entry was found, so we +     create one. */ + +  /* First, we try to find an unused entry in the ARP table. */ +  for(i = 0; i < UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE; ++i) { +    tabptr = &arp_table[i]; +    if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&tabptr->ipaddr, &uip_all_zeroes_addr)) { +      break; +    } +  } + +  /* If no unused entry is found, we try to find the oldest entry and +     throw it away. */ +  if(i == UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE) { +    tmpage = 0; +    c = 0; +    for(i = 0; i < UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE; ++i) { +      tabptr = &arp_table[i]; +      if(arptime - tabptr->time > tmpage) { +	tmpage = arptime - tabptr->time; +	c = i; +      } +    } +    i = c; +    tabptr = &arp_table[i]; +  } + +  /* Now, i is the ARP table entry which we will fill with the new +     information. */ +  uip_ipaddr_copy(&tabptr->ipaddr, ipaddr); +  memcpy(tabptr->ethaddr.addr, ethaddr->addr, 6); +  tabptr->time = arptime; +} +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * ARP processing for incoming IP packets + * + * This function should be called by the device driver when an IP + * packet has been received. The function will check if the address is + * in the ARP cache, and if so the ARP cache entry will be + * refreshed. If no ARP cache entry was found, a new one is created. + * + * This function expects an IP packet with a prepended Ethernet header + * in the uip_buf[] buffer, and the length of the packet in the global + * variable uip_len. + */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +#if 0 +void +uip_arp_ipin(void) +{ +  uip_len -= sizeof(struct uip_eth_hdr); + +  /* Only insert/update an entry if the source IP address of the +     incoming IP packet comes from a host on the local network. */ +  if((IPBUF->srcipaddr[0] & uip_netmask[0]) != +     (uip_hostaddr[0] & uip_netmask[0])) { +    return; +  } +  if((IPBUF->srcipaddr[1] & uip_netmask[1]) != +     (uip_hostaddr[1] & uip_netmask[1])) { +    return; +  } +  uip_arp_update(IPBUF->srcipaddr, &(IPBUF->ethhdr.src)); + +  return; +} +#endif /* 0 */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * ARP processing for incoming ARP packets. + * + * This function should be called by the device driver when an ARP + * packet has been received. The function will act differently + * depending on the ARP packet type: if it is a reply for a request + * that we previously sent out, the ARP cache will be filled in with + * the values from the ARP reply. If the incoming ARP packet is an ARP + * request for our IP address, an ARP reply packet is created and put + * into the uip_buf[] buffer. + * + * When the function returns, the value of the global variable uip_len + * indicates whether the device driver should send out a packet or + * not. If uip_len is zero, no packet should be sent. If uip_len is + * non-zero, it contains the length of the outbound packet that is + * present in the uip_buf[] buffer. + * + * This function expects an ARP packet with a prepended Ethernet + * header in the uip_buf[] buffer, and the length of the packet in the + * global variable uip_len. + */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_arp_arpin(void) +{ +  if(uip_len < sizeof(struct arp_hdr)) { +    uip_len = 0; +    return; +  } +  uip_len = 0; + +  switch(BUF->opcode) { +  case HTONS(ARP_REQUEST): +    /* ARP request. If it asked for our address, we send out a +       reply. */ +    /*    if(BUF->dipaddr[0] == uip_hostaddr[0] && +	  BUF->dipaddr[1] == uip_hostaddr[1]) {*/ +    PRINTF("uip_arp_arpin: request for %d.%d.%d.%d (we are %d.%d.%d.%d)\n", +	   BUF->dipaddr.u8[0], BUF->dipaddr.u8[1], +	   BUF->dipaddr.u8[2], BUF->dipaddr.u8[3], +	   uip_hostaddr.u8[0], uip_hostaddr.u8[1], +	   uip_hostaddr.u8[2], uip_hostaddr.u8[3]); +    if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&BUF->dipaddr, &uip_hostaddr)) { +      /* First, we register the one who made the request in our ARP +	 table, since it is likely that we will do more communication +	 with this host in the future. */ +      uip_arp_update(&BUF->sipaddr, &BUF->shwaddr); + +      BUF->opcode = HTONS(ARP_REPLY); + +      memcpy(BUF->dhwaddr.addr, BUF->shwaddr.addr, 6); +      memcpy(BUF->shwaddr.addr, uip_ethaddr.addr, 6); +      memcpy(BUF->ethhdr.src.addr, uip_ethaddr.addr, 6); +      memcpy(BUF->ethhdr.dest.addr, BUF->dhwaddr.addr, 6); + +      uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->dipaddr, &BUF->sipaddr); +      uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->sipaddr, &uip_hostaddr); + +      BUF->ethhdr.type = HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_ARP); +      uip_len = sizeof(struct arp_hdr); +    } +    break; +  case HTONS(ARP_REPLY): +    /* ARP reply. We insert or update the ARP table if it was meant +       for us. */ +    if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&BUF->dipaddr, &uip_hostaddr)) { +      uip_arp_update(&BUF->sipaddr, &BUF->shwaddr); +    } +    break; +  } + +  return; +} +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * Prepend Ethernet header to an outbound IP packet and see if we need + * to send out an ARP request. + * + * This function should be called before sending out an IP packet. The + * function checks the destination IP address of the IP packet to see + * what Ethernet MAC address that should be used as a destination MAC + * address on the Ethernet. + * + * If the destination IP address is in the local network (determined + * by logical ANDing of netmask and our IP address), the function + * checks the ARP cache to see if an entry for the destination IP + * address is found. If so, an Ethernet header is prepended and the + * function returns. If no ARP cache entry is found for the + * destination IP address, the packet in the uip_buf[] is replaced by + * an ARP request packet for the IP address. The IP packet is dropped + * and it is assumed that they higher level protocols (e.g., TCP) + * eventually will retransmit the dropped packet. + * + * If the destination IP address is not on the local network, the IP + * address of the default router is used instead. + * + * When the function returns, a packet is present in the uip_buf[] + * buffer, and the length of the packet is in the global variable + * uip_len. + */ +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +void +uip_arp_out(void) +{ +  struct arp_entry *tabptr = NULL; + +  /* Find the destination IP address in the ARP table and construct +     the Ethernet header. If the destination IP address isn't on the +     local network, we use the default router's IP address instead. + +     If not ARP table entry is found, we overwrite the original IP +     packet with an ARP request for the IP address. */ + +  /* First check if destination is a local broadcast. */ +  if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&IPBUF->destipaddr, &uip_broadcast_addr)) { +    memcpy(IPBUF->ethhdr.dest.addr, broadcast_ethaddr.addr, 6); +  } else { +    /* Check if the destination address is on the local network. */ +    if(!uip_ipaddr_maskcmp(&IPBUF->destipaddr, &uip_hostaddr, &uip_netmask)) { +      /* Destination address was not on the local network, so we need to +	 use the default router's IP address instead of the destination +	 address when determining the MAC address. */ +      uip_ipaddr_copy(&ipaddr, &uip_draddr); +    } else { +      /* Else, we use the destination IP address. */ +      uip_ipaddr_copy(&ipaddr, &IPBUF->destipaddr); +    } + +    for(i = 0; i < UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE; ++i) { +      tabptr = &arp_table[i]; +      if(uip_ipaddr_cmp(&ipaddr, &tabptr->ipaddr)) { +	break; +      } +    } + +    if(i == UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE) { +      /* The destination address was not in our ARP table, so we +	 overwrite the IP packet with an ARP request. */ + +      memset(BUF->ethhdr.dest.addr, 0xff, 6); +      memset(BUF->dhwaddr.addr, 0x00, 6); +      memcpy(BUF->ethhdr.src.addr, uip_ethaddr.addr, 6); +      memcpy(BUF->shwaddr.addr, uip_ethaddr.addr, 6); + +      uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->dipaddr, &ipaddr); +      uip_ipaddr_copy(&BUF->sipaddr, &uip_hostaddr); +      BUF->opcode = HTONS(ARP_REQUEST); /* ARP request. */ +      BUF->hwtype = HTONS(ARP_HWTYPE_ETH); +      BUF->protocol = HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_IP); +      BUF->hwlen = 6; +      BUF->protolen = 4; +      BUF->ethhdr.type = HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_ARP); + +      uip_appdata = &uip_buf[UIP_TCPIP_HLEN + UIP_LLH_LEN]; + +      uip_len = sizeof(struct arp_hdr); +      return; +    } + +    /* Build an ethernet header. */ +    memcpy(IPBUF->ethhdr.dest.addr, tabptr->ethaddr.addr, 6); +  } +  memcpy(IPBUF->ethhdr.src.addr, uip_ethaddr.addr, 6); + +  IPBUF->ethhdr.type = HTONS(UIP_ETHTYPE_IP); + +  uip_len += sizeof(struct uip_eth_hdr); +} +/*-----------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +/** @} */ +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip_arp.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip_arp.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..4e78ce7b77 --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uip_arp.h @@ -0,0 +1,146 @@ +/** + * \addtogroup uip + * @{ + */ + +/** + * \addtogroup uiparp + * @{ + */ + +/** + * \file + * Macros and definitions for the ARP module. + * \author Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> + */ + + +/* + * Copyright (c) 2001-2003, Adam Dunkels. + * All rights reserved. + * + * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without + * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions + * are met: + * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright + *    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + *    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + *    documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote + *    products derived from this software without specific prior + *    written permission. + * + * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS + * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED + * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE + * ARE DISCLAIMED.  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY + * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL + * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE + * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS + * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, + * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING + * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS + * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. + * + * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. + * + * $Id: uip_arp.h,v 1.2 2006/08/26 23:58:45 oliverschmidt Exp $ + * + */ + +#ifndef __UIP_ARP_H__ +#define __UIP_ARP_H__ + +#include "uip.h" + + +extern struct uip_eth_addr uip_ethaddr; + +/** + * The Ethernet header. + */ +struct uip_eth_hdr { +  struct uip_eth_addr dest; +  struct uip_eth_addr src; +  u16_t type; +}; + +#define UIP_ETHTYPE_ARP  0x0806 +#define UIP_ETHTYPE_IP   0x0800 +#define UIP_ETHTYPE_IPV6 0x86dd + + +/* The uip_arp_init() function must be called before any of the other +   ARP functions. */ +void uip_arp_init(void); + +/* The uip_arp_ipin() function should be called whenever an IP packet +   arrives from the Ethernet. This function refreshes the ARP table or +   inserts a new mapping if none exists. The function assumes that an +   IP packet with an Ethernet header is present in the uip_buf buffer +   and that the length of the packet is in the uip_len variable. */ +/*void uip_arp_ipin(void);*/ +#define uip_arp_ipin() + +/* The uip_arp_arpin() should be called when an ARP packet is received +   by the Ethernet driver. This function also assumes that the +   Ethernet frame is present in the uip_buf buffer. When the +   uip_arp_arpin() function returns, the contents of the uip_buf +   buffer should be sent out on the Ethernet if the uip_len variable +   is > 0. */ +void uip_arp_arpin(void); + +/* The uip_arp_out() function should be called when an IP packet +   should be sent out on the Ethernet. This function creates an +   Ethernet header before the IP header in the uip_buf buffer. The +   Ethernet header will have the correct Ethernet MAC destination +   address filled in if an ARP table entry for the destination IP +   address (or the IP address of the default router) is present. If no +   such table entry is found, the IP packet is overwritten with an ARP +   request and we rely on TCP to retransmit the packet that was +   overwritten. In any case, the uip_len variable holds the length of +   the Ethernet frame that should be transmitted. */ +void uip_arp_out(void); + +/* The uip_arp_timer() function should be called every ten seconds. It +   is responsible for flushing old entries in the ARP table. */ +void uip_arp_timer(void); + +/** @} */ + +/** + * \addtogroup uipconffunc + * @{ + */ + + +/** + * Specifiy the Ethernet MAC address. + * + * The ARP code needs to know the MAC address of the Ethernet card in + * order to be able to respond to ARP queries and to generate working + * Ethernet headers. + * + * \note This macro only specifies the Ethernet MAC address to the ARP + * code. It cannot be used to change the MAC address of the Ethernet + * card. + * + * \param eaddr A pointer to a struct uip_eth_addr containing the + * Ethernet MAC address of the Ethernet card. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define uip_setethaddr(eaddr) do {uip_ethaddr.addr[0] = eaddr.addr[0]; \ +                              uip_ethaddr.addr[1] = eaddr.addr[1];\ +                              uip_ethaddr.addr[2] = eaddr.addr[2];\ +                              uip_ethaddr.addr[3] = eaddr.addr[3];\ +                              uip_ethaddr.addr[4] = eaddr.addr[4];\ +                              uip_ethaddr.addr[5] = eaddr.addr[5];} while(0) + +/** @} */ + + +#endif /* __UIP_ARP_H__ */ +/** @} */ + diff --git a/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uipopt.h b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uipopt.h new file mode 100644 index 0000000000..520c03f25e --- /dev/null +++ b/lib/lufa/Projects/Webserver/Lib/uip/uipopt.h @@ -0,0 +1,740 @@ +/** + * \addtogroup uip + * @{ + */ + +/** + * \defgroup uipopt Configuration options for uIP + * @{ + * + * uIP is configured using the per-project configuration file + * "uipopt.h". This file contains all compile-time options for uIP and + * should be tweaked to match each specific project. The uIP + * distribution contains a documented example "uipopt.h" that can be + * copied and modified for each project. + */ + +/** + * \file + * Configuration options for uIP. + * \author Adam Dunkels <adam@dunkels.com> + * + * This file is used for tweaking various configuration options for + * uIP. You should make a copy of this file into one of your project's + * directories instead of editing this example "uipopt.h" file that + * comes with the uIP distribution. + */ + +/* + * Copyright (c) 2001-2003, Adam Dunkels. + * All rights reserved. + * + * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without + * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions + * are met: + * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright + *    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer. + * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright + *    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the + *    documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution. + * 3. The name of the author may not be used to endorse or promote + *    products derived from this software without specific prior + *    written permission. + * + * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS + * OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED + * WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE + * ARE DISCLAIMED.  IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE FOR ANY + * DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL + * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE + * GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS + * INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, + * WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING + * NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS + * SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. + * + * This file is part of the uIP TCP/IP stack. + * + * $Id: uipopt.h,v 1.11 2009/04/10 00:37:48 adamdunkels Exp $ + * + */ + +#ifndef __UIPOPT_H__ +#define __UIPOPT_H__ + +#include "Config/AppConfig.h" + +#ifndef UIP_LITTLE_ENDIAN +#define UIP_LITTLE_ENDIAN  3412 +#endif /* UIP_LITTLE_ENDIAN */ +#ifndef UIP_BIG_ENDIAN +#define UIP_BIG_ENDIAN     1234 +#endif /* UIP_BIG_ENDIAN */ + +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +/** + * \defgroup uipoptstaticconf Static configuration options + * @{ + * + * These configuration options can be used for setting the IP address + * settings statically, but only if UIP_FIXEDADDR is set to 1. The + * configuration options for a specific node includes IP address, + * netmask and default router as well as the Ethernet address. The + * netmask, default router and Ethernet address are applicable only + * if uIP should be run over Ethernet. + * + * This options are meaningful only for the IPv4 code. + * + * All of these should be changed to suit your project. + */ + +/** + * Determines if uIP should use a fixed IP address or not. + * + * If uIP should use a fixed IP address, the settings are set in the + * uipopt.h file. If not, the macros uip_sethostaddr(), + * uip_setdraddr() and uip_setnetmask() should be used instead. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define UIP_FIXEDADDR    0 + +/** + * Ping IP address assignment. + * + * uIP uses a "ping" packets for setting its own IP address if this + * option is set. If so, uIP will start with an empty IP address and + * the destination IP address of the first incoming "ping" (ICMP echo) + * packet will be used for setting the hosts IP address. + * + * \note This works only if UIP_FIXEDADDR is 0. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_PINGADDRCONF +#define UIP_PINGADDRCONF UIP_CONF_PINGADDRCONF +#else /* UIP_CONF_PINGADDRCONF */ +#define UIP_PINGADDRCONF 0 +#endif /* UIP_CONF_PINGADDRCONF */ + + +/** + * Specifies if the uIP ARP module should be compiled with a fixed + * Ethernet MAC address or not. + * + * If this configuration option is 0, the macro uip_setethaddr() can + * be used to specify the Ethernet address at run-time. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#define UIP_FIXEDETHADDR 0 + +/** @} */ +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * \defgroup uipoptip IP configuration options + * @{ + * + */ +/** + * The IP TTL (time to live) of IP packets sent by uIP. + * + * This should normally not be changed. + */ +#define UIP_TTL         64 + +/** + * The maximum time an IP fragment should wait in the reassembly + * buffer before it is dropped. + * + */ +#define UIP_REASS_MAXAGE 60 /*60s*/ + +/** + * Turn on support for IP packet reassembly. + * + * uIP supports reassembly of fragmented IP packets. This features + * requires an additional amount of RAM to hold the reassembly buffer + * and the reassembly code size is approximately 700 bytes.  The + * reassembly buffer is of the same size as the uip_buf buffer + * (configured by UIP_BUFSIZE). + * + * \note IP packet reassembly is not heavily tested. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_REASSEMBLY +#define UIP_REASSEMBLY UIP_CONF_REASSEMBLY +#else /* UIP_CONF_REASSEMBLY */ +#define UIP_REASSEMBLY 0 +#endif /* UIP_CONF_REASSEMBLY */ +/** @} */ + +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * \defgroup uipoptipv6 IPv6 configuration options + * @{ + * + */ + +/** The maximum transmission unit at the IP Layer*/ +#define UIP_LINK_MTU 1280 + +#ifndef UIP_CONF_IPV6 +/** Do we use IPv6 or not (default: no) */ +#define UIP_CONF_IPV6                 0 +#endif + +#ifndef UIP_CONF_IPV6_QUEUE_PKT +/** Do we do per %neighbor queuing during address resolution (default: no) */ +#define UIP_CONF_IPV6_QUEUE_PKT       0 +#endif + +#ifndef UIP_CONF_IPV6_CHECKS +/** Do we do IPv6 consistency checks (highly recommended, default: yes) */ +#define UIP_CONF_IPV6_CHECKS          1 +#endif + +#ifndef UIP_CONF_IPV6_REASSEMBLY +/** Do we do IPv6 fragmentation (default: no) */ +#define UIP_CONF_IPV6_REASSEMBLY      0 +#endif + +#ifndef UIP_CONF_NETIF_MAX_ADDRESSES +/** Default number of IPv6 addresses associated to the node's interface */ +#define UIP_CONF_NETIF_MAX_ADDRESSES  3 +#endif + +#ifndef UIP_CONF_ND6_MAX_PREFIXES +/** Default number of IPv6 prefixes associated to the node's interface */ +#define UIP_CONF_ND6_MAX_PREFIXES     3 +#endif + +#ifndef UIP_CONF_ND6_MAX_NEIGHBORS +/** Default number of neighbors that can be stored in the %neighbor cache */ +#define UIP_CONF_ND6_MAX_NEIGHBORS    4 +#endif + +#ifndef UIP_CONF_ND6_MAX_DEFROUTERS +/** Minimum number of default routers */ +#define UIP_CONF_ND6_MAX_DEFROUTERS   2 +#endif +/** @} */ + +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * \defgroup uipoptudp UDP configuration options + * @{ + * + * \note The UDP support in uIP is still not entirely complete; there + * is no support for sending or receiving broadcast or multicast + * packets, but it works well enough to support a number of vital + * applications such as DNS queries, though + */ + +/** + * Toggles whether UDP support should be compiled in or not. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_UDP +#define UIP_UDP UIP_CONF_UDP +#else /* UIP_CONF_UDP */ +#define UIP_UDP           1 +#endif /* UIP_CONF_UDP */ + +/** + * Toggles if UDP checksums should be used or not. + * + * \note Support for UDP checksums is currently not included in uIP, + * so this option has no function. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_UDP_CHECKSUMS +#define UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS UIP_CONF_UDP_CHECKSUMS +#else +#define UIP_UDP_CHECKSUMS 0 +#endif + +/** + * The maximum amount of concurrent UDP connections. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_UDP_CONNS +#define UIP_UDP_CONNS UIP_CONF_UDP_CONNS +#else /* UIP_CONF_UDP_CONNS */ +#define UIP_UDP_CONNS    10 +#endif /* UIP_CONF_UDP_CONNS */ + +/** + * The name of the function that should be called when UDP datagrams arrive. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ + + +/** @} */ +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * \defgroup uipopttcp TCP configuration options + * @{ + */ + +/** + * Toggles whether TCP support should be compiled in or not. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_TCP +#define UIP_TCP UIP_CONF_TCP +#else /* UIP_CONF_TCP */ +#define UIP_TCP           1 +#endif /* UIP_CONF_TCP */ + +/** + * Determines if support for opening connections from uIP should be + * compiled in. + * + * If the applications that are running on top of uIP for this project + * do not need to open outgoing TCP connections, this configuration + * option can be turned off to reduce the code size of uIP. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifndef UIP_CONF_ACTIVE_OPEN +#define UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN 1 +#else /* UIP_CONF_ACTIVE_OPEN */ +#define UIP_ACTIVE_OPEN UIP_CONF_ACTIVE_OPEN +#endif /* UIP_CONF_ACTIVE_OPEN */ + +/** + * The maximum number of simultaneously open TCP connections. + * + * Since the TCP connections are statically allocated, turning this + * configuration knob down results in less RAM used. Each TCP + * connection requires approximately 30 bytes of memory. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifndef UIP_CONF_MAX_CONNECTIONS +#define UIP_CONNS       10 +#else /* UIP_CONF_MAX_CONNECTIONS */ +#define UIP_CONNS UIP_CONF_MAX_CONNECTIONS +#endif /* UIP_CONF_MAX_CONNECTIONS */ + + +/** + * The maximum number of simultaneously listening TCP ports. + * + * Each listening TCP port requires 2 bytes of memory. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifndef UIP_CONF_MAX_LISTENPORTS +#define UIP_LISTENPORTS 20 +#else /* UIP_CONF_MAX_LISTENPORTS */ +#define UIP_LISTENPORTS UIP_CONF_MAX_LISTENPORTS +#endif /* UIP_CONF_MAX_LISTENPORTS */ + +/** + * Determines if support for TCP urgent data notification should be + * compiled in. + * + * Urgent data (out-of-band data) is a rarely used TCP feature that + * very seldom would be required. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#if !defined(UIP_URGDATA) +#define UIP_URGDATA      0 +#endif + +/** + * The initial retransmission timeout counted in timer pulses. + * + * This should not be changed. + */ +#if !defined(UIP_RTO) +#define UIP_RTO         3 +#endif + +/** + * The maximum number of times a segment should be retransmitted + * before the connection should be aborted. + * + * This should not be changed. + */ +#if !defined(UIP_MAXRTX) +#define UIP_MAXRTX      8 +#endif + +/** + * The maximum number of times a SYN segment should be retransmitted + * before a connection request should be deemed to have been + * unsuccessful. + * + * This should not need to be changed. + */ +#if !defined(UIP_MAXSYNRTX) +#define UIP_MAXSYNRTX      5 +#endif + +/** + * The TCP maximum segment size. + * + * This is should not be to set to more than + * UIP_BUFSIZE - UIP_LLH_LEN - UIP_TCPIP_HLEN. + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_TCP_MSS +#define UIP_TCP_MSS UIP_CONF_TCP_MSS +#else +#define UIP_TCP_MSS     (UIP_BUFSIZE - UIP_LLH_LEN - UIP_TCPIP_HLEN) +#endif + +/** + * The size of the advertised receiver's window. + * + * Should be set low (i.e., to the size of the uip_buf buffer) if the + * application is slow to process incoming data, or high (32768 bytes) + * if the application processes data quickly. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifndef UIP_CONF_RECEIVE_WINDOW +#define UIP_RECEIVE_WINDOW UIP_TCP_MSS +#else +#define UIP_RECEIVE_WINDOW UIP_CONF_RECEIVE_WINDOW +#endif + +/** + * How long a connection should stay in the TIME_WAIT state. + * + * This configuration option has no real implication, and it should be + * left untouched. + */ +#define UIP_TIME_WAIT_TIMEOUT 120 + + +/** @} */ +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * \defgroup uipoptarp ARP configuration options + * @{ + */ + +/** + * The size of the ARP table. + * + * This option should be set to a larger value if this uIP node will + * have many connections from the local network. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_ARPTAB_SIZE +#define UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE UIP_CONF_ARPTAB_SIZE +#else +#define UIP_ARPTAB_SIZE 8 +#endif + +/** + * The maximum age of ARP table entries measured in 10ths of seconds. + * + * An UIP_ARP_MAXAGE of 120 corresponds to 20 minutes (BSD + * default). + */ +#define UIP_ARP_MAXAGE 120 + + +/** @} */ + +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +/** + * \defgroup uipoptmac layer 2 options (for ipv6) + * @{ + */ + +#define UIP_DEFAULT_PREFIX_LEN 64 + +/** @} */ + +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +/** + * \defgroup uipoptsics 6lowpan options (for ipv6) + * @{ + */ +/** + * Timeout for packet reassembly at the 6lowpan layer + * (should be < 60s) + */ +#ifdef SICSLOWPAN_CONF_MAXAGE +#define SICSLOWPAN_REASS_MAXAGE SICSLOWPAN_CONF_MAXAGE +#else +#define SICSLOWPAN_REASS_MAXAGE 20 +#endif + +/** + * Do we compress the IP header or not (default: no) + */ +#ifndef SICSLOWPAN_CONF_COMPRESSION +#define SICSLOWPAN_CONF_COMPRESSION 0 +#endif + +/** + * If we use IPHC compression, how many address contexts do we support + */ +#ifndef SICSLOWPAN_CONF_MAX_ADDR_CONTEXTS +#define SICSLOWPAN_CONF_MAX_ADDR_CONTEXTS 1 +#endif + +/** + * Do we support 6lowpan fragmentation + */ +#ifndef SICSLOWPAN_CONF_FRAG +#define SICSLOWPAN_CONF_FRAG  0 +#endif + +/** @} */ + +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +/** + * \defgroup uipoptgeneral General configuration options + * @{ + */ + +/** + * The size of the uIP packet buffer. + * + * The uIP packet buffer should not be smaller than 60 bytes, and does + * not need to be larger than 1514 bytes. Lower size results in lower + * TCP throughput, larger size results in higher TCP throughput. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifndef UIP_CONF_BUFFER_SIZE +#define UIP_BUFSIZE UIP_LINK_MTU + UIP_LLH_LEN +#else /* UIP_CONF_BUFFER_SIZE */ +#define UIP_BUFSIZE UIP_CONF_BUFFER_SIZE +#endif /* UIP_CONF_BUFFER_SIZE */ + + +/** + * Determines if statistics support should be compiled in. + * + * The statistics is useful for debugging and to show the user. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifndef UIP_CONF_STATISTICS +#define UIP_STATISTICS  0 +#else /* UIP_CONF_STATISTICS */ +#define UIP_STATISTICS UIP_CONF_STATISTICS +#endif /* UIP_CONF_STATISTICS */ + +/** + * Determines if logging of certain events should be compiled in. + * + * This is useful mostly for debugging. The function uip_log() + * must be implemented to suit the architecture of the project, if + * logging is turned on. + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifndef UIP_CONF_LOGGING +#define UIP_LOGGING     0 +#else /* UIP_CONF_LOGGING */ +#define UIP_LOGGING     UIP_CONF_LOGGING +#endif /* UIP_CONF_LOGGING */ + +/** + * Broadcast support. + * + * This flag configures IP broadcast support. This is useful only + * together with UDP. + * + * \hideinitializer + * + */ +#ifndef UIP_CONF_BROADCAST +#define UIP_BROADCAST 0 +#else /* UIP_CONF_BROADCAST */ +#define UIP_BROADCAST UIP_CONF_BROADCAST +#endif /* UIP_CONF_BROADCAST */ + +/** + * Print out a uIP log message. + * + * This function must be implemented by the module that uses uIP, and + * is called by uIP whenever a log message is generated. + */ +void uip_log(char *msg); + +/** + * The link level header length. + * + * This is the offset into the uip_buf where the IP header can be + * found. For Ethernet, this should be set to 14. For SLIP, this + * should be set to 0. + * + * \note we probably won't use this constant for other link layers than + * ethernet as they have variable header length (this is due to variable + * number and type of address fields and to optional security features) + * E.g.: 802.15.4 -> 2 + (1/2*4/8) + 0/5/6/10/14 + *       802.11 -> 4 + (6*3/4) + 2 + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_LLH_LEN +#define UIP_LLH_LEN UIP_CONF_LLH_LEN +#else /* UIP_LLH_LEN */ +#define UIP_LLH_LEN     14 +#endif /* UIP_CONF_LLH_LEN */ + +/** @} */ +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ +/** + * \defgroup uipoptcpu CPU architecture configuration + * @{ + * + * The CPU architecture configuration is where the endianess of the + * CPU on which uIP is to be run is specified. Most CPUs today are + * little endian, and the most notable exception are the Motorolas + * which are big endian. The BYTE_ORDER macro should be changed to + * reflect the CPU architecture on which uIP is to be run. + */ + +/** + * The byte order of the CPU architecture on which uIP is to be run. + * + * This option can be either UIP_BIG_ENDIAN (Motorola byte order) or + * UIP_LITTLE_ENDIAN (Intel byte order). + * + * \hideinitializer + */ +#ifdef UIP_CONF_BYTE_ORDER +#define UIP_BYTE_ORDER     UIP_CONF_BYTE_ORDER +#else /* UIP_CONF_BYTE_ORDER */ +#define UIP_BYTE_ORDER     UIP_LITTLE_ENDIAN +#endif /* UIP_CONF_BYTE_ORDER */ + +/** @} */ +/*------------------------------------------------------------------------------*/ + +#include <ff.h> +#include <stdbool.h> +#include <stdint.h> + +#include "timer.h" + +typedef uint8_t u8_t; +typedef uint16_t u16_t; +typedef uint32_t u32_t; +typedef uint32_t uip_stats_t; + +/** + * \defgroup uipoptapp Application specific configurations + * @{ + * + * An uIP application is implemented using a single application + * function that is called by uIP whenever a TCP/IP event occurs. The + * name of this function must be registered with uIP at compile time + * using the UIP_APPCALL definition. + * + * uIP applications can store the application state within the + * uip_conn structure by specifying the type of the application + * structure by typedef:ing the type uip_tcp_appstate_t and uip_udp_appstate_t. + * + * The file containing the definitions must be included in the + * uipopt.h file. + * + * The following example illustrates how this can look. + \code + + void httpd_appcall(void); + #define UIP_APPCALL     httpd_appcall + + struct httpd_state { + u8_t state; + u16_t count; + char *dataptr; + char *script; + }; + typedef struct httpd_state uip_tcp_appstate_t + \endcode +*/ +#define UIP_UDP_APPCALL uIPManagement_UDPCallback +void UIP_UDP_APPCALL(void); + +/** + * \var #define UIP_APPCALL + * + * The name of the application function that uIP should call in + * response to TCP/IP events. + * + */ +#define UIP_APPCALL     uIPManagement_TCPCallback +void UIP_APPCALL(void); + +/** + * \var typedef uip_tcp_appstate_t + * + * The type of the application state that is to be stored in the + * uip_conn structure. This usually is typedef:ed to a struct holding + * application state information. + */ +typedef union +{ +	struct +	{ +		uint8_t  CurrentState; +		uint8_t  NextState; + +		char     FileName[MAX_URI_LENGTH]; +		FIL      FileHandle; +		bool     FileOpen; +		uint32_t ACKedFilePos; +		uint16_t SentChunkSize; +	} HTTPServer; + +	struct +	{ +		uint8_t  CurrentState; +		uint8_t  NextState; + +		uint8_t  IssuedCommand; +	} TELNETServer; +} uip_tcp_appstate_t; + +/** + * \var typedef uip_udp_appstate_t + * + * The type of the application state that is to be stored in the + * uip_conn structure. This usually is typedef:ed to a struct holding + * application state information. + */ +typedef union +{ +	struct +	{ +		uint8_t      CurrentState; +		struct timer Timeout; + +		struct +		{ +			uint8_t AllocatedIP[4]; +			uint8_t Netmask[4]; +			uint8_t GatewayIP[4]; +			uint8_t ServerIP[4]; +		} DHCPOffer_Data; +	} DHCPClient; +} uip_udp_appstate_t; +/** @} */ + +#endif /* __UIPOPT_H__ */ +/** @} */ +/** @} */ + | 
